Home
        2009 Pontiac Vibe Owner Manual
         Contents
1.              0cceeeee eee 2 12       Pressure Cap            seeeeeeeee 9 22  PRIVACY annen handel 12 17   Event Data Recorders       12 17   Navigation System            12 18   ONStal antenen sexes 12 18   Radio Frequency   Identification                  12 18  R   Radio Frequency Identification    RFID   Privacy                 12 18  Radio S    sicaissicsscuseradetaneachiaae 6 3  Radios   Reception ussel 6 14   Setting the Clock                  6 2  Reading Lamps                005 5 4  Rear Door Security Locks         2 7  Rear Seat Operation                1 7  Rear Windshield Washer    WIDEST rist os roret rer 4 8  Rearview Mirrors                         2 13  Reclining Seatbacks                 1 3    Recreational Vehicle Towing     9 75  Remote Keyless Entry  RKE     System 20 0    cece eee ee eee ee eee es 2 3  Remote Keyless Entry  RKE   System  Operation                2 4    i 8 INDEX    Removing the Flat Tire and  Installing the Spare Tire        Removing the Spare Tire  and Tools  Replacement Bulbs  Replacement Parts   Maintenance  Replacing LATCH System  Parts After a Crash  Reporting Safety Defects  Canadian Government  General Motors                  United States  Government                   Restraint System Check  Replacing Airbag System  Parts After a Crash           Replacing Safety Belt  System Parts After a  Crash  Retained Accessory Power       Roadside  Assistance Program  Rocking Your Vehicle to  Get it Out aian niania  Routing  Engine Drive Bel
2.              Run the engine for short periods  only as needed to keep warm   but be careful        To save fuel  run the engine for only  short periods as needed to warm the  vehicle and then shut the engine off  and close the window most of the  way to save heat  Repeat this until  help arrives but only when you feel  really uncomfortable from the cold   Moving about to keep warm also  helps     If it takes some time for help to  arrive  now and then when you run  the engine  push the accelerator  pedal slightly so the engine runs  faster than the idle speed  This  keeps the battery charged to restart  the vehicle and to signal for help with  the headlamps  Do this as little as  possible to save fuel        If Your Vehicle is Stuck  in Sand  Mud  Ice   or Snow    Slowly and cautiously spin the  wheels to free the vehicle when  stuck in sand  mud  ice  or snow   See Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It  Out on page 8 31     Driving and Operating 8 31    Rocking Your Vehicle to  Get It Out    Turn the steering wheel left and right  to clear the area around the front  wheels  Turn off any traction or  stability system  Shift back and forth  between R  Reverse  and a forward  gear  or with a manual transmission   between 1  First  or 2  Second  and       Z  CAUTION    R  Reverse   spinning the wheels  as little as possible  To prevent       If you let your vehicle   s tires spin  at high speed  they can explode   and you or others could be  injured  The vehicle can overheat   causing 
3.             6 2  Sheet Metal Damage              9 89  Shifting Into Park              0  8 13  Shifting Out of Park                8 14  Signals  Turn and   Lane Change             0eeeeeee 4 7    Spare Tire  Compact sarsies 9 70  Installing nainen 9 64  REMOVING erissa 9 63  STORNO sses sirenu saai EE 9 68  Specifications  Capacities        10 2    Speed Sensitive Power  Steering  SSPS     Warning Light                     4 18  Speedometer 2    4 13  StabiliTrak   Indicator Light       4 19  Stabilitrak   System                 8 22  Starting the Engine                  8 4  Steering enironta 8 23    Steering  Suspension and  Front Drive Axle Boot and    Seal Inspection                 11 16  Steering Wheel Controls   A Bo e Ee ET A 6 13    Steering Wheel  Tilt Wheel        4 4  Storage Areas    Cargo Management   SYSTEM 200    cece eeee teen ees 3 6  Center Console   Storage Area              0005 3 2  Cupholders                eseeeeee 3 1  Driver Storage   Compartment               06 3 3    GIOVE  BOX  cccsctcecseccldesccsnue 3 1       Storage Areas  cont      Luggage Carrier                   3 2  Overhead Console                3 2  Stuck in Sand  Mud  Ice  or  SHOW    relse aser 8 31  Suri VisOFS hacks sas ba dekanen dar 2 13  SUNFOOR sieselsevoeseciavieesicieseess 2 14  T  Tachometer                 ceeeeeeee 4 13  Taillamp Indicator Light           4 23  TalllaMPS  scesesgechazcacsceadeneecine 9 33  TCS Warning Light                 4 19  Theft Deterrent Systems  
4.            1 4  Securing Child Restraints   Right Front Seat               50    Securing Child Restraints   Rear Seats     1 2 Seats and Restraints    Front Seats    Manual Seats       Z  CAUTION       You can lose control of the  vehicle if you try to adjust a  manual driver   s seat while the  vehicle is moving  The sudden  movement could startle and  confuse you  or make you push a  pedal when you do not want to   Adjust the drivers seat only when  the vehicle is not moving                 To move a manual seat forward or  rearward        1  Lift the bar to unlock the seat     2  Slide the seat to the desired  position and release the bar     Try to move the seat to be sure it is  locked in place        Seat Height Adjuster            The driver seat height adjuster is  located on the outboard side of the  seat  To raise or lower the seat   pull up or push down on the lever  repeatedly until the seat is at   the desired height     Reclining Seatbacks    Seats and Restraints 1 3          Z  CAUTION    Z  CAUTION    Z  CAUTION             You can lose control of the  vehicle if you try to adjust a  manual driver   s seat while the  vehicle is moving  The sudden  movement could startle and  confuse you  or make you push a  pedal when you do not want to   Adjust the driver s seat only when  the vehicle is not moving        If the seatback is not locked  it  could move forward in a sudden  stop or crash  That could cause    injury to the person sitting there     Always push an
5.           1 3  Passenger Folding  Seatback s    1 4  Head Restraints            08 1 6  Rear Seats  Rear Seat Operation             1 7  Safety Belts  Safety Belts                                  1 8  How to Wear Safety Belts  Properly ui cicecmnssineasscacevaes 1 11  Lap Shoulder Belt               1 16    Safety Belt Use During  PreQnancy          ssseeeeeeeeees 1 19       Safety Belt Extender           1  Safety Belt Check               1   Care of Safety Belts           1  Replacing Safety Belt  System Parts After a  Crashed ereen nent 1   Airbag System   Airbag System                    1    Where Are the Airbags      1  When Should an Airbag    linflate  fesssisicseesiseecsue dicts 1  What Makes an Airbag   Alate T eiee 1  How Does an Airbag   Restrain   oce 1  What Will You See After   an Airbag Inflates             1  Passenger Sensing   SYSTEM eiieeii 1    Servicing Your  PA Equipped  Vehicl     19   20     20     21     23     24     26     26     26   28     33       Seats and Restraints 1 1   Adding Equipment to   Your Airbag Equipped   Vehicle             cccccc ec ee eee ees 1 34  Airbag System Check         1 35  Replacing Airbag System   Parts After a Crash           1 35   Child Restraints   Older Children              068 1 36  Infants and Young  Childrens 1 38  Child Restraint Systems     1 41  Where to Put the   Restraint resisaer 1 43  Lower Anchors and   Tethers for Children    LATCH  osessescss ce rubel 1 44  Replacing LATCH System  Parts After a Crash
6.          2 9  Content Theft Deterrent       2 10  Immobilizer                     008 2 9  Immobilizer Operation           2 9  Throttle System Inspection     11 17  Tilt Wheel icenian 4 4  Time  Setting 2    6 2  UNOS  ace D   aA heey cect 9 41  Buying New Tires               9 54  GAINS ese  are rare 9 60  Changing a Flat Tire           9 62  Compact Spare Tire            9 70  Different Size                    9 56       INDEX  i 9    Tires  cont      If a Tire Goes Flat              9 61  Inflation   Tire Pressure       9 47  Inspection and Rotation       9 53    Installing the Spare Tire       9 64  Pressure Monitor    Operation                 ee 9 50  Pressure Monitor System     9 48  Removing the Flat Tire        9 64  Removing the Spare Tire   and Tools                 6 66 9 63  Storing a Flat or Spare Tire   and Tools               0 6006 9 68  Tire Sidewall Labeling         9 42  Tire Terminology and   Definitions                 0655 9 44  Uniform Tire Quality   Grading            ceeeeeeeeee 9 56  Wheel Alignment and Tire   Balance miiie anne 9 58  Wheel Replacement            9 59  When It Is Time for   New Tires a na 9 54   Towing  Recreational Vehicle            9 75  Towing a Trailer                  9 77  Your Vehicle                2 6 5  9 75    i 10 INDEX  Traction  Control System  TCS          8 21  Control System Warning  Light ss cdedacrecordsdieeerendies 4 19   Stabilitrak   System             8 22  Transmission   Fluid  Automatic                  9 
7.         Connect the red positive      cable to the positive     terminal  of the dead battery  Use a remote  positive     terminal if the vehicle  has one       Do not let the other end   touch metal  Connect it to the  positive     terminal of the good  battery  Use a remote positive      terminal if the vehicle has one        1 8 L4 Engine    8  To access the remote negative    on the 1 8L engine  the cover  will need to be removed    To remove the engine cover  raise the rear of the engine cover  to remove the rear clips and   the front of the engine cover   to remove the two front clips       2 4L L4 Engine    Now connect the black   negative       cable to the negative  terminal of the good battery    Use a remote negative      terminal if the vehicle has one     Do not let the other end touch  anything until the next step    The other end of the negative      cable does not go to the dead  battery  It goes to a heavy   unpainted metal engine part or to  a remote negative       terminal on  the vehicle with the dead battery     9 74 Vehicle Service and Care    9  Connect the other end of the  negative       cable at least  18 inches  45 cm  away from the  dead battery  but not near engine  parts that move  The electrical  connection is just as good there   and the chance of sparks getting  back to the battery is much less     10  Now start the vehicle with the  good battery and run the  engine for a while     11  Try to start the vehicle that had  the dead battery  If it
8.        Power Windows and    Other Power Options          Fuses and Circuit    Breakers sussie ener    Instrument Panel Fuse    BIOCK E  Engine Compartment  Fuse Block          0c 0sceeees  Tires  WAVES ieren anan  Tire Sidewall Labeling        Tire Terminology and  Definitions           W 1 1 1 1  1 1 1  1  1 W      Inflation   Tire Pressure       Tire Pressure Monitor  SYSTEM a eres  Tire Pressure Monitor  Operation siiis  Tire Inspection and  Rotation sussie  When It Is Time for New    THOS    ccccccceceeeeeeeeeeeeaeaes    Jump Starting  Jump Starting    Towing  Towing Your Vehicle    Recreational Vehicle  Towin  Towing a Trailer                     Appearance Care  Interior Cleaning                  Exterior Cleaning    9 2 Vehicle Service and Care  Buying New Tires               9 54  Different Size Tires and   Wheels          2 2 eceeeeeeeeeee ee 9 56  Uniform Tire Quality   Grading eeir o indeks 9 56  Wheel Alignment and   Tire Balance 2    9 58  Wheel Replacement            9 59  Tire Chains                 cceee 9 60   Tire Changing  If a Tire Goes Flat              9 61  Changing a Flat Tire           9 62    Removing the Spare   Tire and Tools             00 9 63  Removing the Flat Tire   and Installing the    Spare Tire            ee 9 64  Storing a Flat or Spare  Tire and Tools                   9 68    Compact Spare Tire            9 70       Sheet Metal Damage  Finish Damage              00   Underbody Maintenance       Chemical Paint Spotting            Service
9.      Horn    Press near or on the horn symbols  on the steering wheel pad to  sound the horn     4 4    Tilt Wheel    A tilt and telescope wheel lets the  steering wheel position be adjusted        The adjustment lever is located  on the left side of the steering  column     Pull the lever down to move the  steering wheel up or down and in or  out  Pull the lever up to lock the  steering wheel in place     Do not adjust the tilt and telescope  lever while driving        Instruments and Controls    Turn Signal Multifunction  Lever       The lever on the left side of the  steering column includes the  following         Exterior Lamps          Turn and Lane Change  Signals     ZD   Headlamp High Low Beam  Changer     40   Fog Lamps  If Equipped    Flash to Pass Feature     Information for these features is on  the pages following        Cruise Control       For vehicles with cruise control  the  lever is located on the right side  of the steering wheel     Cruise control  lets a speed of  25 mph  40 km h  or more be  maintained without keeping your  foot on the accelerator  Cruise  control does not work at speeds  below 25 mph  40 km h         Z  CAUTION          Cruise control can be dangerous  where you cannot drive safely at  a steady speed  So  do not use  the cruise control on winding  roads or in heavy traffic     Cruise control can be dangerous  on slippery roads  On such roads   fast changes in tire traction can  cause excessive wheel slip  and  you could lose control  D
10.     For service and parts needs  visit  your dealer retailer  You will receive  genuine GM parts and GM trained  and supported service people     Genuine GM parts have one  of these marks   ACDelco   H Parts  E  Goodwrench     E  Accessories    Accessories and  Modifications    When non dealer non retailer  accessories are added to the vehicle   they can affect vehicle performance  and safety  including such things   as airbags  braking  stability  ride  and handling  emissions systems   aerodynamics  durability  and  electronic systems like antilock  brakes  traction control  and stability  control  Some of these accessories  could even cause malfunction or  damage not covered by the vehicle  warranty     GM Accessories are designed  to complement and function with  other systems on the vehicle   Your GM dealer retailer can  accessorize the vehicle using  genuine GM Accessories  When       Vehicle Service and Care 9 3    you go to your GM dealer retailer  and ask for GM Accessories  you will  know that GM trained and supported  service technicians will perform the    work using genuine GM Accessories     Also  see Adding Equipment to  Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle on  page 1 34     California Proposition 65  Warning    Most motor vehicles  including this  one  contain and or emit chemicals  known to the State of California to  cause cancer and birth defects or  other reproductive harm  Engine  exhaust  many parts and systems   including some inside the vehicle    many fluids 
11.     INDEX  i 3    Electrical System  cont      Headlamp Wiring                9 35  Instrument Panel  Fuse Block                00 9 36    Power Windows and  Other Power Options       9 36    Windshield Wiper Fuses      9 36  Engine  Air Cleaner Filter                 9 12  Check and Service Engine  Soon Lamp senienas 4 20  Coolant ireira 9 18  Coolant Heater           1           1 1 1      8 5  Coolant  Temperature Gage           4 19  Cooling System  Inspection                  4  11 17  Drive Belt Routing               10 5  Engine Compartment  Overview GG  eee eee eeee teens 9 6  EXNMAUSE ierra 8 16  Gil rr nere 9 9  Overheating           cceeeeee 9 22  Stating inknn 8 4  Entry Lighting              eee 5 3  Event Data Recorders           12 17  Extender  Safety Belt              1 19    Exterior Lamps                 0ee 5 1    i 4 INDEX  F   Filter   Engine Air Cleaner              9 12  Finish Damage                060 9 89  Fixed Mast Antenna               6 14  Flashers  Hazard Warning         4 3  Flash to Pass             cccceeeeeees 4 7  Flat Tire         c cccccceeeeeeeeeee eee 9 61  Flat Tire  Changing                 9 62  Flat Tire  Storing                    9 68  Floor Malgre eraasi 3 3  Fluid   Automatic Transmission       9 14   Power Steering               6 9 24   Windshield Washer             9 24  Fog Lamp   FOG  sale ae Ehe Eg 5 2  Fog Lamp Light                     4 23  Folding Seatback  Passenger     1 4  Fuel         ccc cccee ee eeeeeeeee eee e
12.    Brakes on page 9 27 and  Hydraulic Clutch on page 9 17   If Equipped       Engine Air Cleaner Filter on  page 9 12      Engine Compartment Fuse Block  on page 9 39        Vehicle Service and Care 9 9       Battery on page 9 30     J  Remote Positive     Terminal   See Jump Starting on page 9 71     K  Automatic Transmission  Fluid Dipstick  See    Checking  the Fluid Level    under Automatic  Transmission Fluid on page 9 14   If Equipped   Out of View      Engine Oil  Checking Engine Oil    It is a good idea to check the  engine oil every time you get fuel   In order to get an accurate reading   the oil must be warm and the  vehicle must be on level ground        The engine oil dipstick handle   is a yellow loop  See Engine  Compartment Overview on page 9 6  for the location of the engine oil  dipstick     1  Turn off the engine and give the  oil several minutes to drain back  into the oil pan  If you do not  do this  the oil dipstick might  not show the actual level     2  Pull out the dipstick and clean  it with a paper towel or cloth   then push it back in all the way   Remove it again  keeping the tip  down  and check the level     9 10 Vehicle Service and Care    When to Add Engine Oil    1 8L Engine    pg    E e a       2 4L Engine    If the oil is below the indent at   the tip of the dipstick  add at least  one quart liter of the recommended  oil  This section explains what kind of  oil to use  For engine oil crankcase  capacity  see Capacities and  Specifications o
13.    Consult with your dealer retailer        Audio Steering Wheel  Controls       For vehicles with audio steering  wheel controls some audio controls  can be adjusted at the steering  wheel  They include the following         I    Volume   Press to  decrease or increase the volume        Infotainment 6 13    V A  Next Previous   Press to  select the next or previous radio  station  CD track  or MP3 folder     e Press V or  to go to the next  or previous preset station     e Press andholdV or  _ untila  beep is heard to go to the next  or previous radio station    Only stations with a strong  signal will be selected     e Press V or  to go to the next  or previous CD track     e Press andholdV or  _ untila  beep is heard to go to the next or  previous MP3 folder     MODE  Press to turn the audio  system on or to select between AM   FM  XM  CD  or AUX     Press and hold to turn the audio  system off     6 14 Infotainment    Radio Reception    Frequency interference and static  can occur during normal radio  reception if items such as cell phone  chargers  vehicle convenience  accessories  and external electronic  devices are plugged into the  accessory power outlet  If there is  interference or static  unplug the item  from the accessory power outlet     AM    The range for most AM stations is  greater than for FM  especially at  night  The longer range can cause  station frequencies to interfere  with each other  For better radio  reception  most AM radio stations  boost the p
14.    See Traction Control System  TCS   on page 8 21 for more information     If it stays on or comes on while  driving  there is a problem with the  Traction Control System  TCS    contact your dealer retailer        Instruments and Controls    StabiliTrak   Indicator  Light    VSC  OFF    This light warns that there is a  problem with the Traction Control  System  TCS  or the Vehicle  Stability Control  VSC  system     The light comes on when the ignition  is turned to ON RUN     If the light comes on while driving   the system is not working     The TCS light comes on when the  VSC system warning light comes on   even if the TRAC OFF button is   not pressed     See StabiliTrak   System on  page 8 22 for more information on  Vehicle Stability Control System        4 19    See Traction Control System  TCS   on page 8 21 for more information     Contact your dealer retailer  if  the light does not come on or if it  stays on     Engine Coolant  Temperature Gage    120             50  United States    This gage shows the engine coolant  temperature  If the gage pointer  moves into the red area  the engine  is too hot  Pull off the road  stop  the vehicle  and turn off the engine  as soon as possible  See Engine  Overheating on page 9 22     Canada    4 20    Malfunction  Indicator Lamp    Check Engine Light    A computer system called OBD II   On Board Diagnostics Second  Generation  monitors operation of  the fuel  ignition  and emission  control systems  It makes sure  that emi
15.    or upside down      The air is very humid  If so  wait  about an hour and try again      The format of the CD might not    be compatible  See Using an  MP3 later in this section       A problem may have occurred  while burning the CD       The label could be caught in the  CD player     If any error occurs repeatedly or if  an error cannot be corrected   contact your dealer retailer  If the  radio displays an error message   write it down and provide it to your  dealer retailer when reporting   the problem     Using the Auxiliary Input Jack    The radio has an auxiliary input  jack located on the lower right side  of the faceplate  This is not an  audio output  do not plug the  headphone set into the front  auxiliary input jack  An external  audio device such as an iPod   laptop computer  MP3 player  CD  changer  etc  can be connected  to the auxiliary input jack for use  as another audio source        To use a portable audio player   connect a 3 5 mm  1 8 inch  cable  to the radio   s front auxiliary input  jack  When a device is connected   press the radio CD AUX button   to begin playing audio from   the device over the vehicle  speakers     PWR VOL  Power Volume   Turn  to adjust the volume  Additional  volume adjustments may have to be  made from the portable device if  the volume is too quiet or not loud     BAND  Press to listen to the  radio when a portable audio device  is playing     CD AUX  CD Auxiliary   Press to  play a CD when a portable audio  device is play
16.    to work     TILT  Slide the sunshade back   Press to tilt the sunroof  Press again  to stop movement at any time     DOWN  Press to lower the sunroof     SLIDE  Press to open the sunroof   It express opens and stops   before the fully open position    Press again to fully open  Press   the switch at any time to stop the  sunroof from moving  If the sunshade  is closed it opens with the sunroof     CLOSE  Press to express close  the sunroof  Press again to  stop movement at any time     The sunshade must be closed  by hand     Anti Pinch Feature    If there is an obstruction when the  sunroof is closing  it stops and  partly opens again  Remove the  obstruction and press the button  again to close the sunroof        Keys  Doors and Windows       2 15    2 16 Keys  Doors and Windows    4 NOTES    Storage   Storage  Glove BOX issue rs 3 1  Cupholders siii sagerne 3 1  Overhead Console                3 2    Center Console Storage       3 2  Luggage Carrier              00  3 2  Driver Storage    Compartment                05  3 3  Floor Mats  oee 3 3  HOOKS or ives 3 3  Cargo Cover  ciiis 3 4  Cargo Tie Downs                 3 6  Cargo Management   System       ee 3 6       Storage    Glove Box   Lift up on the glovebox lever to  open it    Cupholders    There are cupholders located in  the console area between the  front seats     p  Sel       The cupholder size can be adjusted  by changing the location of the  provided insert        Storage 3 1       There are also cupholder
17.   14   equential Multiport i i n  Fuel Injection a  System  Instrument Outlet    Panel Lights    Switch Illumination             Vehicle Service and Care    Main Body ECU   Electric Power  Steering  Electric  Cooling Fans   Brake Transmission  Shift Interlock   Antilock Braking  System  ABS    Multiport Fuel  Injection  System Sequential  Multiport Fuel  Injection System   Tire Pressure  Monitoring  System  TPMS    Vehicle Stability  Control System  Back up Lamps   Charging System   Rear Window  Defogger    19 Onboard Diagnosis  System       Stoplamps  Center  High Mounted  Stoplamps  CHMSL    ABS  Vehicle  Stability Control  System  Multiport  Fuel Injection  System Sequential  Multiport Fuel  Injection System   Brake Transmission  Shift Interlock    Outside Rearview  Mirrors  Audio  System  Main Body  ECU  Clock  Brake  Transmission Shift  Interlock  Cigarette  Lighter       All Wheel Drive  System  Front Foglamps    Ignition  Outside  Rearview Mirrors   Audio System  Main  Body ECU  Clock   Brake Transmission  Shift Interlock   Cigarette Lighter    Rear Window  Defogger  Heated  Mirrors  Multiport  Fuel Injection  System Sequential  Multiport Fuel  Injection System       Engine Compartment  Fuse Block       This engine compartment fuse block  is located in the engine compartment  on the driver side of the vehicle   near the air cleaner  See Engine    Compartment Overview on page 9 6     Notice  Spilling liquid on any  electrical components on   the vehicle may damage it   
18.   3  Pick up the latch plate  and run  the lap and shoulder portions  of the vehicle   s safety belt  through or around the restraint   The child restraint instructions  will show you how     Seats and Restraints 1 51       4  Push the latch plate into the  buckle until it clicks     Position the release button on  the buckle so that the safety belt  could be quickly unbuckled if  necessary        1 52 Seats and Restraints    If the airbags are off  the off  indicator in the passenger airbag  status indicator will come on  and stay on when the vehicle   is started     If a child restraint has been installed  and the on indicator is lit  see    If the  On Indicator is Lit for a Child  Restraint    under Passenger Sensing  System on page 1 28 for more  information        To remove the child restraint     5  Pull the rest of the shoulder belt 6  To tighten the belt  push down unbuckle the vehicle safety belt and  all the way out of the retractor to on the child restraint  pull the let it return to the stowed position   set the lock  shoulder portion of the belt to    tighten the lap portion of the belt  and feed the shoulder belt back  into the retractor  When installing  a forward facing child restraint  it  may be helpful to use your knee  to push down on the child  restraint as you tighten the belt     7  Push and pull the child restraint  in different directions to be sure  it is secure           Securing Child Restraints   Rear Seats     When securing a child restraint in a
19.   3  Push and pull the top of the  seatback to be sure it is  locked into position     4  Use the reclining front seatback  lever to adjust the seatback to a  comfortable position     1 6 Seats and Restraints    Head Restraints    The front seats have adjustable  head restraints  The rear seats have  adjustable headrests in all seating  positions        Z  CAUTION       With head restraints that are not  installed and adjusted properly   there is a greater chance that  occupants will suffer a neck spinal  injury in a crash  Do not drive until  the head restraints for all  occupants are installed and  adjusted properly                    Adjust the head restraint so that the  top of the restraint is at the same  height as the top of the occupant   s  head  This position reduces the  chance of a neck injury in a crash     Pull the head restraint up to  raise it        To lower the head restraint  press  the button  located on the top of  the seatback  and push the  restraint down     Push down on the head restraint  after the button is released to make  sure that it is locked in place     The head restraints are not  designed to be removed     Always raise the rear center head  rest at least one position when there  is a passenger seated there     Active Head Restraint System    The vehicle has an active head  restraint system in the front seating  positions  These automatically tilt  forward to reduce the risk of   neck injury if the vehicle is hit   from behind        Rear Se
20.   9 51      Operating electronic devices or  being near facilities using radio  wave frequencies similar to the  TPMS could cause the TPMS  sensors to malfunction       lf tire chains are installed on the  vehicle        f there is a lot of snow or ice  around the wheels or wheel  housings       If a window tint that affects the  radio wave signals is installed     If the TPMS is not functioning it  cannot detect or signal a low tire  condition  See your dealer retailer for  service if the TPMS malfunction light  comes on and stays on     9 52    TPMS Reset    The TPMS sensors and transmitters  have unique identification codes   Anytime you replace a TPMS sensor  or transmitter the identification codes  need to be registered and the TPMS  needs to be reset  initialized   When  the system is initialized  the current  air pressure in the tires is set as the  tire pressure benchmark  The tire  pressure warning system determines  decreased air pressure by comparing  tire pressure to the benchmark  pressure stored in the TPMS     Do not reset the TPMS without first  correcting the cause of a low tire  condition     To reset the system     1  Park the vehicle at a safe place  and apply the parking brake   Turn the engine off     2  Turn the ignition to  ACC ACCESSORY or  LOCK OFF        Vehicle Service and Care    3  Adjust the tire pressure of all the  installed tires to the specified  cold tire inflation pressure level  indicated on the Tire and Loading  Information label attache
21.   Install the filler plug  Be sure the  plug is fully seated     Hydraulic Clutch    The hydraulic clutch linkage in  your vehicle is self adjusting   The master cylinder reservoir is  filled with DOT 3 brake fluid     It is not necessary to regularly check  the fluid unless you suspect there   is a leak in the system  Adding fluid  will not correct a leak     The hydraulic clutch and brake  master cylinder use the same  reservoir     A fluid loss in this system could  indicate a problem  Have the system  inspected and repaired        Vehicle Service and Care    When to Check and What  to Use       The reservoir is located at the back  of the engine compartment  on the  driver side of the vehicle  Engine    Compartment Overview on page 9 6        9 17    Refer to the Maintenance Schedule  to determine how often you should  check the fluid level in your master  cylinder reservoir and for the proper  fluid  Part B  Owner Checks and  Services on page 11 12 and Part D   Recommended Fluids and  Lubricants on page 11 18     How to Check and Add Fluid    Check that the fluid level is at   or above the MIN mark  If the level  is below the MIN mark  see the  instructions on the reservoir cap     9 18 Vehicle Service and Care    Cooling System  When it is safe lift the hood        A  Electric Engine Cooling Fans  B  Pressure Cap  C  Engine Coolant Recovery Tank       Z  CAUTION       An electric engine cooling fan  under the hood can start up even  when the engine is not running  and c
22.   LATCH  on page 1 44 for more  information  A child can be  endangered in a crash if the child  restraint is not properly secured   in the vehicle     When securing an add on child  restraint  refer to the instructions that  come with the restraint which may  be on the restraint itself or ina  booklet  or both  and to this manual   The child restraint instructions are  important  so if they are not  available  obtain a replacement  copy from the manufacturer        Keep in mind that an unsecured  child restraint can move around   in a collision or sudden stop   and injure people in the vehicle    Be sure to properly secure any child  restraint in the vehicle     even  when no child is in it     Securing the Child Within the  Child Restraint       Z  CAUTION       A child can be seriously injured or  killed in a crash if the child is not  properly secured in the child  restraint  Secure the child properly  following the instructions that  came with that child restraint              Where to Put the  Restraint    According to accident statistics   children and infants are safer when  properly restrained in a child  restraint system or infant restraint  system secured in a rear seating  position     We recommend that children and  child restraints be secured in a rear  seat  including  an infant or a child  riding in a rear facing child restraint   a child riding in a forward facing child  seat  an older child riding in a booster  seat  and children  who are large  enough  usin
23.   Replace filter if  necessary     Inspect passenger compartment  air filter        20 000 Miles  32 000 km   Q Change engine oil and filter     or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See footnote        Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     25 000 Miles  40 000 km   Q Change engine oil and filter     or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection    and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See footnote           Q  Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     30 000 Miles  48 000 km     Q  Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See footnote        QO  Replace engine air cleaner filter   or every 24 months  whichever  occurs first   See Engine Air  Cleaner Filter on page 9 12 for  more information     11 6 Service and Maintenance    Q Check restraint system  Make  sure the safety belt reminder    35 000 Miles  56 000 km   Q Change engine oil and filter    Q Inspect engine air cleaner 
24.   all the filler caps are on properly   Return the hood prop rod carefully  back to its retainer to avoid  damaging the vehicle     9 6 Vehicle Service and Care    Engine Compartment Overview  When you open the hood on the 1 8L L4 engine  this is what you see     Sy WL    DH   ST         Engine Oil Dipstick  See     Checking Engine Oil    under  Engine Oil on page 9 9      Pressure Cap on page 9 22      Windshield Washer Fluid   on page 9 24      Coolant Recovery Tank    See Engine Coolant on   page 9 18      Engine Oil Fill Cap  See    When  to Add Engine Oil    under Engine  Oil on page 9 9      Engine Air Cleaner Filter on  page 9 12        H     Vehicle Service and Care      Brakes on page 9 27 and    Hydraulic Clutch on page 9 17   If Equipped     Engine Compartment Fuse Block  on page 9 39        Battery on page 9 30     J     K     Remote Positive     Terminal   See Jump Starting on page 9 71   Automatic Transmission   Fluid Dipstick  See    Checking  the Fluid Level    under Automatic  Transmission Fluid on page 9 14   If Equipped   Out of View         9 7    9 8 Vehicle Service and Care    When you open the hood on the 2 4L L4 engine  this is what you see          Engine Oil Dipstick  See   Checking Engine Oil    under  Engine Oil on page 9 9      Pressure Cap on page 9 22      Windshield Washer Fluid   on page 9 24      Coolant Recovery Tank  See  Engine Coolant on page 9 18      Engine Oil Fill Cap  See    When  to Add Engine Oil    under Engine  Oil on page 9 9   
25.   driving speeds  vehicle loading   and road conditions influence  when you need new tires        One way to tell when it is time for  new tires is to check the treadwear  indicators  which will appear   when the tires have only 1 16 inch     1 6 mm  or less of tread remaining        Vehicle Service and Care    You need new tires if any of the  following statements are true       You can see the indicators at  three or more places around  the tire       You can see cord or fabric    showing through the tire s rubber       The tread or sidewall is cracked   cut  or snagged deep enough to  show cord or fabric       The tire has a bump  bulge   or split       The tire has a puncture  cut  or  other damage that cannot be  repaired well because of the  size or location of the damage     The rubber in tires degrades over  time  even if they are not being used   This is also true for the spare tire    if the vehicle has one  Multiple  conditions affect how fast this aging  takes place  including temperatures        loading conditions  and inflation  pressure maintenance  With proper  care and maintenance tires typically  wear out before they degrade due to  age  If you are unsure about the  need to replace the tires as they get  older  consult the tire manufacturer  for more information     Buying New Tires    GM has developed and matched  specific tires for the vehicle  If you  need replacement tires  GM strongly  recommends that you get tires that  are the same size  brand  load r
26.   in hot weather       While pulling a trailer     To get the right reading  the fluid  should be at normal operating  temperature  which is 158  F to  176  F  70  C to 80  C         Get the vehicle warmed up by  driving about 15 miles  24 km   when outside temperatures are  above 50  F  10  C   If it is colder  than 50  F  10  C   you may have  to drive longer     Checking the Fluid Level  Prepare your vehicle as follows     1  Park your vehicle on a level  place  Keep the engine running     2  With the parking brake applied   place the shift lever in P  Park      3  With your foot on the brake  pedal  move the shift lever  through each gear range   pausing for about three seconds  in each range  Then  position  the shift lever in P  Park      4  Let the engine run at idle for  three to five minutes     Then  without shutting off the  engine  follow these steps     The automatic transmission   dipstick has an orange handle   and is located near the front of the  engine compartment  See Engine  Compartment Overview on page 9 6  for more information on location     1  Release the tab and pull out the  dipstick and wipe it with a clean  rag or paper towel     2  Push it back in all the way  wait  three seconds and then pull it  back out again     O O e     1 8L shown    3  Check both sides of the dipstick   and read the lower level  The  fluid level must be between the  two dimples in the hot range        Vehicle Service and Care    4  If the fluid level is in the  acceptable r
27.   is jacked up is dangerous  If the  vehicle slips off the jack you could  be badly injured or killed  Never  get under a vehicle when it is  supported only by a jack           Z  CAUTION          Raising your vehicle with the jack  improperly positioned can damage  the vehicle and even make the  vehicle fall  To help avoid personal  injury and vehicle damage  be  sure to fit the jack lift head into the  proper location before raising the  vehicle                    7  Turn the jack handle clockwise     Raise the vehicle far enough off  the ground so there is enough   room for the compact spare tire  to fit underneath the wheel well     9 66 Vehicle Service and Care       8  Remove the wheel nuts and the  flat tire     9  Install the spare tire        Z  CAUTION          Rust or dirt on a wheel  or on the  parts to which it is fastened  can  make wheel nuts become loose  after time  The wheel could come  off and cause an accident  When  you change a wheel  remove any  rust or dirt from places where the  wheel attaches to the vehicle    In an emergency  you can use a  cloth or a paper towel to do this   but be sure to use a scraper   or wire brush later  if needed    to get all the rust or dirt off    See Changing a Flat Tire on  page 9 62                 10  Remove any rust or dirt from  the wheel bolts  mounting  surfaces and spare wheel     11  Place the compact spare tire on  the wheel mounting surface        Z  CAUTION       Never use oil or grease on bolts  or nuts becau
28.   material is on the road  For safety   you want to slow down and adjust  your driving to these conditions  It is  important to slow down on slippery  surfaces because stopping distance  is longer and vehicle control more  limited     While driving on a surface with  reduced traction  try your best to  avoid sudden steering  acceleration   or braking  including reducing vehicle  speed by shifting to a lower gear   Any sudden changes could cause  the tires to slide  You might not  realize the surface is slippery until  your vehicle is skidding  Learn to  recognize warning clues     such as  enough water  ice  or packed snow  on the road to make a mirrored  surface     and slow down when   you have any doubt     Remember  Any Antilock Brake  System  ABS  helps avoid only the  braking skid        Driving at Night    Night driving is more dangerous  than day driving because   some drivers are likely to be  impaired     by alcohol or drugs   with night vision problems  or  by fatigue     Night driving tips include     Drive defensively   e Do not drink and drive       Reduce headlamp glare by  adjusting the inside rearview  mirror       Slow down and keep more space  between you and other vehicles  because headlamps can only  light up so much road ahead        e Watch for animals     When tired  pull off the road     Do not wear sunglasses       Avoid staring directly into  approaching headlamps       Keep the windshield and all glass  on your vehicle clean     inside  and out    
29.   occurs first   See Engine Air  Cleaner Filter on page 9 12   for more information     Check restraint system  Make  sure the safety belt reminder  light and safety belt assemblies  are working properly  Look for  any other loose or damaged  safety belt system parts  If you  see anything that might keep  a safety belt system from  doing its job  have it repaired   Have any torn or frayed safety  belts replaced  Also see Airbag  System Check on page 1 35           Replace passenger compartment  air filter     Inspect engine accessory drive  belts  or every 48 months   whichever occurs first   Visually  inspect belt for fraying  excessive  cracks  or obvious damage   Replace belt if necessary    An Emission Control Service     Inspect for tappet noise and  engine vibration  Adjust valve  clearance to factory specifications  if necessary  or every 48 months   whichever occurs first     An Emission Control Service     Inspect fuel tank  cap  cap gasket   and lines for damage or leaks    or every 24 months  whichever  occurs first   Replace parts as  needed  An Emission Control  Service   See footnote t    Change manual transmission fluid  every 30 000 miles  48 000 km   only if your vehicle is used to tow  a trailer     11 8    Q  Change automatic transmission  fluid every 60 000 miles   96 000 km  if the vehicle is  mainly driven under one or more  of these conditions         In heavy city traffic where the  outside temperature regularly  reaches 90  F  32  C  or higher        
30.   on page 9 6 for more information  on location     Engine Overheating    A coolant temperature gage is  located on the vehicle s instrument  panel  See Engine Coolant  Temperature Gage on page 4 19     Check to see if the electric engine  cooling fan is running  If the engine  is overheating  the fan should be  running  If it is not  the vehicle  needs service        If no problem is apparent  but the  coolant level is not at or above the  FULL mark  add a 50 50 mixture   of clean  drinkable water and  DEX COOL   coolant at the coolant  recovery tank  See Engine Coolant  on page 9 18 for more information  about the proper coolant mixture     If the coolant inside the coolant  recovery tank is boiling  do not do  anything else until it cools down   The vehicle should be parked on  a level surface     If Steam Is Coming From Your  Engine       Z  CAUTION       Steam from an overheated engine  can burn you badly  even if you  just open the hood  Stay away  from the engine if you see or hear  steam coming from it  Just turn it  off and get everyone away from  the vehicle until it cools down  Wait  until there is no sign of steam or  coolant before you open the hood     If you keep driving when your  engine is overheated  the liquids  in it can catch fire  You or others  could be badly burned  Stop your  engine if it overheats  and get out  of the vehicle until the engine   is cool                 Vehicle Service and Care    Notice  If the engine catches fire  because of being dr
31.   parts as well as open seams  holes   loose connections  or other  conditions which could cause a heat  build up in the floor pan or could   let exhaust fumes into the vehicle   See Engine Exhaust on page 8 16     Fuel System Inspection    Inspect the complete fuel system for  damage or leaks     Engine Cooling System  Inspection    Inspect the hoses and have them  replaced if they are cracked  swollen  or deteriorated  Inspect all pipes   fittings and clamps  replace as  needed  Clean the outside of the  radiator and air conditioning  condenser  To help ensure proper  operation  a pressure test of   the cooling system and pressure  cap is recommended at least once  a year        Service and Maintenance    Throttle System  Inspection    Inspect the throttle system for  interference or binding  and for  damaged or missing parts   Replace parts as needed   Replace any components that    have high effort or excessive wear     Do not lubricate accelerator and  cruise control cables        11 17    Brake System Inspection    Inspect the complete system   Inspect brake lines and hoses for  proper hook up  binding  leaks   cracks  chafing  etc  Inspect disc  brake pads for wear and rotors for  surface condition  Inspect other  brake parts  including calipers   parking brake  etc  You may need  to have your brakes inspected more  often if your driving habits or  conditions result in frequent braking     11 18 Service and Maintenance    Part D  Recommended Fluids and Lubricants  Flui
32.   rear seating position  study the  instructions that came with the child  restraint to make sure it is compatible  with this vehicle     If the child restraint has the LATCH  system  see Lower Anchors and  Tethers for Children  LATCH    on page 1 44 for how to install the  child restraint using LATCH  If a  child restraint is secured in a seating  position using a safety belt and it  uses a top tether  see Lower  Anchors and Tethers for Children   LATCH  on page 1 44 for top tether  anchor locations     Do not secure a child restraint   in a position without a top tether  anchor if a national or local   law requires that the top tether be  anchored  or if the instructions  that come with the child restraint  say that the top strap must be  anchored        In Canada  the law requires that  forward facing child restraints have  a top tether  and that the tether   be attached     If the child restraint does not have  the LATCH system  you will be using  the safety belt to secure the child  restraint in this position  Be sure to  follow the instructions that came  with the child restraint  Secure the  child in the child restraint when   and as the instructions say     If more than one child restraint  needs to be installed in the   rear seat  be sure to read Where to  Put the Restraint on page 1 43     1  Put the child restraint on the seat     2  Pick up the latch plate  and  run the lap and shoulder portions  of the vehicle   s safety belt  through or around the restraint   Th
33.   suddenly  causing a crash   Use only radial ply tires with  the wheels on the vehicle                       Vehicles that have a tire pressure  monitoring system could give   an inaccurate low pressure warning  if tires not recommended for the  vehicle are installed  Tires that do  not match the original equipment  tires could give a low pressure  warning that is higher or lower  than the proper warning level you  would get with original equipment  tires  See Tire Pressure Monitor  System on page 9 48     The vehicle   s original equipment  tires are listed on the Tire and  Loading Information Label  See  Loading the Vehicle on page 8 32   for more information about the  Tire and Loading Information label  and its location on the vehicle     9 56    Different Size Tires and  Wheels    If you add wheels or tires that are  a different size than your original  equipment wheels and tires  this  may affect the way your vehicle  performs  including its braking   ride and handling characteristics   stability  and resistance to rollover   Additionally  if your vehicle has  electronic systems such as  antilock  brakes  traction control  and  electronic stability control  the  performance of these systems  can be affected     Vehicle Service and Care       Z  CAUTION       If you add different sized   wheels  your vehicle may not  provide an acceptable level of  performance and safety if tires not  recommended for those wheels  are selected  You may increase  the chance that you will
34.   the child correctly  In a crash  the  child could be seriously injured or  killed  Install a LATCH type child  restraint properly using the  anchors  or use the vehicle   s  safety belts to secure the  restraint  following the instructions  that came with the child restraint  and the instructions in this          manual              Z  CAUTION    Z  CAUTION          Do not attach more than one child  restraint to a single anchor   Attaching more than one child  restraint to a single anchor could  cause the anchor or attachment to  come loose or even break during  a crash  A child or others could  be injured  To reduce the risk of  serious or fatal injuries during a  crash  attach only one child  restraint per anchor        Children can be seriously injured  or strangled if a shoulder belt is  wrapped around their neck and  the safety belt continues to  tighten  Buckle any unused safety  belts behind the child restraint so  children cannot reach them  Pull  the shoulder belt all the way out  of the retractor to set the lock  if  your vehicle has one  after the  child restraint has been installed        Seats and Restraints 1 47    Do not fold the empty rear seat  with a safety belt buckled  This  could damage the safety belt or  the seat  Unbuckle and return the  safety belt to its stowed position     1  Attach and tighten the lower             Notice  Do not let the LATCH  attachments rub against the  vehicle   s safety belts  This may  damage these parts  If necessary   mo
35.   the vehicle safe       Turn on the Hazard Warning  Flashers on page 4 3       Tie ared cloth to an outside  mirror     Driving and Operating       CAUTION  Continued     CAUTION  Continued           Z  CAUTION       Snow can trap engine exhaust  under the vehicle  This may cause  exhaust gases to get inside   Engine exhaust contains carbon  monoxide  CO  which cannot be  seen or smelled  It can cause  unconsciousness and even death      Continued                 If the vehicle is stuck in the snow      Clear away snow from  around the base of your  vehicle  especially any that  is blocking the exhaust pipe      Check again from time to  time to be sure snow does  not collect there      Open a window about  two inches on the side of  the vehicle that is away from  the wind to bring in fresh air      Fully open the air outlets  on or under the instrument  panel      Adjust the Climate Control  system to a setting that  circulates the air inside  the vehicle and set the fan  speed to the highest setting   See Climate Control System  in the Index      Continued     For more information about  carbon monoxide  see Engine  Exhaust on page 8 16     Snow can trap exhaust gases  under your vehicle  This can  cause deadly CO  carbon  monoxide  gas to get inside  CO  could overcome you and kill you   You cannot see it or smell it  so  you might not know it is in your  vehicle  Clear away snow from  around the base of your vehicle   especially any that is blocking the  exhaust         
36.   the word AIRBAG   will appear on the side of the  seatback closest to the door     With roof rail airbags  the word  AIRBAG will appear along the  headliner or trim     Airbags are designed to supplement  the protection provided by safety  belts  Even though today   s airbags  are also designed to help reduce  the risk of injury from the force   of an inflating bag  all airbags   must inflate very quickly to do   their job     1 22 Seats and Restraints    Here are the most important things  to know about the airbag system        Z  CAUTION    Z  CAUTION          Z  CAUTION       You can be severely injured or  killed in a crash if you are not  wearing your safety belt     even if  you have airbags  Airbags are  designed to work with safety  belts  but do not replace them   Also  airbags are not designed to  deploy in every crash  In some  crashes safety belts are your only  restraint  See When Should an  Airbag Inflate  on page 1 24     Wearing your safety belt during a  crash helps reduce your chance  of hitting things inside the vehicle  or being ejected from it  Airbags  are    supplemental restraints    to  the safety belts  Everyone in your  vehicle should wear a safety belt  properly     whether or not there is  an airbag for that person           Airbags inflate with great force   faster than the blink of an eye   Anyone who is up against  or very  close to  any airbag when it  inflates can be seriously injured or  killed  Do not sit unnecessarily  close to the airba
37.   unless the shift lever is in  P  Park       Prevent movement of the shift  lever out of P  Park   unless  the ignition is in ON RUN and  the brake pedal is applied     The shift lock release is always  functional except in the case of  an uncharged or low voltage   less than 9 volt  battery     If the vehicle has an uncharged  battery or a battery with low voltage   try charging or jump starting the  battery  See Jump Starting on   page 9 71 for more information     To shift out of P  Park  use the  following     1  Apply the brake pedal     2  Move the shift lever to the  desired position     If you still are unable to shift out of  P  Park     1  Fully release the shift lever    2  Hold the brake pedal down     3  Move the shift lever to the  desired position     If you still cannot move the shift  lever from P  Park   consult your  dealer retailer or a professional  towing service        Driving and Operating    Parking the Vehicle   Manual Transmission     Before you get out of the vehicle   move the shift lever into R  Reverse    and firmly apply the parking brake   Once the shift lever has been placed  into R  Reverse  with the clutch  pedal pressed in  you can turn the  ignition key to LOCK OFF  remove  the key and release the clutch     If you are parking on a hill  or if  the vehicle is pulling a trailer  see  Towing a Trailer on page 9 77        8 15    Evaporation Pump    The vehicle is equipped with   a vacuum pump for the fuel  evaporation system  This pump  pe
38.   you do not want  You would not  be able to start your vehicle  and  the bad grounding could damage  the electrical systems        9 71    To avoid the possibility of the  vehicles rolling  set the parking  brake firmly on both vehicles  involved in the jump start  procedure  Put an automatic  transmission in P  Park  or   a manual transmission in  NEUTRAL before setting   the parking brake     Notice  If you leave the radio   or other accessories on during  the jump starting procedure  they  could be damaged  The repairs  would not be covered by the  warranty  Always turn off   the radio and other accessories  when jump starting the vehicle     3  Turn off the ignition on both  vehicles  Unplug unnecessary  accessories plugged into the  cigarette lighter  Turn off the radio  and all lamps that are not needed   This will avoid sparks and help  save both batteries  And it could  save the radio     9 72 Vehicle Service and Care    4  Open the hoods and locate the  batteries  Find the positive      and negative       terminal  locations on each vehicle  See  Engine Compartment Overview  on page 9 6 for more information  on location        CAUTION  Continued           Z  CAUTION       An electric fan can start up even  when the engine is not running  and can injure you  Keep hands   clothing and tools away from any  underhood electric fan           Z  CAUTION       Using a match near a battery can  cause battery gas to explode    People have been hurt doing this   and some have 
39.  2  Turn the bulb socket  counterclockwise and pull  it out of the lamp assembly           3  Pull the old bulb straight out of  the bulb socket     4  Push the new bulb straight in  until it clicks     5  Push the bulb socket into  the lamp assembly and turn  clockwise to secure it in  its original location     Taillamps       A  Turn Signal Lamp    B  Stoplamp Sidemarker  Lamp Taillamp    C  Back up Lamp       To replace one of these lamps   1  Open the liftgate        Passenger Side       Vehicle Service and Care 9 33       Driver Side    2  Remove the storage  compartment cover in the rear  cargo area of the vehicle to  access the bulbs     3  Turn the bulb socket  counterclockwise and pull it out     9 34         Pull the bulb straight out of the  socket       Push the new bulb straight in  until it clicks to secure       Push the bulb socket in and turn  it clockwise to secure       Reinstall the cover        Vehicle Service and Care    License Plate Lamp    To replace the license plate  lamp bulb        1  Press the tabs in to disengage  them and remove the license  plate lamp assembly             Turn the bulb socket    counterclockwise to remove it  from the license plate assembly       Pull the bulb straight out of    the bulb socket       Push the new bulb straight in the    bulb socket until it clicks       Push the bulb socket straight into    the license plate assembly and  turn it clockwise to secure it       Reinstall the license plate    assembly into its ori
40.  Available Cargo  Weight   0 Ibs  0 kg      Refer to your vehicle   s Tire  and Loading Information label  for specific information about  the vehicle   s capacity weight  and seating positions        The combined weight of the  driver  passengers  and cargo  should never exceed the  vehicle   s maximum vehicle  capacity weight     Certification Label    MFD  BY  Fil Sl aa thls    07 02  iB RA LE  FNS VE   Fi    THEFT PREV  51  THE DATE OF MANUFACTURE SHOWN ABOVE     PASS CAR       Label Example    A vehicle specific Certification  label is attached to the center  pillar  near the driver   s door  latch  It tells you the gross  weight capacity of your vehicle   called the Gross Vehicle  Weight Rating  GVWR      The GVWR includes the weight  of the vehicle  all occupants  fuel   and cargo  Never exceed the  GVWR for the vehicle  or the  Gross Axle Weight Rating   GAWR  for either the front   or rear axle     And  if you do have a heavy  load  you should spread it out   See    Steps for Determining  Correct Load Limit    earlier in  this section     Notice  Overloading your  vehicle may cause damage   Repairs would not be covered  by your warranty  Do not  overload your vehicle     If you put things inside your  vehicle     like suitcases    tools  packages  or anything  else     they will go as fast as the  vehicle goes  If you have to stop  or turn quickly  or if there is a  crash  they will keep going     Driving and Operating    8 35       CAUTION  Continued           Z  CA
41.  CD may not play properly or at   all  Do not touch the bottom side of  a CD while handling it  this could  damage the surface  Pick up CDs  by grasping the outer edges or   the edge of the hole and the   outer edge        To clean a CD  use a soft lint free  cloth  or dampen a clean soft cloth  in a mild neutral detergent solution  mixed with water  Wipe the CD from  the center to the edge     Care of The CD Player    Use a marking pen to identify CDs   do not add labels     Do not use CD lens cleaners  they  could damage the CD player     Notice  If a label is added to a CD   or more than one CD is inserted  into the slot at a time  or an  attempt is made to play scratched  or damaged CDs  the CD player  could be damaged  While using  the CD player  use only CDs in  good condition without any label   load one CD at a time  and keep  the CD player and the loading slot  free of foreign materials  liquids   and debris     If an error displays  see    CD  Messages    later in this section        Playing an MP3 CD R Disc    Radios with the MP3 feature are  capable of playing an MP3 CD R  disc  For more information on how to  play an MP3 CD R disc  see Using  an MP3 later in this section     CD Messages    If the CD ejects  it could be for  one of the following reasons       The CD player is very hot   When the temperature returns to  normal  the CD should play       The road is very rough  When  the road becomes smoother   the CD should play       The CD is dirty  scratched  wet
42.  Customer Assistance  Information  Courtesy    Transportation       12 4  12 10  Customer Assistance    OCES eian 12 4  Customer Satisfaction  Procedure  1    12 1    Customer Assistance Information     cont    GM Mobility  Reimbursement  Program ses riiai aans 12 5  Reporting Safety Defects  to General Motors          12 16    Reporting Safety Defects   to the Canadian   Government                  12 15  Reporting Safety Defects   to the United States    Government                  12 15  Roadside Assistance  Progra  eii ans 12 5    Service Publications  Ordering Information       12 16    D  Daytime Running Lamp            5 2  Defensive Driving                   8 17  DISC  MPS aiin aE 6 9  Doing Your Own  Service Work n se 9 4  Dome Lamps 2        sssseseserererserer 5 3       Door  Ajar Light 43k 4 24  LOCKS o airnet iaeei 2 6  Power Door Locks                2 7    Rear Door Security Locks      2 7  Driver Storage Compartment      3 3  Driving    AE NIONE succederede 8 26  Before a Long Trip             8 28  Defensive       u          sssesseseerseneer 8 17  Dr  nk  r 255 aksen 8 18  Highway Hypnosis              8 28    Hill and Mountain Roads      8 28  In Rain and on Wet    Roads  3214 labels ita 8 27  Rocking Your Vehicle to  Get it OU seers 8 31  VA AT 9    Tore tese REE ERE LEES ERR 8 29  E  PDR aiaee eee 12 17  Electrical System  Add On Equipment              9 35  Engine Compartment  Fuse Block                0655 9 39  Fuses and Circuit  Breakers 1    9 36   
43.  In hilly or mountainous terrain        When doing frequent trailer  towing        Uses such as found in taxi   police  or delivery service     If you do not use your vehicle  under any of these conditions  the  fluid does not require changing   See Part D  Recommended Fluids  and Lubricants on page 11 18   for the proper fluid to use     65 000 Miles 104 000 km     Q Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service        Service and Maintenance    Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See footnote        Q Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     70 000 Miles  112 000 km     Q Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53  for proper rotation pattern  and additional information    See footnote        Q Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary        75 000 Miles  120 000 km     Q Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See footnote        Q  Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are drivi
44.  N  Neutral   In this position  the  engine does not connect with   the wheels  To restart the engine  when the vehicle is already moving   use N  Neutral  only  Also  use   N  Neutral  when the vehicle   is being towed        Z  CAUTION       Shifting into a drive gear while the  engine is running at high speed is  dangerous  Unless your foot is  firmly on the brake pedal  the  vehicle could move very rapidly   You could lose control and hit  people or objects  Do not shift  into a drive gear while the engine  is running at high speed                 Driving and Operating 8 9    Notice  Shifting out of P  Park   or N  Neutral  with the engine  running at high speed may  damage the transmission  The  repairs would not be covered by  the vehicle warranty  Be sure  the engine is not running at high  speed when shifting the vehicle     D  Drive   This position is for  normal driving  It provides the best  fuel economy from the vehicle   If you need more power for  passing  and you are     Going less than 35 mph   55 km h   push the accelerator  pedal about halfway down       Going about 35 mph  55 km h     or more  push the accelerator  all the way down     8 10    Driver Shift Control  DSC     DSC mode allows you to choose  the top gear limit of the vehicle s  transmission and the vehicle s speed  while driving down hill or towing a  trailer  To use this feature  do the  following     1  Move the shift lever from  D  Drive  left to S  Shift Control      While driving in this mo
45.  Service  and Care    Service   GEVE orne adledes 9 2  Accessories and   Modifications                        1 1W  1 1 1     9 3  California Proposition   65 Warning  California Perchlorate   Materials Requirements      9 3  Doing Your Own   Service Work  nsee 9 4  Adding Equipment to the    Outside of the Vehicle        9 4  Owner Checks   Owner Checks             0 0eee 9 5  Hood Release             eseeeeeee 9 5  Engine Compartment   Overview        eeceeceeeeeeeee eee 9 6  Engine Oil                  9 9    Engine Air Cleaner Filter     9 12       Vehicle Service and Care    Automatic Transmission    o E vires cteesealanaies 9 14  Manual Transmission   im  UT  oe Seite Ree ates 9 16  Hydraulic Clutch                  9 17  Cooling System           2 5 9 18  Engine Coolant                   9 18  Pressure Cap            0cceee 9 22  Engine Overheating             9 22  Power Steering Fluid           9 24    Windshield Washer Fluid    9 24  Windshield Wiper Blade    Replacement                005 9 25  Braks o orangeri 9 27  Battery aeea en lende 9 30   Headlamp Aiming  Headlamp Aiming                9 30  Bulb Replacement   Bulb Replacement               9 31  Halogen Bulbs                    9 31  Headlamps and Parking   LAMPS ur deigendiwiseecensnas 9 31  Taillamps  eseese 9 33  License Plate Lamp            9 34  Replacement Bulbs             9 35       Electrical System  Add On Electrical    Equipment                00006    Headlamp Wiring    Windshield Wiper Fuses  
46.  Turn   the pressure cap slowly  counterclockwise until it first  stops  Do not press down while  turning the pressure cap        9 21       If you hear a hiss  wait for that  to stop  A hiss means there  is still some pressure left       Keep turning the pressure cap     but now push down while turning   Remove the pressure cap       Fill the radiator with the proper    coolant mixture  up to the base  of the filler neck  For more  information about the proper  coolant mixture look earlier in  this section     9 22    4  Then fill the coolant recovery  tank to the FULL mark     5  Put the cap back on the coolant  recovery tank  but leave the  pressure cap off     6  Start the engine and let it run  until you can feel the upper  radiator hose getting hot  Watch  out for the engine cooling fan     7  By this time  the coolant level  inside the radiator filler neck may  be lower  If the level is lower   add more of the proper coolant  mixture through the filler neck  until the level reaches the base  of the filler neck     8  Then replace the pressure cap   At any time during this procedure  if coolant begins to flow out of  the filler neck  reinstall the  pressure cap  Be sure the ears  on the pressure cap are in  line with the vent tube        Vehicle Service and Care    Pressure Cap    Notice  If the pressure cap is not  tightly installed  coolant loss and  possible engine damage may  occur  Be sure the cap is properly  and tightly secured     See Engine Compartment Overview
47.  Wheel Retainer Nut    Jack Handle     Wheel Wrench       mM   00O0W0 gt        Vehicle Service and Care    To remove the spare tire and tools        1  Turn the two lock knobs on the    cargo area floor  C  to UNLOCK     2  Lift up and remove the both  of the cargo area floors  C         9 63       3  Remove the hook holding the  jack  B  and remove the jack  B      4  Remove the jack handle  E   and wheel wrench  F  from  the passenger side of the  cargo area     9 64       5  Remove the tire wheel  retainer  D  from the compact  spare tire  A  and remove  the compact spare tire  A    See Compact Spare Tire on  page 9 70     6  Place the compact spare tire  A   next to the flat tire        Vehicle Service and Care    Removing the Flat Tire  and Installing the  Spare Tire    1  Do a safety check before  proceeding  See Changing  a Flat Tire on page 9 62     2  If the vehicle has steel wheels  with plastic wheel nut caps   loosen the plastic wheel  nut caps  You may need the  wheel wrench to loosen them   Do not pry off wheel covers that  have plastic wheel nut caps     3  Remove the wheel cover and set  it off to the side     4  Attach the jack handle to the jack  and turn clockwise to raise the  lift head a little           5  Loosen all the wheel nuts   Do not remove them yet        6  Position the jack and raise the  jack lift head to fit over the car    flange between the two notches     Vehicle Service and Care 9 65       Z  CAUTION       Getting under a vehicle when it
48.  When adding  be sure to fill to the approximate level  as recommended in this  manual        Engine Specifications     Engine   Vin Code Spark Plug Gap    Automatic R  pe         Automatic i  Manual 0 043 in  1 10 mm    10 4 Technical Data    Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts    Maintenance Replacement Parts  Replacement parts identified below by name  part number  or specification can be obtained from your dealer retailer     GM Part Numbers Other Part Numbers    Engine Air Cleaner Filter    1 8L L4 Engine   2 4L L4 Engine  Engine Oil Filter   1 8L L4 Engine    2 4L L4 Engine  Passenger Compartment Air Filter    Spark Plugs      1 8L L4 Engine 19185438 SK20HR11t    2 4L L4 Engine 88969636 ROM tt     Oil Filter Element Kit includes element and seal       The engine is fitted with iridium tipped spark plugs  Use only iridium tipped spark plugs for better engine  performance    t DENSO   tt NGK       Engine Drive Belt  Routing       1 8L L4 Engine    The 1 8L L4 engine drive belt  requires the use of a special kind  of tool to service  See your  dealer retailer for service           2 4L L4 Engine       Technical Data    10 5    10 6 Technical Data    4 NOTES    Service and  Maintenance    Service and Maintenance    Introduction              11 1  Maintenance   Requirements  2    11 2  Your Vehicle and the  Environment               1 1  1       1      11 2  How This Section is   Organized eisein  11 2    Part A  Scheduled  Maintenance Services        11 3  Using the Mainte
49.  a  track  Release to resume playing the  track  Press and hold V to reverse  playback quickly within a track   Release to resume playing the track     BAND  Press to listen to the radio  when a CD is playing        Infotainment 6 7    CD AUX  CD Auxiliary   Press to  play a CD when listening to the radio     Press the CD AUX button again and  the system begins playing audio from  the connected portable audio player   If a portable audio player is not  connected     No Input Device Found     displays     See    Using the Auxiliary Input Jack     later in this section     INFO  Information   Press to  switch the display between the  track number  elapsed time of the  track  and the time  When the  ignition is off  press this button to  display the time     EQ  Equalization   Press to select  an equalization setting while playing  a CD  See    EQ    listed previously for  more information  If an EQ setting is  selected for a CD  it is activated each  time a CD is played     6 8 Infotainment    Care of CDs    The sound quality of the CD player  can be reduced because of       The CD R quality       The method of recording  the CD R       The quality of the music that has  been recorded on the CD R       The way the CD R has been  handled     Store CD R s  in their original cases  or other protective cases and   away from dust and direct sunlight   The CD player scans the bottom  surface of the disc  If the surface  of a CD is damaged  such as  cracked  broken  or scratched  the 
50.  addition  your vehicle has a  passenger sensing system which   is designed to turn off the right front  passenger frontal and seat mounted  side impact airbag under certain  conditions  See Passenger Sensing  System on page 1 28 and  Passenger Airbag Status Indicator  on page 4 15 for more information   including important safety  information     Seats and Restraints       A label on the sun visor says    Never put a rear facing child seat  in the front     This is because the risk  to the rear facing child is so great    if the airbag deploys        Z  CAUTION       A child in a rear facing child  restraint can be seriously injured or  killed if the right front passenger  airbag inflates  This is because  the back of the rear facing child  restraint would be very close to  the inflating airbag  A child in a  forward facing child restraint can  be seriously injured or killed if the  right front passenger airbag  inflates and the passenger seat is  in a forward position      Continued                 CAUTION  Continued           Even if the passenger sensing  system has turned off the right  front passenger frontal airbag  no  system is fail safe  No one can  guarantee that an airbag will not  deploy under some unusual  circumstance  even though it is  turned off     Secure rear facing child restraints  in a rear seat  even if the airbag is  off  If you secure a forward facing  child restraint in the right front seat   always move the front passenger  seat as far back as it w
51.  and Windows       Manual Windows    Turn the crank on the door to open  and close a manual window     Power Windows       Z  CAUTION          Leaving children in a vehicle with  the keys is dangerous for many  reasons  children or others could  be badly injured or even killed   They could operate the power  windows or other controls or  even make the vehicle move   The windows will function and  they could be seriously injured or  killed if caught in the path of a  closing window  Do not leave  keys in a vehicle with children     When there are children in the  rear seat use the window lockout  button to prevent unintentional  operation of the windows                 On vehicles with this feature  the  power windows only work when the  ignition is turned to ON RUN or   in Retained Accessory Power   RAP   See Retained Accessory  Power  RAP  on page 8 4     Switches on the driver door control  the driver and passenger windows   Each passenger door has a  switch to control that window     Press or pull the front of a switch to  lower or raise a window        Keys     AUTO  Express Down   Press all  the way down and release to lower  the driver window automatically   Pull up at any time to stop the  window from lowering     oe  Lock Out   Press the lock out  button  located on the driver   door  to disable the passenger  power windows and again to  enable them     Only the driver window can be  operated when the lock out feature  is used     Sun Visors    Pull the visor toward y
52.  and a proper  coolant              Notice  In cold weather  water  can freeze and crack the engine   radiator  heater core and other  parts  Use the recommended  coolant and the proper coolant  mixture     How to Add Coolant to the  Radiator    When the coolant in the coolant  recovery tank is at the FULL mark   start the vehicle     If the overheat warning continues   there is one more thing that can  be done  Add the proper coolant  mixture directly to the radiator but  be sure the cooling system is  cool before you do it     Vehicle Service and Care       Z  CAUTION    Z  CAUTION          Steam and scalding liquids from a  hot cooling system can blow out  and burn you badly  They are  under pressure  and if you turn the  radiator pressure cap     evena  little     they can come out at high  speed  Never turn the cap when  the cooling system  including the  radiator pressure cap  is hot  Wait  for the cooling system and radiator  pressure cap to cool if you ever  have to turn the pressure cap        Turning the radiator pressure cap  when the engine and radiator are  hot can allow steam and scalding  liquids to blow out and burn you  badly  With the coolant recovery  tank  you will almost never have  to add coolant at the radiator   Never turn the radiator pressure  cap     even a little     when the  engine and radiator are hot                    1     Remove the pressure cap when  the cooling system  including the  pressure cap and upper radiator  hose  is no longer hot 
53.  and comparable equipment     Insuring Your Vehicle    Protect your investment in your  GM vehicle with comprehensive  and collision insurance coverage   There are significant differences  in the quality of coverage afforded  by various insurance policy terms        Many insurance policies provide  reduced protection to your GM  vehicle by limiting compensation  for damage repairs by using  aftermarket collision parts    Some insurance companies will not  specify aftermarket collision   parts  When purchasing insurance   we recommend that you assure  your vehicle will be repaired with  GM original equipment collision  parts  If such insurance coverage is  not available from your current  insurance carrier  consider switching  to another insurance carrier     If your vehicle is leased  the leasing  company may require you to   have insurance that assures   repairs with Genuine GM Original  Equipment Manufacturer  OEM   parts or Genuine Manufacturer  replacement parts  Read your lease  carefully  as you may be charged  at the end of your lease for   poor quality repairs     If a Crash Occurs    Here is what to do if you are  involved in a crash     e Check to make sure that you are  all right  If you are uninjured   make sure that no one else in  your vehicle  or the other vehicle   is injured      lf there has been an injury  call  emergency services for help    Do not leave the scene of a crash  until all matters have been taken   care of  Move your vehicle only if  its posit
54.  and some component  wear by products contain and or  emit these chemicals        California Perchlorate  Materials Requirements    Certain types of automotive  applications  such as airbag  initiators  seat belt pretensioners   and lithium batteries contained in  remote keyless transmitters  may  contain perchlorate materials   Special handling may be necessary   For additional information  see  www dtsc ca gov hazardouswaste   perchlorate     9 4 Vehicle Service and Care    Doing Your Own  Service Work       Z  CAUTION       You can be injured and the  vehicle could be damaged if you  try to do service work on a vehicle  without knowing enough about it      Be sure you have sufficient  knowledge  experience  the  proper replacement parts  and  tools before attempting any  vehicle maintenance task      Be sure to use the proper  nuts  bolts  and other  fasteners  English and  metric fasteners can be  easily confused  If the wrong  fasteners are used  parts  can later break or fall off    You could be hurt                 If doing some of your own service  work  use the proper service manual   It tells you much more about how to  service the vehicle than this manual  can  To order the proper service  manual  see Service Publications  Ordering Information on page 12 16     This vehicle has an airbag system   Before attempting to do your   own service work  see Servicing  Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle   on page 1 33     Keep a record with all parts receipts  and list the mileage
55.  and the date   of any service work performed    See Part E  Maintenance Record  on page 11 20        Adding Equipment to the  Outside of the Vehicle    Things added to the outside of   the vehicle can affect the airflow  around it  This can cause wind noise  and can affect fuel economy and  windshield washer performance   Check with your dealer retailer  before adding equipment to   the outside of the vehicle     Owner Checks       Z  CAUTION       An electric fan under the hood  can start up and injure you even  when the engine is not running   Keep hands  clothing  and tools  away from any underhood  electric fan           Z  CAUTION       Things that burn can get on hot  engine parts and start a fire  These  include liquids like fuel  oil  coolant   brake fluid  windshield washer and  other fluids  and plastic or rubber   You or others could be burned    Be careful not to drop or spill  things that will burn onto a hot  engine                 Vehicle Service and Care 9 5    Hood Release  To open the hood     1        Pull the release handle  located  below the instrument panel to  the left of the steering wheel        2  From the front of the vehicle   pull up on the secondary  hood release located near  the middle of the hood     3  Lift the hood     4  Release the hood prop rod from  its retainer and insert into the slot   moving it straight up  If it is moved  to the side or toward the inside  of the vehicle  it may become  detached     Before closing the hood  be sure
56.  battery   Always turn off electrical  equipment when not in use and  do not plug in equipment that  exceeds the maximum amperage  rating     This circuit is protected by a fuse  and has a maximum current level   Do not use equipment exceeding  the maximum amperage rating     Certain power accessory plugs may  not be compatible to the power  accessory outlet and could result   in a blown vehicle or adapter   fuse  See your dealer retailer for  additional information on the power  accessory plugs        Notice  Adding any electrical  equipment to the vehicle can  damage it or keep other  components from working as  they should  The repairs would  not be covered by the vehicle  warranty  Do not use equipment  exceeding maximum amperage  rating of 20 amperes  Check  with your dealer retailer before  adding electrical equipment     When adding electrical equipment   be sure to follow the proper  installation instructions included  with the equipment     Notice  Improper use of the  power outlet can cause damage  not covered by the warranty   Do not hang any type of  accessory or accessory bracket  from the plug because the  power outlets are designed for  accessory power plugs only     4 10    Power Outlet 115 Volt  Alternating Current    Electrical equipment with a  maximum limit of 115 VAC can be  plugged into this power outlet  If the  equipment used requires more than  the limit  a protection circuit will   cut the power supply  The power  automatically restarts when  equipme
57.  be injured  and both  the vehicle and the trailer can be  damaged  When possible  always  park the rig on a flat surface              To park your rig on a hill     1  Apply your regular brakes  but  do not shift into P  Park  for an  automatic transmission or into  gear for a manual transmission   yet  When parking uphill  turn  your wheels away from the curb   When parking downhill  turn your  wheels into the curb     2  Have someone place chocks  under the trailer wheels        Vehicle Service and Care    3  When the chocks are in place   release the regular brakes until  the chocks absorb the load    4  Reapply the regular brakes   Then apply your parking  brake and shift into P  Park   for an automatic transmission  or R  Reverse  for a manual  transmission     5  Release the regular brakes   When You Are Ready to Leave  After Parking on a Hill    1  Apply your regular brakes and  hold the pedal down while you       start your engine      shift the transmission  into gear    e release the parking brake  2  Let up on the brake pedal     3  Drive slowly until the trailer is  clear of the chocks     4  Stop and have someone pick up  and store the chocks        Maintenance When Trailer  Towing    Your vehicle will need service more  often when you are pulling a trailer   See the Maintenance Schedule   for more on this  Things that are  especially important in trailer  operation are automatic transmission  fluid  do not overfill   engine oil  drive  belt  cooling system and 
58.  code helps  identify the vehicle   s engine   specifications  and replacement  parts  See    Engine Specifications     under Capacities and Specifications  on page 10 2 for your vehicle   s  engine code        Service Parts  Identification Label  This label is on the inside of the  glove box  It is very helpful if  you ever need to order parts   The label has the following  information       Vehicle Identification  Number  VIN       Model designation    Paint information      Production options and special  equipment    Do not remove this label from the  vehicle     10 2 Technical Data    Capacities and Specifications    The following approximate capacities are given in English and metric conversions  Please refer to Part D   Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 11 18 for more information     ms     engin   were      For the air conditioning system refrigerant charge   amount  see the refrigerant caution label located   under the hood  See your dealer retailer for more  information     Air Conditioning Refrigerant R134a    Cooling System    1 8L L4 Engine 5 8 qt  2 4L L4 Engine 6 0 qt    Engine Oil with Filter    1 8L L4 Engine  2 4L L4 Engine   Fuel Tank 50L   Transmission  Automatic  Complete Drain and Refill   1 8L L4 Engine  2 4L L4 Engine       Technical Data 10 3    FE  Serene Engish      Transmission  Manual  Complete Drain and Refill     1 8L L4 Engine 2 0 qt 1 9L    2 4L L4 Engine 2 6 qt 2 5L  Wheel Nut Torque 76 Ib ft 103 Nem    All capacities are approximate 
59.  common  types of recreational vehicle towing       Vehicle Service and Care    are known as    dinghy towing     towing  your vehicle with all four wheels on  the ground  and    dolly towing      towing your vehicle with two wheels  on the ground and two wheels up on  a device known as a    dolly         With the proper preparation and  equipment  many vehicles can be  towed in these ways  See    Dinghy  Towing    and    Dolly Towing      following     Here are some important things to  consider before you do recreational  vehicle towing       What is the towing capacity  of the towing vehicle   Be sure you read the tow  vehicle manufacturer   s  recommendations       How far will you tow  Some    vehicles have restrictions on how  far and how long they can tow        9 75      Do you have the proper towing  equipment  See your dealer   retailer or trailering professional  for additional advice and  equipment recommendations       Is your vehicle ready to be towed   Just as you would prepare your  vehicle for a long trip  you will  want to make sure your vehicle  is prepared to be towed  See     Before Leaving On A Long Trip     in the Index     Dinghy Towing   If your vehicle has an automatic  transmission  it cannot be dinghy  towed  See    Dolly Towing    for    more information regarding  towing your vehicle     If your vehicle has a manual  transmission  it can be dinghy  towed     9 76    Vehicle Service and Care       When dinghy towing  be sure to    follow the poste
60.  could void  authorization to use this equipment     Tire Pressure Monitor  Operation    The Tire Pressure Monitor System   TPMS  warns the driver when a low  tire pressure condition exists  TPMS  sensors are mounted onto each tire  and wheel assembly  excluding the  spare tire and wheel assembly        Vehicle Service and Care    When a low tire pressure condition  is detected  the low tire pressure  warning light  located on the  instrument panel cluster  comes on     This light also comes on for a   few seconds and then goes off when  you turn the ignition to ON RUN   This indicates the TPMS is  functioning properly  If the low tire  pressure warning light comes on  while driving the vehicle  the system  may have detected a low tire  condition  You need to stop as soon  as possible and check the tires     The low tire pressure warning light  may come on in cool weather when  the vehicle is first started  and   then turn off as you start to drive        This could be an early indicator that  the air pressure in the tire s  are  getting low and need to be inflated  to the proper pressure     A Tire and Loading Information  label  attached to the vehicle  shows  the size of the vehicle   s original  equipment tires and the correct  inflation pressure for the tires when  they are cold  See Loading the  Vehicle on page 8 32  for an  example of the Tire and Loading  Information label and its location on  your vehicle  Also see Inflation   Tire  Pressure on page 9 47     The vehi
61.  crash and  suffer serious injury  Only use GM  specific wheel and tire systems  developed for your vehicle  and  have them properly installed by   a GM certified technician                 See Buying New Tires on page 9 54  and Accessories and Modifications  on page 9 3 for additional  information        Uniform Tire Quality  Grading    Quality grades can be found  where applicable on the tire  sidewall between tread shoulder  and maximum selection width   For example     Treadwear 200 Traction AA  Temperature A    The following information relates  to the system developed by the  Unites States National Highway  Traffic Safety Administration   NHTSA   which grades tires   by treadwear  traction  and  temperature performance    This applies only to vehicles   sold in the United States     The grades are molded on   the sidewalls of most passenger  car tires  The Uniform Tire  Quality Grading  UTQG   system does not apply to deep  tread  winter type snow tires   space saver  or temporary use  spare tires  tires with nominal  rim diameters of 10 to 12 inches   25 to 30 cm   or to some  limited production tires     While the tires available on  General Motors passenger  cars and light trucks may vary  with respect to these grades   they must also conform to  federal safety requirements        Vehicle Service and Care    Treadwear    The treadwear grade is a  comparative rating based on the  wear rate of the tire when tested  under controlled conditions on   a specified governmen
62.  different  positions     To shift out of P  Park   turn the  ignition to ON RUN and apply  the brake pedal        Notice  Using a tool to force the  key to turn in the ignition could  cause damage to the switch or  break the key  Use the correct key   make sure it is all the way in  and  turn it only with your hand  If the  key cannot be turned by hand   see your dealer retailer     LOCK OFF  This is the only position  from which you can remove the key   This locks the steering wheel   ignition and automatic transmission   Push in the ignition switch as you  turn the key toward you     On vehicles with an automatic  transmission  the shift lever must be  in P  Park  to turn the ignition switch  to the LOCK OFF position     A warning tone will sound if the driver  door is opened with the key in the  ignition    The ignition switch can bind in the  LOCK OFF position with your wheels  turned off center  If this happens   move the steering wheel from right   to left while turning the key to  ACC ACCESSORY  If this doesn   t  work  then the vehicle needs service           Z  CAUTION       On manual transmission vehicles   turning the key to LOCK OFF and  removing it will lock the steering  column and result in a loss of  ability to steer the vehicle    This could cause a collision    If you need to turn the engine   off while the vehicle is moving   turn the key only to ACC   ACCESSORY  Do not push the  key in while the vehicle is moving              ACC ACCESSORY  This position 
63.  e Keep your eyes moving   especially during turns or curves     No one can see as well at night as  in the daytime  But  as we get older   these differences increase    A 50 year old driver might need at  least twice as much light to see the  same thing at night as a 20 year old     Driving in Rain and on  Wet Roads    Rain and wet roads can reduce  vehicle traction and affect your  ability to stop and accelerate   Always drive slower in these types  of driving conditions and avoid  driving through large puddles and  deep standing or flowing water        Z  CAUTION    Driving and Operating       CAUTION  Continued        Flowing or rushing water creates  strong forces  Driving through  flowing water could cause your  vehicle to be carried away  If this  happens  you and other vehicle  occupants could drown  Do not  ignore police warnings and be  very cautious about trying to  drive through flowing water              Wet brakes can cause crashes   They might not work as well in  a quick stop and could cause  pulling to one side  You could  lose control of the vehicle     After driving through a large  puddle of water or a car vehicle  wash  lightly apply the brake  pedal until the brakes work  normally      Continued                 Hydroplaning    Hydroplaning is dangerous  Water  can build up under your vehicle   s  tires so they actually ride on the  water  This can happen if the road  is wet enough and you are going  fast enough  When your vehicle is  hydroplaning  it has
64.  ends  play continues  sequentially through all tracks  in each playlist    2  After the last track of the last  playlist ends  play restarts  from the first track of the first  playlist     CDs that do not have playlists play  the tracks in the following order     1  The first file in the root directory  plays    2  After all files from the root  directory have played  files in the  folders play     3  After playing the last file from the  last folder  play restarts with the  first file in the root directory        File System and Naming    The radio display shows  track  names that are shorter than   39 characters  Names that are  longer are shortened  The track  name appears as       The song name that is in the  ID3 tag       The file name without the file  extension if the song name is  not in the ID3 tag     Preprogrammed Playlists    Playlists are accessed before files  or folders in the root directory     Preprogrammed playlists created  by WinAmp     MusicMatch       or Real Jukebox    software can  be accessed and are treated   as special folders containing  compressed audio song files     Music Navigator    The music navigator feature lets  MP3 CDs play in order by artist or  album      The MP3 player scans the disc  to sort the files by artist and  album ID3 tag information      It can take several minutes to  scan the disc depending  on the number of MP3 files  recorded to the CD R      The radio starts playing while  the disc is being scanned       After the sca
65.  example  if the    XXX     amount equals 1400 Ibs  and there will be five 150 Ib  passengers in your vehicle   the amount of available  cargo and luggage  load capacity Is 650 Ibs   1400     750  5 x 150     650 Ibs         5  Determine the combined  weight of luggage and  cargo being loaded on the  vehicle  That weight may not  safely exceed the available  cargo and luggage load    capacity calculated in Step 4     6  If your vehicle will be towing  a trailer  the load from your  trailer will be transferred to  your vehicle  Consult this  manual to determine how this  reduces the available cargo  and luggage load capacity of  your vehicle     If your vehicle can tow a  trailer  see Towing a Trailer  on page 9 77 for important  information on towing a trailer   towing safety rules and  trailering tips     Driving and Operating 8 33             im    Msi    A B C    Example 1    A  Vehicle Capacity Weight  for Example 1   1 000 Ibs   453 kg      B  Subtract Occupant Weight  150 Ibs  68 kg  x 2   300 Ibs   136 kg     C  Available Occupant and  Cargo Weight   700 Ibs   317 kg         8 34    T    Example 2    A  Vehicle Capacity Weight for  Example 2   1 000 Ibs   453 kg     B  Subtract Occupant Weight  150 Ibs  68 kg  x 5   750 Ibs   340 kg     C  Available Cargo  Weight   250 lbs  113 kg         Driving and Operating    Example 3    A  Vehicle Capacity Weight for  Example 3   1 000 Ibs   453 kg      B  Subtract Occupant Weight  200 Ibs  91 kg  x 5   1 000 Ibs   453 kg      C 
66.  for important safety information     The instrument panel has a  passenger airbag status indicator     PASSENGER    AIRBAG AIRBAG  OFF  ONI    When the vehicle is started  the  passenger airbag status indicator  will light ON and OFF for several  seconds as a system check     Then  after several more seconds   the status indicator will light   either ON or OFF if there is weight  on the seat  to let you know the       4 15    status of the right front passenger  frontal and seat mounted side  impact airbags  if equipped     If the seat is unoccupied  the light  will not be visible after the system  check     If the word ON is lit on the  passenger airbag status indicator    it means that the right front  passenger frontal and seat mounted  side impact airbags  if equipped   are enabled  may inflate      If the word OFF is lit on the  passenger airbag status indicator  it  means that the passenger sensing  system has turned off the right  front passenger   s frontal airbag and  seat mounted side impact airbag    if equipped   See Passenger  Sensing System on page 1 28 for  more on this  including important  safety information     4 16    If  after several seconds  all status  indicator lights remain on  there  may be a problem with the lights or  the passenger sensing system   See your dealer retailer for service        Z  CAUTION       If the airbag readiness light in the  instrument panel cluster ever  comes on and stays on  it means  that something may be wrong with  the a
67.  get a copy of the  report for a nominal fee  In some  states provinces with    no fault     insurance laws  a report may not  be necessary  This is especially  true if there are no injuries and  both vehicles are driveable     12 14      Choose a reputable collision  repair facility for your vehicle   Whether you select a dealer   retailer or a private collision repair  facility to fix the damage  make  sure you are comfortable with  them  Remember  you will have to  feel comfortable with their work for  a long time       Once you have an estimate  read  it carefully and make sure you  understand what work will be  performed on your vehicle  If you  have a question  ask for an  explanation  Reputable shops  welcome this opportunity        Customer Information    Managing the Vehicle Damage  Repair Process    In the event that your vehicle  requires damage repairs  GM  recommends that you take an active  role in its repair  If you have a  pre determined repair facility   of choice  take your vehicle there   or have it towed there  Specify to  the facility that any required  replacement collision parts be  original equipment parts  either  new Genuine GM parts or recycled  original GM parts  Remember   recycled parts will not be covered  by your GM vehicle warranty     Insurance pays the bill for the repair   but you must live with the repair   Depending on your policy limits   your insurance company may  initially value the repair using  aftermarket parts        Discuss this 
68.  heavy  the brakes may not work  well or even at all  The driver and  passengers could be seriously     Continued                 Vehicle Service and Care       CAUTION  Continued        injured  The vehicle may also be  damaged  the resulting repairs  would not be covered by the  vehicle warranty  Pull a trailer only  if all the steps in this section have  been followed  Ask your  dealer retailer for advice and  information about towing a trailer  with the vehicle              Your vehicle can tow a trailer if it   is equipped with the proper trailer  towing equipment  To identify the  vehicle trailering capacity of your  vehicle  you should read the  information in    Weight of the Trailer     that appears later in this section   Trailering is different than just driving  your vehicle by itself  Trailering  means changes in handling        9 77    acceleration  braking  durability and  fuel economy  Successful  safe  trailering takes correct equipment   and it has to be used properly     That is the reason for this part    In it are many time tested  important  trailering tips and safety rules  Many  of these are important for your safety  and that of your passengers    So please read this section   carefully before you pull a trailer     Load pulling components such as  the engine  transmission  wheel  assemblies and tires are forced to  work harder against the drag of  the added weight  The engine   is required to operate at relatively  higher speeds and under greater  lo
69.  if the vehicle is  mainly driven under one or  more of these conditions         In heavy city traffic where the  outside temperature regularly  reaches 90  F  32  C  or  higher         In hilly or mountainous terrain      When doing frequent trailer  towing        Uses such as found in taxi   police  or delivery service     If you do not use your vehicle under  any of these conditions  the fluid  does not require changing    See Part D  Recommended Fluids  and Lubricants on page 11 18   for the proper fluid to use     11 12    Service and Maintenance    150 000 Miles  240 000 km     Q Drain  flush  and refill the cooling  system  or every 5 years   whichever occurs first     This service can be complex    you should have your dealer   retailer perform this service    See Engine Coolant on page 9 18  for what to use  Inspect hoses   Clean radiator  condenser   pressure cap  and neck  Pressure  test cooling system and pressure  cap  An Emission Control Service        Part B  Owner Checks  and Services    These owner checks and services  should be performed at the intervals  specified to help ensure vehicle  safety  dependability  and emission  control performance     Be sure any necessary repairs are  completed at once  Whenever   any fluids or lubricants are added to  the vehicle  make sure they are    the proper ones  as shown in Part D     At Each Fuel Fill    It is important to perform these  underhood checks at each fuel fill     Engine Oil Level Check    Notice  It is im
70.  is completely full       Do not use engine coolant   antifreeze  in your windshield  washer  It can damage the  vehicle   s windshield washer  system and paint        Vehicle Service and Care    Windshield Wiper Blade  Replacement    Front Windshield Wiper    Windshield wiper blades should be  inspected at least twice a year for  wear or cracking  See At Least  Twice a Year on page 11 13     Replacement blades come in  different types and are removed  in different ways  To remove  the wiper blade        1  Pull the windshield wiper arm  away from the windshield        9 25       Call   a    2  Push the release lever and slide  the wiper assembly toward the  driver side of the vehicle     9 26 Vehicle Service and Care       3  Slide the new wiper assembly  into place     4  Push the release lever down to  lock into place        Rear Windshield Wiper       1  Disengage the two pins and  disconnect the rear wiper arm  by pulling them up        Ifa    2  Raise the wiper arm until it  comes off   You will hear a clicking sound  when the arm comes off        3  Push the rear wiper assembly    straight into the rear wiper arm     4  Reengage the two pins to the  rear wiper arm by pushing  them down        Vehicle Service and Care 9 27    Brakes  Brake Fluid    The brake master cylinder and    on manual transmission vehicles   the clutch hydraulic system use the  same reservoir  The reservoir is  filled with DOT 3 brake fluid        There are only two reasons why  the brake fluid le
71.  is no occupant in that  position     The passenger sensing system  works with sensors that are part of  the right front passenger seat    The sensors are designed to detect       the presence of a properly seated  occupant and determine if the  right front passenger frontal airbag  and seat mounted side impact  airbag  if equipped  should   be enabled  may inflate  or not     According to accident statistics   children and infants are safer when  properly restrained in a child  restraint system or infant restraint  system secured in a rear seating  position     We recommend that children be  secured in a rear seat  including  an  infant or a child riding in a  rear facing child restraint  a child  riding in a forward facing child seat   an older child riding in a booster  seat  and children  who are   large enough  using safety belts     A label on the sun visor says    Never put a rear facing child seat  in the front     This is because the risk  to the rear facing child is so great    if the airbag deploys        Z  CAUTION    CAUTION  Continued           A child in a rear facing child  restraint can be seriously injured or  killed if the right front passenger  airbag inflates  This is because  the back of the rear facing child  restraint would be very close to  the inflating airbag  A child ina  forward facing child restraint can  be seriously injured or killed if  the right front passenger airbag  inflates and the passenger seat  is in a forward position     Even if the 
72.  lever into another gear  See  Shifting Out of Park on page 8 14     R  Reverse   Use this gear to  back up     Notice  Shifting to R  Reverse   while the vehicle is moving  forward could damage the  transmission  The repairs would  not be covered by the vehicle  warranty  Shift to R  Reverse   only after the vehicle is stopped     To rock the vehicle back and   forth to get out of snow  ice or sand  without damaging the transmission   see  f Your Vehicle is Stuck in  Sand  Mud  Ice  or Snow on   page 8 31        N  Neutral   In this position  the  engine does not connect with the  wheels  To restart the vehicle when  it is already moving  use N  Neutral   only  Also  use N  Neutral  when the  vehicle is being towed        Z  CAUTION       Shifting into a drive gear while the  engine is running at high speed is  dangerous  Unless your foot is  firmly on the brake pedal  the  vehicle could move very rapidly   You could lose control and hit  people or objects  Do not shift  into a drive gear while the engine  is running at high speed              Notice  Shifting out of P  Park   or N  Neutral  with the engine  running at high speed may  damage the transmission  The  repairs would not be covered by  the vehicle warranty  Be sure  the engine is not running at high  speed when shifting the vehicle        Driving and Operating 8 7    D  Drive   This position is for  normal driving  It provides the best  fuel economy  If you need more  power for passing  and you are       Going les
73.  little or no  contact with the road        8 27    There is no hard and fast rule about  hydroplaning  The best advice is  to slow down when the road is wet     Other Rainy Weather Tips    Besides slowing down  other wet  weather driving tips include     Allow extra following distance   Pass with caution    Keep windshield wiping  equipment in good shape    Keep the windshield washer fluid  reservoir filled    Have good tires with proper tread  depth  See Tires on page 9 41   Turn off cruise control  if  equipped     8 28    Before Leaving on a  Long Trip   To prepare your vehicle for a long  trip  consider having it serviced    by your dealer retailer before  departing     Things to check on your own  include     Windshield Washer Fluid   Reservoir full  Windows   clean     inside and outside   Wiper Blades  In good shape   Fuel  Engine Oil  Other Fluids  All  levels checked     Lamps  Do they all work and are  lenses clean     Tires  Are treads good  Are  tires inflated to recommended  pressure     Weather and Maps  Safe to  travel  Have up to date maps        Driving and Operating    Highway Hypnosis    Always be alert and pay attention  to your surroundings while driving   If you become tired or sleepy  find  a safe place to park your vehicle  and rest     Other driving tips include       Keep the vehicle well ventilated     e Keep interior temperature cool     e Keep your eyes moving     scan  the road ahead and to the sides       Check the rearview mirror and  vehicle 
74.  longer brake life        8 19    If your vehicle   s engine ever stops  while you are driving  brake normally  but do not pump the brakes  If you  do  the pedal could get harder to  push down  If the engine stops  you  will still have some power brake  assist  But you will use it when you  brake  Once the power assist is used  up  it can take longer to stop and the  brake pedal will be harder to push     Adding non dealer non retailer  accessories can affect your vehicle   s  performance  See Accessories  and Modifications on page 9 3     8 20    Antilock Brake  System  ABS     Your vehicle has the Antilock  Brake System  ABS   an advanced  electronic braking system that   will help prevent a braking skid     When you start the engine and  begin to drive away  ABS will check  itself  You might hear a momentary  motor or clicking noise while this test  is going on  and you might even  notice that the brake pedal moves a    little  This is normal     Canada    ABS    United States    If there is a problem with ABS   this warning light will stay on   See Antilock Brake System  ABS   Warning Light on page 4 18        Driving and Operating    Let us say the road is wet and you  are driving safely  Suddenly  an  animal jumps out in front of you    You slam on the brakes and continue  braking  Here is what happens   with ABS     A computer senses that the wheels  are slowing down  If one of the  wheels is about to stop rolling    the computer will separately work  the brakes at eac
75.  meet under the Federal Motor    Vehicle Service and Care    Vehicle Safety Standard No  109     Grades B and A represent higher  levels of performance on the  laboratory test wheel than the  minimum required by law        Z  WARNING       The temperature grade for this  tire is established for a tire  that is properly inflated and  not overloaded  Excessive  speed  underinflation  or  excessive loading  either  separately or in combination   can cause heat buildup and  possible tire failure                    Wheel Alignment and  Tire Balance    The tires and wheels on your vehicle  were aligned and balanced carefully  at the factory to give you the longest  tire life and best overall performance   Adjustments to wheel alignment and  tire balancing will not be necessary  on a regular basis  However  if you  notice unusual tire wear or your  vehicle pulling to one side or the  other  the alignment might need to be  checked  If you notice your vehicle  vibrating when driving on asmooth  road  the tires and wheels might  need to be rebalanced  See your  dealer retailer for proper diagnosis     Wheel Replacement  Replace any wheel that is bent     cracked or badly rusted or corroded     If wheel nuts keep coming loose   the wheel  wheel bolts and wheel  nuts should be replaced  If the  wheel leaks air  replace it  except  some aluminum wheels  which can  sometimes be repaired   See your  dealer retailer if any of these  conditions exist     Your dealer retailer will know the  ki
76.  need to replace other parts       The vehicle has a crash sensing  and diagnostic module which  records information after a crash   See Vehicle Data Recording and  Privacy on page 12 17 and Event  Data Recorders on page 12 17       Let only qualified technicians work  on the airbag systems  Improper  service can mean that an airbag  system will not work properly  See  your dealer retailer for service        1 28    Seats and Restraints    Passenger Sensing  System    The vehicle has a passenger  sensing system for the right front  passenger position  The passenger  airbag status indicator will be  visible in the instrument panel when  the vehicle is started           The words ON and OFF will be  visible during the system check   When the system check is complete   either the word ON or the word  OFF will be visible depending on       whether the seat is occupied and or  the weight of the occupant  If the  seat is unoccupied  the light will not  be visible after the system check   See Passenger Airbag Status  Indicator on page 4 15     The passenger sensing system will  turn off the right front passenger  frontal airbag and seat mounted  side impact airbag under certain  conditions  The driver airbags   and the roof rail airbags are not  affected by the passenger sensing  system     The passenger sensing system will  also turn off the right front passenger  frontal airbag  seat mounted side  impact airbag  if equipped   and  safety belt pretensioner if it detects  that there
77.  off   the cruise control      Step on the brake pedal or push  the clutch pedal  if the vehicle  has a manual transmission      Press the ON OFF button       Pull the cruise control lever  toward you     Erasing Speed Memory    The cruise control set speed memory  is erased when the cruise control or  the ignition is turned off     Turn and Lane Change  Signals     gt     An arrow on the instrument panel  cluster flashes in the direction of the  turn or lane change     Move the lever all the way up or  down to signal a turn     Raise or lower the lever until the  arrow starts to flash to signal a lane  change  Hold it there until the   lane change is completed     The lever returns to its starting  position whenever it is released     If after signaling a turn or a   lane change the arrow flashes  rapidly or does not come on    a signal bulb may be burned out     Have the bulbs replaced  If the bulb  is not burned out  check the fuse   See Fuses and Circuit Breakers   on page 9 36        Instruments and Controls    Headlamp High   Low Beam Changer    The headlamps must be on for this  feature to work     Push the turn signal lever away  from you to turn the high beams on     This instrument panel cluster light   D comes on while the high beam  headlamps are on     Pull the lever towards you to return  to low beams     Flash to Pass    This feature is used to signal to the  vehicle ahead that you want to pass   With the lever in the low beam  position  pull the lever toward y
78.  off when the ignition is shifted to  ON RUN or HOLD  M is pressed  again  The ignition must be in  LOCK OFF or ACC ACCESSORY  for the alarm to work        Programming Transmitters  to the Vehicle    Only RKE transmitters programmed  to this vehicle will work  Ifa  transmitter is lost or stolen  a  replacement can be purchased   and programmed through your  dealer retailer  When the  replacement transmitter is  programmed to this vehicle  all  remaining transmitters must also be  reprogrammed  Any lost or stolen  transmitters will no longer work once  the new transmitter is programmed   Each vehicle can have up to four  transmitters programmed to it     Battery Replacement    The battery in the transmitter is  weak and should be changed if it  does not work at the normal range  in any location     Notice  When replacing the  battery  do not touch any of the  circuitry on the transmitter   Static from your body could  damage the transmitter        Keys  Doors and Windows    To replace the battery  use a flat   thin non metal object or  tape wrapped metal object     1  Separate the transmitter        2  Remove the module           3  Open the module cover   4  Remove the old battery     2 5    2 6 Keys  Doors and Windows       5  Insert the new battery   positive     side facing up   Replace with a CR2025 or  equivalent battery     6  Snap the module back together    and replace it in the transmitter     7  Snap the front and back of the  transmitter together     Doors and Lock
79.  often     Do not wash the vehicle in direct  sunlight  Use a car washing soap     Notice  Certain cleaners contain  chemicals that can damage the  emblems or nameplates on your  vehicle  Check the cleaning  product label  If it states that it  should not be used on plastic  parts  do not use it on your vehicle  or damage may occur and it would  not be covered by the warranty        Vehicle Service and Care    Do not use cleaning agents that are  petroleum based or that contain acid  or abrasives  as they can damage  the paint  metal or plastic on your  vehicle  Approved cleaning products  can be obtained from your dealer   retailer  Follow all manufacturers   directions regarding correct product  usage  necessary safety precautions  and appropriate disposal of any  vehicle care product     Rinse the vehicle well  before  washing and after to remove all  cleaning agents completely  If they  are allowed to dry on the surface   they could stain     Dry the finish with a soft  clean  chamois or an all cotton towel to  avoid surface scratches and  water spotting        9 87    High pressure car washes may  cause water to enter the vehicle   Avoid using high pressure washes  closer than 12 inches  30 cm  to  the surface of the vehicle  Use of  power washers exceeding 1 200 psi   8 274 kPa  can result in damage or  removal of paint and decals     Weatherstrips    Silicone grease on weatherstrips will  make them last longer  seal better   and not stick or squeak  Apply  silicone gre
80.  provides power to some of the  electrical accessories  It unlocks the  steering wheel and ignition  To move  the key from ACC ACCESSORY to  LOCK OFF  push in the key and then  turn it to LOCK OFF     A warning tone will sound when   the driver door is opened when the  ignition is still in ACC ACCESSORY  or LOCK OFF and the key is in the  ignition     Driving and Operating 8 3    ON RUN  The ignition switch stays  in this position when the engine is  running  This position can be used to  operate the electrical accessories   including the ventilation fan and   115 volt power outlet  as well as to  display some warning and indicator  lights  The transmission is also  unlocked in this position on  automatic transmission vehicles     The battery could be drained   if you leave the key in the ACC   ACCESSORY or ON RUN position  with the engine off  You may not be  able to start the vehicle if the battery  is allowed to drain for an extended  period of time     START  This position starts the  engine  When the engine starts   release the key  The ignition switch  will return to ON RUN for normal  driving        8 4    Retained Accessory  Power  RAP     These vehicle accessories may be  used for less than a minute after  the engine is turned off      Power Windows  if equipped     Sunroof  if equipped    The power windows and sunroof  will continue to work for less than a  minute or until either front door is  opened  The radio will work when  the key is in ON RUN or ACC   ACCESSOR
81.  reaction time  First  you  have to decide to push on the brake  pedal  That is perception time  Then  you have to bring up your foot and do  it  That is reaction time     Average reaction time is about  three fourths of a second  But that  is only an average  It might be less  with one driver and as long as two or  three seconds or more with another   Age  physical condition  alertness   coordination  and eyesight all play   a part  So do alcohol  drugs  and  frustration  But even in three fourths  of a second  a vehicle moving at   60 mph  100 km h  travels 66 feet   20 m   That could be a lot of  distance in an emergency  so  keeping enough space between  your vehicle and others is important        Driving and Operating    And  of course  actual stopping  distances vary greatly with the  surface of the road  whether it is  pavement or gravel  the condition of  the road  whether it is wet  dry  or icy   tire tread  the condition of the brakes   the weight of the vehicle  and the  amount of brake force applied     Avoid needless heavy   braking  Some people drive   in spurts     heavy acceleration  followed by heavy braking     rather  than keeping pace with traffic    This is a mistake  The brakes might  not have time to cool between hard  stops  The brakes will wear out much  faster if you do a lot of heavy braking   If you keep pace with the traffic   and allow realistic following  distances  you will eliminate a lot of  unnecessary braking  That means  better braking and
82.  recall  liability prior to the completion of the  vehicle   s useful life  We  however   urge that all recommended  maintenance services be performed  at the indicated intervals and the  maintenance be recorded          A good time to check your brakes  is during tire rotation  See Brake  System Inspection on page 11 17     5 000 Miles  8 000 km    Q Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission Control  Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See footnote        Q  Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     10 000 Miles  16 000 km     Q Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Service and Maintenance 11 5    Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection    and Rotation on page 9 53  for proper rotation pattern  and additional information    See footnote        Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     15 000 Miles  24 000 km   QO Change engine oil and filter     or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See footnote        Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions
83.  recommend that you use an  SAE OW 20 oil  SAE OW 20 oil  provides easier cold starting and  better protection for the engine  at extremely low temperatures     Engine Oil Additives   Engine  Oil Flushes    Do not add anything to the oil   The recommended oils with the  starburst symbol that meet GM  Standard GM6094M are all you  need for good performance and  engine protection     Engine oil system flushes are not  recommended and could cause  engine damage not covered by the  vehicle warranty     When to Change Engine Oil    Change the oil and filter   every 5 000 miles  8 000 km  or   3 months  whichever occurs first   See Scheduled Maintenance on   page 11 4        9 11    What to Do with Used Oil    Used engine oil contains certain  elements that can be unhealthy for  your skin and could even cause  cancer  Do not let used oil stay on  your skin for very long  Clean your  skin and nails with soap and water   or a good hand cleaner  Wash or  properly dispose of clothing or rags  containing used engine oil  See the  manufacturer   s warnings about the  use and disposal of oil products     Used oil can be a threat to the  environment  If you change your own  oil  be sure to drain all the oil from the  filter before disposal  Never dispose  of oil by putting it in the trash  pouring  it on the ground  into sewers  or into  streams or bodies of water  Recycle  it by taking it to a place that collects  used oil     9 12    Engine Air Cleaner Filter    The engine air cleaner fi
84.  road     Treadwear Indicators  Narrow  bands  sometimes called wear  bars  that show across the tread  of a tire when only 1 16 inch   1 6 mm  of tread remains    See When It Is Time for New  Tires on page 9 54     UTQGS  Uniform Tire Quality  Grading Standards   A tire  information system that provides  consumers with ratings for a  tire   s traction  temperature    and treadwear  Ratings are  determined by tire manufacturers  using government testing  procedures  The ratings are  molded into the sidewall of the  tire  See Uniform Tire Quality  Grading on page 9 56     Vehicle Capacity Weight    The number of designated  seating positions multiplied   by 150 Ibs  68 kg  plus the rated  cargo load  See Loading the  Vehicle on page 8 32     Vehicle Maximum Load on the  Tire  Load on an individual tire  due to curb weight  accessory  weight  occupant weight  and  cargo weight     Vehicle Placard  A label  permanently attached to   a vehicle showing the vehicle s  capacity weight and the  original equipment tire size  and recommended inflation  pressure  See    Tire and  Loading Information Label     under Loading the Vehicle   on page 8 32        Vehicle Service and Care    Inflation   Tire Pressure    Tires need the correct amount  of air pressure to operate  effectively     Notice  Do not let anyone tell  you that under inflation or  over inflation is all right  It is  not  If your tires do not have  enough air  under inflation    you can get the following         Too much f
85.  sidewall     The examples show a typical  passenger vehicle tire and a  compact spare tire sidewall     A on a  OR16  ee say PS    2a        Passenger  P Metric  Tire  Example        A  Tire Size  The tire size   is a combination of letters and  numbers used to define a  particular tire   s width  height   aspect ratio  construction type   and service description  See the     Tire Size    illustration later in this  section for more detail      B  DOT  Department of  Transportation   The  Department of Transportation   DOT  code indicates that the tire  is in compliance with the U S   Department of Transportation  Motor Vehicle Safety Standards      C  Tire Identification Number   TIN   The letters and numbers  following DOT  Department of  Transportation  code is the Tire  Identification Number  TIN   The  TIN shows the manufacturer and  plant code  tire size  and date the  tire was manufactured  The TIN  is molded onto both sides of the  tire  although only one side may  have the date of manufacture         D  Tire Ply Material  The type  of cord and number of plies   in the sidewall and under   the tread      E  Uniform Tire Quality  Grading  UTQG   Tire  manufacturers are required   to grade tires based on three  performance factors  treadwear   traction  and temperature  resistance  For more information  see Uniform Tire Quality Grading  on page 9 56      F  Maximum Cold Inflation  Load Limit  Maximum load  that can be carried and the  maximum pressure needed  to suppor
86.  the  brake or clutch hydraulic system   the brakes or clutch might not  work well  This could cause a  crash  Always use the proper  brake fluid                 Notice     Using the wrong fluid can  badly damage brake or clutch  hydraulic system parts    For example  just a few drops  of mineral based oil  such as  engine oil  in the brake or clutch  hydraulic system can damage  brake or clutch hydraulic  system parts so badly that they  will have to be replaced  Do not  let someone put in the wrong  kind of fluid     If brake fluid is spilled on the  vehicle   s painted surfaces  the  paint finish can be damaged   Be careful not to spill brake  fluid on the vehicle  If you do   wash it off immediately  See  Exterior Cleaning on page 9 86     Brake Wear    This vehicle has disc brakes    Disc brake pads have built in wear  indicators that make a high pitched  warning sound when the brake  pads are worn and new pads are  needed  The sound can come   and go or be heard all the time  the vehicle is moving  except when  applying the brake pedal firmly        Z  CAUTION       The brake wear warning sound  means that soon the brakes will  not work well  That could lead to  an accident  When the brake wear  warning sound is heard  have the  vehicle serviced              Notice  Continuing to drive  with worn out brake pads could  result in costly brake repair        Vehicle Service and Care    Some driving conditions or climates  can cause a brake squeal when the  brakes are first 
87.  the  procedure outlined in Steps One  and Two  General Motors of Canada  Limited wants you to be aware of  its participation in a no charge  Mediation Arbitration Program   General Motors of Canada Limited  has committed to binding  arbitration of owner disputes  involving factory related vehicle  service claims  The program  provides for the review of the facts  involved by an impartial third   party arbiter  and may include an  informal hearing before the arbiter   The program is designed so   that the entire dispute settlement  process  from the time you file  your complaint to the final  decision  should be completed in  approximately 70 days  We believe  our impartial program offers  advantages over courts in most  jurisdictions because it is informal   quick  and free of charge        Customer Information    For further information concerning  eligibility in the Canadian Motor  Vehicle Arbitration Plan  CAMVAP    call toll free 1 800 207 0685  or call  the General Motors Customer  Communication Centre   1 800 263 3777  English    1 800 263 7854  French   or   write to     Mediation Arbitration Program   c o Customer Communication Centre  General Motors of Canada Limited  Mail Code  CA1 163 005   1908 Colonel Sam Drive   Oshawa  Ontario L1H 8P7    Your inquiry should be accompanied  by the Vehicle Identification  Number  VIN         12 3    Online Owner Center     United States only     The Owner Center is a resource  for your GM ownership needs   Specific vehicle infor
88.  the  radio     Press the CD AUX button again and  the system begins playing audio  from the connected portable audio  player  If a portable audio player   is not connected     No Input Device  Found    displays     6 12 Infotainment  RDM  Random   Press the button    below the RDM label to hear  the tracks in random order      lt      Previous Folder   Press  the button below to go to the  first track in the previous folder      gt   Next Folder   Press  the button below to go to the first  track in the next folder         Music Navigator   Press the  button below to play MP3 files in  order by artist or album     SORT  Press the button below the  SORT label to change between  playback by artist or aloum while  using the Music Navigator     BACK  Press the button below the  BACK label to return to the main  music navigator screen      lt  gt   Previous Next   Press the  button below to go to the next   or previous artist or album in  alphabetical order while using  the Music Navigator                    XM Radio Messages    XL  Explicit Language Channels    These channels  or any others  can  be blocked at a customer s request   by calling 1 800 852 XMXM  9696      Updating  The encryption code  in the receiver is being updated   and no action is required  This  process should take no longer  than 30 seconds     No Signal  The system is  functioning correctly  but the vehicle  is in a location that is blocking   the XM    signal  When the vehicle  is moved into an open area 
89.  the  release button in as you move the  lever all the way down     Notice  Driving with the parking  brake on can overheat the brake  system and cause premature wear  or damage to brake system parts   Make sure that the parking brake  is fully released and the brake  warning light is off before driving        If you are towing a trailer  see  Towing a Trailer on page 9 77     Shifting Into Park    Driving and Operating 8 13    To shift into P  Park   do the  following     1  Hold the brake pedal down  and set the parking brake   See Parking Brake on page 8 12       Z  CAUTION    for more information        It can be dangerous to get out of  the vehicle if the shift lever is not  fully in P  Park  with the parking  brake firmly set  The vehicle can  roll  If you have left the engine  running  the vehicle can move  suddenly  You or others could be  injured  To be sure the vehicle will  not move  even when you are on  fairly level ground  use the steps  that follow  If you are pulling a  trailer  see Towing a Trailer on  page 9 77        2  Move the shift lever into P  Park   by pushing the lever all the way  toward the front of the vehicle  and to the left     3  Turn the ignition key to  LOCK OFF     4  Remove the key and take it with  you  If you can leave the vehicle  with the key in your hand  the  vehicle is in P  Park               8 14    Leaving Your Vehicle  With the Engine Running   Automatic Transmission        Z  CAUTION       It can be dangerous to leave the  vehi
90.  the  signal should return     Loading XM  The audio system is  acquiring and processing audio  and text data  No action is needed   This message should disappear  shortly        CH Off Air  This channel is not  currently in service  Tune to another  channel     CH Unavail  This previously  assigned channel is no longer  assigned  Tune to another station    If this station was one of the presets   choose another station for that  preset button     No Info  No artist  song title   category  or text information is  available at this time on this channel   The system is working properly     No Info  No text or informational  messages are available at this time  on this channel  The system is  working properly     Not Found  There are no channels  available for the selected category   The system is working properly     XM Locked  The XM    receiver in  your vehicle may have previously  been in another vehicle  For security  purposes  XM    receivers cannot  be swapped between vehicles  If this  message is received after having  your vehicle serviced  check   with your dealer retailer     Radio ID  If tuned to channel 0   this message alternates with  the XM    Radio eight digit radio  ID label  This label is needed   to activate the service     Unknown  If this message is  received when tuned to channel 0   there may be a receiver fault   Consult with your dealer retailer     Chk XMRevr  If this message does  not clear within a short period of  time  the receiver may have a fault
91.  the malfunction indicator is  illuminated  the system may not be  able to detect or signal low tire  pressure as intended  TPMS  malfunctions may occur for a variety  of reasons  including the installation  of replacement or alternate tires or  wheels on the vehicle that prevent  the TPMS from functioning properly   Always check the TPMS malfunction  telltale after replacing one or more  tires or wheels on your vehicle to  ensure that the replacement or       9 49    alternate tires and wheels allow the  TPMS to continue to function    properly   See Tire Pressure Monitor    Operation on page 9 50 for  additional information     Federal Communications  Commission  FCC  and  Industry and Science Canada    The Tire Pressure Monitor  System  TPMS  operates on   a radio frequency and complies  with Part 15 of the FCC Rules   Operation is subject to the  following two conditions     1  This device may not cause  harmful interference     2  This device must accept any  interference received  including  interference that may cause  undesired operation     9 50    The TPMS operates on a radio  frequency and complies with  RSS 210 of Industry and Science  Canada  Operation is subject to  the following two conditions     1  This device may not cause  interference     2  This device must accept any  interference received  including  interference that may cause    undesired operation of the device     Changes or modifications to  this system by other than an  authorized service facility
92.  use of  Genuine GM parts can help maintain  your GM New Vehicle Warranty     12 12    Recycled original equipment parts  may also be used for repair  These  parts are typically removed from  vehicles that were total losses in  prior crashes  In most cases  the  parts being recycled are from  undamaged sections of the vehicle   A recycled original equipment GM  part  may be an acceptable choice to  maintain your vehicle s originally  designed appearance and safety  performance  however  the history of  these parts is not known  Such parts  are not covered by your GM New  Vehicle Limited Warranty  and any  related failures are not covered by  that warranty     Aftermarket collision parts are also  available  These are made by  companies other than GM and  may not have been tested for your  vehicle  As a result  these parts  may fit poorly  exhibit premature  durability corrosion problems    and may not perform properly in  subsequent collisions  Aftermarket  parts are not covered by your       Customer Information    GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty   and any vehicle failure related to  such parts are not covered by that  warranty     Repair Facility    We recommend that you choose   a collision repair facility that   meets your needs before you   ever need collision repairs    Your dealer retailer may have a  collision repair center with  GM trained technicians and state of  the art equipment  or be able to  recommend a collision repair center  that has GM trained technicians 
93.  valve stem facing up        6  Attach the other end of the  straps to the cargo hooks     5  Pass the straps through the 7  Position the tire edge against the   center hole of the wheel  rear center end of the floor panel   Pull the end of the straps to make  sure the tire is secure     Store the compact spare tire  properly after use        3  Use the tire tie down straps  located under the floor panel  to secure the flat tire           9 70       Return the jack and tools to the left  side of the compartment after use        Vehicle Service and Care    Compact Spare Tire    The compact spare tire was fully  inflated when the vehicle was new   it can lose air after a time  Check  the inflation pressure regularly    It should be 60 psi  414 kPa      After installing the compact spare  on your vehicle  you should stop as  soon as possible and make sure  your spare tire is correctly inflated   The compact spare is intended to  perform well at speeds up to 50 mph   80 km h   so you can finish your trip  and have your full size tire repaired  or replaced where you want  Replace  your spare with a full size tire as  soon as you can        Notice  When the compact spare  is installed  do not take the vehicle  through an automatic car wash  with guide rails  The compact  spare can get caught on the rails  which can damage the tire  wheel  and other parts of the vehicle     Do not use your compact spare on  other vehicles     Do not mix your compact spare  tire or wheel with other w
94.  what can easily be done to help  keep the vehicle in good condition      Part C  Periodic Maintenance  Inspections    explains important  inspections that your dealer retailer  can perform for you        Part D  Recommended Fluids  and Lubricants    lists some  recommended products necessary  to help keep the vehicle properly  maintained  These products  or  their equivalents  should be used  whether you do the work yourself  or have it done        Part E  Maintenance Record    is a  place to record and keep track of  the maintenance performed on   the vehicle  Keep the maintenance  receipts  They may be needed   to qualify the vehicle for warranty  repairs        Service and Maintenance    Part A  Scheduled  Maintenance Services  In this part are scheduled  maintenance services which are    to be performed at the mileage  intervals specified     Using the Maintenance  Schedule    We want to help keep this vehicle in  good working condition  But we do    not know exactly how you will drive it     You might drive short distances only  a few times a week  Or you might  drive long distances all the time in  very hot  dusty weather  You might  use the vehicle in making deliveries   Or you might drive it to work  to do  errands  or in many other ways        11 3    Because of the different ways  people use their vehicles   maintenance needs vary  You might  need more frequent checks and  replacements  So please read the  following and note how you drive    If you have questions o
95.  will not  start after a few tries  it probably  needs service     Notice  If the jumper cables are  connected or removed in the  wrong order  electrical shorting  may occur and damage the  vehicle  The repairs would not be  covered by your warranty  Always  connect and remove the jumper  cables in the correct order   making sure that the cables do not  touch each other or other metal        Jumper Cable Removal  A  Heavy  Unpainted Metal  Engine Part  B  Good Battery  C  Dead Battery          To disconnect the jumper cables  from both vehicles  do the following     1  Disconnect the black negative        cable from the vehicle that had  the dead battery     2  Disconnect the black negative      cable from the vehicle with the  good battery     3  Disconnect the red positive      cable from the vehicle with the  good battery     4  Disconnect the red positive      cable from the other vehicle     Towing    Towing Your Vehicle    To avoid damage  the disabled  vehicle should be towed with all   four wheels off the ground  Consult  your dealer retailer or a professional  towing service if the disabled vehicle  must be towed  See Roadside  Assistance Program on page 12 5     To tow the vehicle behind another  vehicle for recreational purposes   such as behind a motorhome    see  Recreational Vehicle Towing     following     Recreational Vehicle  Towing    Recreational vehicle towing means  towing your vehicle behind another  vehicle     such as behind a   motorhome  The two most
96. 14   Fluid  Manual                     9 16  Transmission Operation    Automatic               2 055 8 6  8 8  Transmission Operation    Manual ietccccviencsadeeszenecaes 8 11  Trip Odometers               6 06 4 13  Turn and Lane Change   Signals re enan DEE 4 7  Turn Signal Multifunction   LEVET sisvevsiesesveesiscsseesesseees 4 4   U  Uniform Tire Quality  Grading osainen Eske 9 56       V  Vehicle  COMMON  222 car ra FARER ERE 8 18  LOACING snoren 8 32  Parking Your                0 8 15  Running While Parked         8 17  Vehicle Data Recording and  Priva piao er 12 17  Vehicle Identification  Number  VIN   oaeee 10 1  Service Parts Identification  tabel  oirinn 10 1  Ventilation Adjustment               7 3  MIS OS eae E deres 2 13  WwW    Warning Lights  Gages and  Indicators  Warnings    Hazard Warning Flashers      4 3  Washer Fluid  Low Warning  LGM EE E AE ETE 4 23  Wheels  Alignment and  Tire Balance                   9 58  Different Size               0    9 56    Replacement               0 00  9 59       Where to Put the Restraint       WINGOWS  elser ert   Power  GGssssssssseeeeeeeeneerrknee  Windshield    Washer     Gvssssssseeeeeeeeeereknee    Washer Fluid                  04    Wiper Blade  Replacement   Wiper Fuses    WIPGIS  sir cicaccsxatnaess    Windshield  Rear Washer   Wiper  Winter Driving                       XM Radio Messages  XM    Satellite Radio  Antenna System    Y    Your Vehicle and the  Environment                e0c0es    
97. 20 kg      The luggage compartment hooks  should only be used to hang  items under 7 Ib  3 kg      For vehicles with a cargo  management system  open the  deck lid to hang items under   5 Ib  2 3 kg      3 4 Storage    Cargo Cover    For vehicles equipped with a cargo  cover     Using the cargo cover     1  Remove the cargo cover from its  storage location     2  Unfold the cargo cover           3  Attach the hooks to the indented  slots on the sides of the rear  cargo area        4  Attach the center hook to the  center head restraint        Z  CAUTION       An improperly stored cargo cover  could be thrown about the vehicle  during a collision or sudden  maneuver  Someone could be  injured  If the cover is removed   always store it in the proper  storage location  When it is  replaced  always be sure that       it is securely reattached                 Folding the Cargo Cover     1  Hold the cargo cover with  both hands        2  Bend one side of the cover  toward the body     Storage 3 5       3  Twist the other side in the  opposite direction        4  Make a small circle  and then  fold the cover inward          Make sure the cover s three    circles are side by side       Return the cover to its    storage bag     3 6 Storage    Cargo Tie Downs    The cargo tie down straps and  hooks are intended to be used to  secure a flat tire or other items   The tie down hooks are located in  the rear cargo area  The straps  are under the rear floor panel     To use  hook the end o
98. 2009 Pontiac Vibe Owner Manual LL        Seats and Restraints           1 1  Front SeatS ow    1 2  Rear Seats ow    1 7  Safety Belts    1 8  Airbag System                8  1 21  Child Restraints               1 36   Keys  Doors and   Windows  eseese eneee 2 1  Keys rain niii nnii 2 2  Doors and Locks _             2 6    Theft Deterrent Systems     2 9    Windows           ceeeeeeeeeee es 2 12  MirrorS rer cece ee ee es 2 13  SUNrOO   serne sissa 2 14  Storage  eeste 3 1  Storage eee eee 3 1  Instruments and  Controls            eceeeeeeeneeeee ees 4 1  Instrument Panel  Overview     eccere 4 2  Warning Lights  Gages   and Indicators              4 11  OnStar   System ou    4 25       Lighting rss nale on 5 1  ohin E EE deden 5 1  Infotainment  eee 6 1  Audio System s  _              6 1  Climate Controls                 7 1  Climate Controls                  7 1  Driving and Operating         8 1  Starting and Operating  Your Vehicle    8 2  Driving Your Vehicle _       8 17  Fuel  occicssathawdanincgadens cece 8 36  Vehicle Service  and Care eee 9 1  Service  KG   dssssesseseerereereeee 9 2  Owner Checks 0  9 5  Headlamp Aiming _           9 30  Bulb Replacement _          9 31  Electrical System _            9 35  THOS    sidcutogboiatanedience diss 9 41  Tire Changing                0e 9 61       Jump Starting ou    9 71  TOWING cs eee ec ec eaeceeeeeees 9 75  Appearance Care _            9 83  Technical Data                   10 1  Vehicle Identification        10 1  
99. 6 14  Fixed Mast Antenna            6 14  XM    Satellite Radio   Antenna System                6 14       Audio System s     Determine which radio the vehicle  has and read the following pages to  become familiar with its features        Z  CAUTION       Taking your eyes off the road for  extended periods could cause   a crash resulting in injury or  death to you or others  Do not  give extended attention to  entertainment tasks while driving              This system provides access to  many audio and non audio listings        Infotainment 6 1    To minimize taking your eyes off the  road while driving  do the following  while the vehicle is parked       Become familiar with the  operation and controls of  the audio system      Set up the tone  speaker  adjustments  and preset radio  stations     For more information  see Defensive  Driving on page 8 17     6 2 Infotainment    Setting the Clock    The radio has a CLOCK button for  adjusting the time and date    The date does not automatically  display  To see the date press  CLOCK while the radio is on    The date with display times out after  a few seconds and goes back to  the normal radio and time display   To adjust the time and date     1  Turn the ignition key to  ACC ACCESSORY or ON RUN     2  Press the PWR VOL   Power Volume  knob to  turn on the radio     3  Press the CLOCK button  and  the HR  MIN  MM  DD  YYYY   hour  minute  month  day   and year  categories display     4  Press the button under the  category to 
100. A vehicle specific Tire and  Loading Information label is  attached to the vehicle   s center  pillar  B pillar   With the driver   s  door open you will find the label  attached below the door lock post   striker   The Tire and Loading  Information label shows the  number of occupant seating       positions  A   and the maximum  vehicle capacity weight  B  in  kilograms and pounds  This  weight includes the weight of   all occupants  cargo  and all  nonfactory installed options     The Tire and Loading  Information label also shows the  tire size of the original equipment  tires  C   and the recommended  cold tire inflation pressures  D    For more information on tires and  inflation see Tires on page 9 41  and Inflation   Tire Pressure on  page 9 47     There is also important loading  information on the Certification  label  It tells you the Gross  Vehicle Weight Rating  GVWR   and the Gross Axle Weight  Rating  GAWR  for the front  and rear axle  See    Certification  Label    later in this section     Steps for Determining Correct  Load Limit    1  Locate the statement   The combined weight  of occupants and cargo  should never exceed XXX kg  or XXX Ibs    on your vehicle s  placard     2  Determine the combined  weight of the driver and  passengers that will be  riding in your vehicle     3  Subtract the combined weight  of the driver and passengers  from XXX kg or XXX Ibs     4  The resulting figure equals  the available amount of cargo  and luggage load capacity   For
101. Always keep the covers on  any electrical component        Vehicle Service and Care    1 Electric  Cooling Fans   2 Electric  Cooling Fans    Antilock Braking  3 System  ABS     Vehicle Stability   Control System       9 39    ABS  Vehicle  Stability Control  System    Air Conditioning      6   Charging System    7 Electric Power  Steering       9 40    Emission Control  System Main  Horn   Ignition 2    Headlamp Main    Emission Control  System 2  Multiport Fuel  Injection System     Sequential Multiport  Fuel Injection    Driver Side  Headlamp  Passenger Side  Headlamp    Driver Side    Headlamp   Front Foglamps    Passenger Side  Low Beam  Headlamp       Vehicle Service and Care    Multiport Fuel  Injection  System Sequential  Multiport Fuel  Injection System  17 Turn Signal Lamps   Hazard Lamps    Charging System    Starting System   Multiport Fuel  Injection System   Sequential Multiport  Fuel Injection  System    Starting System   Multiport Fuel   Injection System   Sequential Multiport    Fuel Injection  System    Starting System           Immobilizer  System    Main Body ECU   Gages  Daytime  Running   Lights  DRL     Air Conditioning  System  Wireless  Remote Control   Theft Deterrent  System    Audio System    Interior Lamps   Personal Lamps     Audio System       Multiport Fuel  Injection  System Sequential  Multiport Fuel  Injection System   Horn  Emission  Control System 1   Emission Control  System 2    Multiport   Fuel Injection  System Sequential  Multiport Fu
102. CAUTION  Continued        control setting that will force  outside air into your vehicle   See Climate Control System  on page 7 1      If you have air outlets on or  under the instrument panel   open them all the way    See Engine Exhaust on  page 8 16              Unlock and open the liftgate by  inserting the key  turning it  counterclockwise and raise it  by hand           Close the liftgate by using the  handle to pull it down     Lock the liftgate by inserting the key  and turning it clockwise to the  first position     See Remote Keyless Entry  RKE   System Operation on page 2 4  for more information     Theft Deterrent  Systems    Vehicle theft is big business   especially in some cities    This vehicle has theft deterrent  features  however  they do not  make it impossible to steal     Immobilizer    This device complies with  Part 15 of the FCC Rules   Operation is subject to the  following two conditions     1  This device may not cause  interference     2  This device must accept any  interference received  including  interference that may cause  undesired operation        Keys  Doors and Windows 2 9    This device complies with  RSS 210 of Industry Canada   Operation is subject to the  following two conditions     1  This device may not cause  interference     2  This device must accept any  interference received  including  interference that may cause  undesired operation of the  device     Changes or modifications to this  system by other than an authorized  se
103. Capacities and  Specifications                 10 2  Normal Maintenance  Replacement Parts _      10 4  Service and  Maintenance                     11 1  Service and  Maintenance _               11 1  Customer Information        12 1  Customer Information          12 1  Reporting Safety  Defects            ceceeseeeee 12 15  Vehicle Data Recording  and Privacy ww    12 17  Indek sarte i 1    ii Preface    Y    PONTIAC       GENERAL MOTORS  GM  the GM  Emblem  PONTIAC  the PONTIAC  Emblem and the name VIBE  are registered trademarks of  General Motors Corporation     This manual includes the latest    information at the time it was printed     GM reserves the right to make  changes after that time without    Litho in U S A     Part No  25823089 B Second Printing       further notice  For vehicles first   sold in Canada  substitute the name   General Motors of Canada Limited     for Pontiac Division wherever it  appears in this manual     This manual describes features  that may or may not be on  your specific vehicle     Read this manual from beginning to  end to learn about the vehicle s  features and controls  Pictures   symbols  and words work together  to explain vehicle operation     Keep this manual in the vehicle for  quick reference        Canadian Owners    A French language copy of this  manual can be obtained from your  dealer retailer or from     Helm  Incorporated  P O  Box 07130  Detroit  MI 48207    1 800 551 4123  helminc com    Propri  taires Canadiens    On 
104. Control             1    1   1 1   4 23  Door Al al araberne 4 24  FOG  LAMP wise  ii lse abe 4 23  Highbeam On nsss 4 24  Lights On Reminder            4 23  Low Fuel Warning               4 25  Low Tire Pressure   Warning Light                 4 18  Low Washer Fluid   Warning cisetise ccsdcicawcnerie 4 23  Oil Pressure sidan 4 22  Passenger Airbag Status   Indicator 222 250 se see 4 15  Safety Belt Reminders         4 14  S CUTILY rer rene 4 22  Service All Wheel Drive        4 24  Speed Sensitive Power   Steering  SSPS    Warning Light                 4 18  StabiliTrak   Indicator           4 19  Taillamp Indicator                4 23  TCS Warning Light             4 19  Traction Control System    TCS  Warning                4 19   Lighting  ENV paine a T 5 3    i 6 INDEX  Lights  Exterior Lamps                4   Flash to Pass annas  High Low Beam Changer      Loading Your Vehicle  Locks  DOOM rr esser  Power Door 1       Rear Door Security Locks         Loss of Control a   se  Low Fuel Warning Light  Low Washer Fluid Warning  LINE eisereen anini  Lower Anchors and Tethers  for Children            Luggage Carrier    Maintenance Schedule   At Each Fuel Fill                 At Least Once a Month       At Least Once a Year          At Least Twice a Year   Brake System  Inspection             ee   Engine Cooling System  Inspection           cee       Maintenance Schedule  cont    Exhaust System  Inspection               0 08 11 16  Fuel System Inspection      11 16  How This 
105. Do not drive with it off  and  be careful working on the engine  with the air cleaner filter off              Notice  If the air cleaner filter   is off  a backfire can cause a  damaging engine fire  And  dirt  can easily get into the engine   which will damage it  Always have  the air cleaner filter in place when  you are driving     9 14    Automatic Transmission  Fluid    When to Check and Change  Automatic Transmission Fluid    Check the fluid in the transmission  and differential at the intervals listed  in Part A  Scheduled Maintenance  Services on page 11 3  and be   sure to use the transmission fluid  listed in Part D  Recommended  Fluids and Lubricants on   page 11 18     How to Check Automatic  Transmission Fluid    This operation can be difficult  you  may choose to have this done at the  dealer retailer service department     If you do it yourself  be sure to follow  all the instructions here  or you  could get a false reading on   the dipstick        Vehicle Service and Care    Notice  Use of the incorrect   automatic transmission fluid may   damage your vehicle  and the   damages may not be covered by   your warranty  Always use the   automatic transmission fluid   listed in Part D  Recommended   Fluids and Lubricants on   page 11 18    Wait at least 30 minutes before   checking the transmission fluid level   if you have been driving      When outside temperatures are  above 90  F  32  C       At high speed for quite a while       In heavy traffic     especially
106. ION    CAUTION  Continued           If the vehicle has P215 45R18  size tires  do not use tire chains   There is not enough clearance     Tire chains used on a vehicle  without the proper amount of  clearance can cause damage to  the brakes  suspension or other  vehicle parts  The area damaged  by the tire chains could cause you  to lose control of the vehicle and  you or others may be injured in a  crash      Continued           Use another type of traction  device only if its manufacturer  recommends it for use on the  vehicle and tire size combination  and road conditions  Follow that  manufacturer   s instructions    To help avoid damage to the  vehicle  drive slowly  readjust  or remove the device if it is  contacting the vehicle  and   do not spin the wheels     If you do find traction devices that  will fit  install them on the front  tires                       Notice  If the vehicle has a tire  size other than P215 45R18 size  tires  use tire chains only where  legal and only when you must   Use only SAE Class    S    type  chains that are the proper size for  the tires  Install them on the front  tires and tighten them as tightly as  possible with the ends securely  fastened  Drive slowly and follow  the chain manufacturer   s  instructions  If you can hear the  chains contacting the vehicle   stop and retighten them  If the  contact continues  slow down  until it stops  Driving too fast or  spinning the wheels with chains  on will damage the vehicle     Tire Changi
107. Information    Owner publications are written  specifically for owners and intended  to provide basic operational  information about the vehicle        The owner manual includes the  Maintenance Schedule for all  models     In Portfolio  Includes a Portfolio   Owner Manual  and Warranty  Booklet     RETAIL SELL PRICE    35 00  U S   plus processing fee    Without Portfolio  Owner  Manual only     RETAIL SELL PRICE    25 00  U S   plus processing fee    Current and Past Model  Order Forms    Technical Service Bulletins and  Manuals are available for current  and past model GM vehicles    To request an order form  specify  year and model name of the vehicle     ORDER TOLL FREE   1 800 551 4123 Monday Friday  8 00 AM   6 00 PM Eastern Time    For Credit Card Orders Only   VISA MasterCard Discover     visit Helm  Inc  on the World Wide  Web at  helminc com    Or you can write to     Helm  Incorporated  P O  Box 07130  Detroit  MI 48207    Prices are subject to change  without notice and without incurring  obligation  Allow ample time for  delivery     Note to Canadian Customers   All listed prices are quoted in  U S  funds  Canadian residents  are to make checks payable in  U S  funds        Customer Information    Vehicle Data  Recording and  Privacy    Your GM vehicle has a number of  sophisticated computers that record  information about the vehicle   s  performance and how it is driven   For example  your vehicle uses  computer modules to monitor and  control engine and trans
108. It shows vehicle speed  how much fuel is  left in the fuel tank and many other things needed to drive safely and economically        United States Base Cluster shown  Canada similar    Speedometer and  Odometer    The speedometer shows the vehicle  speed in both miles per hour  mph   and kilometers per hour  km h     The odometer shows how far the  vehicle has been driven     If the vehicle needs a new odometer  installed  the new one must be   set to the mileage total of the old  odometer  If it cannot be reset  then  it must be set at zero and a label  put on the driver door to show   the old mileage reading when the  new odometer was installed    See your dealer retailer for more  information        Instruments and Controls    Trip Odometer s     The trip odometer shows how far the  vehicle has been driven since the trip  odometer was last set to zero        The button located above the  odometer allows switching between  the odometer and the trip odometer     et  PUSH iP    opona       To set the trip odometer to zero   press and hold the button        4 13    Temperature Display    The outside air temperature is  displayed on the center of the  instrument panel  within the trip  odometer  The display shows  the outside air temperature in  Fahrenheit with a range from     40 F to 122  F   40  C to 50  C      Tachometer    The tachometer shows engine  speed in thousands of revolutions  per minute  rpm      Notice  If the engine is operated  while the tachometer is in the  
109. N  but do  not start the engine  Without  applying the regular brake   try to move the shift lever out  of P  Park  with normal effort   If the shift lever moves out  of P  Park   contact your  dealer retailer for service     Ignition Transmission Lock  Check    While parked  and with the parking   brake set  try to turn the ignition   to LOCK OFF in each shift lever   position      For automatic transmission  vehicles  the ignition should turn  to LOCK OFF only when the shift  lever is in P  Park        For manual transmission vehicles   the ignition should turn to LOCK   OFF only if you push the ignition  key in farther  while turning it  toward LOCK OFF     Contact your dealer retailer if  service is required        Service and Maintenance    Parking Brake and Automatic  Transmission P  Park   Mechanism Check       Z  CAUTION       When you are doing this check   the vehicle could begin to move   You or others could be injured  and property could be damaged   Make sure there is room in front  of the vehicle in case it begins to  roll  Be ready to apply the regular  brake at once should the vehicle  begin to move              Park on a fairly steep hill  with the  vehicle facing downhill  Keeping  your foot on the regular brake   set the parking brake       To check the parking brake   s  holding ability  With the engine  running and transmission in  N  Neutral   slowly remove foot  pressure from the regular  brake pedal  Do this until the  vehicle is held by the parking  b
110. Normal Occupant Weight  The  number of occupants a vehicle  is designed to seat multiplied by  150 Ibs  68 kg   See Loading  the Vehicle on page 8 32     Occupant Distribution   Designated seating positions     Outward Facing Sidewall  The  side of an asymmetrical tire that  has a particular side that faces  outward when mounted on a  vehicle  The side of the tire that  contains a whitewall  bears white  lettering  or bears manufacturer   brand  and or model name  molding that is higher or deeper  than the same moldings on the  other sidewall of the tire        Vehicle Service and Care    Passenger  P Metric  Tire    A tire used on passenger   cars and some light duty trucks  and multipurpose vehicles     Recommended Inflation  Pressure  Vehicle  manufacturer   s recommended  tire inflation pressure as  shown on the tire placard   See Inflation   Tire Pressure  on page 9 47 and Loading the  Vehicle on page 8 32     Radial Ply Tire  A pneumatic  tire in which the ply cords that   extend to the beads are laid at  90 degrees to the centerline of  the tread     Rim  A metal support for a tire  and upon which the tire beads  are seated     Sidewall  The portion of a tire  between the tread and the bead     Speed Rating  An alphanumeric  code assigned to a tire indicating  the maximum speed at which a  tire can operate        Traction  The friction between  the tire and the road surface   The amount of grip provided     Tread  The portion of a tire that  comes into contact with the
111. OFF or  ACC ACCESSORY  the light  remains on for about 15 seconds  and then goes out  except under  the following conditions       The ignition is turned to  ACC ACCESSORY or ON RUN  after all the doors and liftgate  are closed       All the doors and the liftgate are  locked and the light is still on     When any door is unlocked with the  key or Remote Keyless Entry  RKE   system transmitter  the light comes   on for 15 seconds  even if the door is  not opened     5 4 Lighting    Reading Lamps    For vehicles with a sunroof  there is  a reading lamp near the sunroof  switch     OFF  Turns the lamp off     ON  Keeps the lamp on all  the time     Door  Turns the lamp on when  any door or the liftgate is opened   The lamp goes off when all the side  doors and the liftgate are closed        Battery Run Down  Protection    The vehicle has a battery saver  feature designed to protect  the vehicle s battery     This feature will only work with the  dome lamp in the Door position     When any interior lamp is left on  and the ignition is turned off    the battery rundown protection  system automatically turns the lamp  off after 20 minutes  This prevents  draining of the battery        Infotainment    Audio System s     Audio System s                   6 1  Setting the Clock                  6 2  RACIO S   tatccccen stectlantied tines 6 3  Using an MPI censis 6 9  XM Radio Messages           6 12  Audio Steering Wheel   Controls  sessist irren 6 13  Radio Reception                 
112. Octane    Use regular unleaded gasoline   with a posted octane rating of 87 or  higher  If the octane rating is less  than 87  you might notice an audible  knocking noise when you drive   commonly referred to as spark  knock  If this occurs  use a gasoline  rated at 87 octane or higher as soon  as possible  If you are using gasoline  rated at 87 octane or higher and you  hear heavy knocking  the engine  needs service        Driving and Operating    Gasoline Specifications    At a minimum  gasoline should meet  ASTM specification D 4814 in the  United States or CAN CGSB 3 5   or 3 511 in Canada  Some  gasolines contain an  octane enhancing additive called  methylcyclopentadienyl manganese  tricarbonyl  MMT   We recommend  against the use of gasolines  containing MMT  See Additives on  page 8 37 for additional information     California Fuel    If the vehicle is certified to meet  California Emissions Standards   it is designed to operate on fuels  that meet California specifications        See the underhood emission control  label  If this fuel is not available in  states adopting California emissions  standards  the vehicle will operate  satisfactorily on fuels meeting federal  specifications  but emission control  system performance might be  affected  The malfunction indicator  lamp could turn on and the vehicle  might fail a smog check test    See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on  page 4 20  If this occurs  return to  your authorized dealer retailer for  diagnosis  If it is d
113. Older Children  Restraints        1 36  Online Owner Center              12 3  OnStar  Privacy                6 12 18  OnStar   System  see   OnStar   Manual                 4 25  Outlet Adjustment                    7 3  Outlets   Accessory Power                5 4 9  Outside   Power Mirrors                065 2 14  Overhead Console                   3 2  Owner Checks  Service            9 5  Owners  Canadian                 0 05 ii   P   Paint  Damage 22122265 sur banker 9 89  Park   Shifting Into a   an 8 13   Shifting Out of           ee 8 14    Park Brake              cccceeeeeeees 8 12       Parking   Over Things That Burn        8 16  Parking Your Vehicle              8 15  Part A   Scheduled   Maintenance Services          11 3  Part B   Owner Checks   and Services                668 11 12  Part C   Periodic Maintenance   Inspections             cee 11 16  Part D   Recommended   Fluids and Lubricants        11 18  Part E   Maintenance   Record 155 gror aoia 11 20  Passenger Airbag Status   INGIGATON si div sdiccdieberina vedi 4 15  Passenger Compartment   Air Filter                ccccceee cence 7 4  Passenger Sensing System     1 28  PASSING oss arret beer 8 25  Perchlorate Materials   Requirements  California        9 3  Power   Door LOCKS ws tisiativecieiisvemdes 2 7   Electrical System                9 36   Outlet 115 Volt Alternating   CUITENt       c cece eee ee eee es 4 10   Retained Accessory              8 4   Steering Fluid                    9 24   Windows 
114. R  Reverse   To back up  press  down on the clutch pedal and shift  into R  Reverse   Let up on the  clutch pedal slowly while pressing  the accelerator pedal     Notice  Shifting to R  Reverse   while the vehicle is moving  forward could damage the  transmission  The repairs would  not be covered by the vehicle  warranty  Shift to R  Reverse   only after the vehicle is stopped     Also  use R  Reverse  along with  the parking brake for parking  your vehicle     8 12    Shift Speeds       Z  CAUTION       If you skip a gear when you  downshift  you could lose control  of your vehicle  You could injure  yourself or others  Do not shift  down more than one gear at a  time when you downshift              This chart shows the maximum  allowable speeds in each gear when  maximum acceleration is necessary        Driving and Operating    Manual Transmission  Recommended Shift Speeds     Engine  ra J     Engine  za          If your speed drops below 20 mph   32 km h   or if the engine is not  running smoothly  you should  downshift to the next lower gear   You may have to downshift two or  more gears to keep the engine  running smoothly or for good  performance     Parking Brake    To set the parking brake  hold the  brake pedal down and pull up on the  parking brake lever  If the ignition   is on  the brake system warning light  will come on        To release the parking brake  hold  the brake pedal down  Pull the  parking brake lever up until you can  press the release button  Hold
115. Recirculation    CE   Recirculation   Press to  turn the recirculation mode on or off   An indicator light shows that it is on   This mode recirculates the air inside  the vehicle and helps to heat or cool  the air more quickly  It can be used to  prevent outside air and odors from  entering the vehicle     Press the button again to turn   the recirculation mode off and the  outside air mode on  Recirculation  is automatically turned off when the  climate control system mode knob  is turned to defog  defrost  or is  positioned between modes        Rear Window Defogger    The rear window defogger uses a  warming grid to clear fog from   the rear window  It will only work  when the ignition is in the ON RUN  position     KI  Rear Defogger   Press to turn  the rear window defogger on or off   An indicator light shows that it is on   The rear window defogger stays on  until it is manually turned off  Clear  any snow from the rear window     If the ignition is turned off  while   the rear window defogger is on  the  defogger turns back on automatically  when the ignition is in the ON RUN  position again     Notice  Do not use a razor blade  or sharp object to clear the inside  rear window  Do not adhere  anything to the defogger grid lines  in the rear glass  These actions  may damage the rear defogger   Repairs would not be covered   by your warranty        Climate Controls 7 3    Outlet Adjustment    Use the air outlets located in   the center and outboard sides of  the instrume
116. Section is    Organized       11 2  Introduction sirener 11 1  Maintenance Replacement   alts  sr mosen snegle 10 4  Maintenance   Requirements    11 2  Part A   Scheduled   Maintenance Services      11 3  Part B   Owner Checks   and Services                 11 12  Part C   Periodic   Maintenance   Inspections               0   11 16  Part D   Recommended   Fluids and Lubricants     11 18  Part E   Maintenance   Record unerede 11 20  Scheduled Maintenance       11 4  Steering  Suspension and   Front Drive Axle Boot   and Seal Inspection       11 16       Maintenance Schedule  cont    Throttle System    Inspection               0 0 11 17  USING cera 11 3  Your Vehicle and the   Environment                5  11 2   Malfunction Indicator Lamp      4 20  Manual Seats               cccceeeeee 1 2  Manual Transmission   Fluid 2    cece ec ec cece cece cece eees 9 16   Operation o   on 8 11  Mirrors   Manual Rearview Mirror       2 13   Outside Power Mirrors         2 14  MP3 0    ececcececeeeceeeeeeeeeeeeeneues 6 9  MyGMLink com nsss 12 3   N  Navigation System    PRIVACY  s ecaieeeeseaoaacenesiies 12 18  New Vehicle Break In               8 2  Notices and Cautions                 iii  Notification   Service Airbag Message      4 16    Odometer 1 1      W XW          sssssseeeeeeeerree 4 13  Odometers  Trip           1 1           W1 1 1 1W      4 13  Off Road Recovery                 8 24  Oil   EEN QING  scsi dass divorcee dee sactnn 9 9   Pressure Light                    4 22  
117. See footnote           Service and Maintenance    Q Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     105 000 Miles  168 000 km     Q Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53  for proper rotation pattern  and additional information    See footnote        Q Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     Q Inspect passenger compartment  air filter        QO Inspect engine accessory drive  belts  or every 48 months   whichever occurs first   Visually  inspect belt for fraying  excessive  cracks  or obvious damage   Replace belt if necessary    An Emission Control Service     110 000 Miles  176 000 km     Q Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53  for proper rotation pattern  and additional information    See footnote           Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     115 000 Miles  184 000 km     Q Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See foot
118. System Operation     2 4    Doors and Locks   Door LOCKS            0cececeeeeeees 2 6  Power Door Locks                2 7  Rear Door Security Locks     2 7  Liftgate suse tern susan EN 2 8       Keys  Doors and Windows    Theft Deterrent Systems  Theft Deterrent Systems             Immobilizer 2    2   Immobilizer Operation           2 9   Content Theft Deterrent       2 10  Windows   Windows         0cceceeceeeee eee ees 2 12   Power Windows                5 2 12   Sun Visors          ecececeeeeeeees 2 13  Mirrors    Manual Rearview Mirror     2 13  Outside Power Mirror s      2 14    Sunroof  Sunroof  ooeec 2 14       2 1    2 2 Keys  Doors and Windows    Keys       Z  CAUTION       Leaving children in a vehicle with  the ignition key is dangerous for  many reasons  children or others  could be badly injured or even  killed  They could operate the  power windows or other controls  or even make the vehicle move   The windows will function with the  keys in the ignition and children  could be seriously injured or killed  if caught in the path of a closing  window  Do not leave the keys in  a vehicle with children                    The key is used for the ignition   doors  and all other locks     The key number is on the tag  attached to the key ring  Keep this  tag and give it to your dealer retailer  if a new key needs to be made     If the vehicle has an Immobilizer  theft deterrent system  the key has  a transponder in the key that  matches a decoder in the vehicle   Se
119. Text Telephone  TTY     EE ae E E E P E 12 4  Customer Assistance   Offices         ccceccee eee eee eases 12 4  GM Mobility   Reimbursement   PLOQIAM ses snydere 12 5  Roadside Assistance   Programi i sstecicceanceces tinnen 12 5    Scheduling Service  Appointments   for Service                            12 8  Scheduling Service  Appointments  for Vehicle  Customization                   12 8       Customer Information    Courtesy Transportation    12 10  Collision Damage  PRED AIL dne nerne 12 11    Reporting Safety Defects  Reporting Safety Defects   to the United States   Government             00000 12 15  Reporting Safety Defects   to the Canadian    Government          0 0 0000 12 15  Reporting Safety Defects   to General Motors           12 16  Service Publications   Ordering Information        12 16    Vehicle Data Recording  and Privacy  Vehicle Data Recording    And Privacy sesers 12 17  Event Data Recorders       12 17  OnStar   oiii 12 18  Navigation System             12 18    Radio Frequency  Identification  RFID          12 18       12 1    Customer Information    Customer Satisfaction  Procedure    Your satisfaction and goodwill are  important to your dealer and to  Pontiac  Normally  any concerns  with the sales transaction or the  operation of the vehicle will   be resolved by the dealer   s sales or  service departments  Sometimes   however  despite the best intentions  of all concerned  misunderstandings  can occur  If your concern has   not been resolve
120. The security light flashes  inconsistently     See your dealer retailer to have a  new key with a transponder made   Bring the key and key number  with you     In an emergency  contact Roadside  Assistance Program  See Roadside  Assistance Program on page 12 5     Do not leave the key or device  that disarms or deactivates the theft  deterrent system in the vehicle        Content Theft Deterrent    This vehicle may have a  theft deterrent system that activates  an alarm if attempts are made to  damage or break into the vehicle   The alarm sounds and the lights  flash           The security light is located on the  center of the instrument panel     Arming the System   To arm the system    1  Close all the doors and the  liftgate     2  Lock the doors and liftgate with  the key or Remote Keyless  Entry  RKE  transmitter     The security light comes on solid     The system automatically arms  after 30 seconds  The security  light flashes when the system   is armed     No one should be in the vehicle  when the alarm system is armed  because unlocking the vehicle from  the inside activates the system     To avoid setting off the alarm make  sure all passengers are out of   the vehicle and the windows are  closed before arming the system        Keys  Doors and Windows    Disarming the System    To disarm the alarm do one of the  following     Unlock the doors with the key       Unlock the doors and liftgate with  the RKE transmitter     Start the engine     Testing the Alarm   To 
121. Top Tether  Anchor Locations       Rear Seat    li  Top Tether Anchor   Seating  positions with top tether anchors     9  Lower Anchor   Seating positions  with two lower anchors        1 46       To assist you in locating the lower  anchors  each seating position  with lower anchors has two labels   near the crease between the  seatback and the seat cushion     ete    To assist you in locating the top  tether anchors  the top tether anchor  symbol is located on the cover     Seats and Restraints          The top tether anchors are located  on the floor of the rear cargo area   Open the cover to access the  anchors  If the vehicle has a cargo  mat  you may need to fold it back   to access the top tether anchors    Be sure to use an anchor located on  the same side of the vehicle as the  seating position where the child  restraint will be placed     Do not secure a child restraint   in a position without a top tether  anchor if a national or local   law requires that the top tether  be attached  or if the instructions  that come with the child restraint  say that the top tether must   be attached     Accident statistics show that  children are safer if they are  restrained in the rear rather than the  front seat  See Where to Put the  Restraint on page 1 43 for additional  information     Securing a Child Restraint  Designed for the LATCH  System       Z  CAUTION       If a LATCH type child restraint is  not attached to anchors  the child  restraint will not be able to protect
122. Turn to  select radio stations        SEEK TRACKV  Press to go to  the previous or next radio station   The radio only stops at stations with  a strong signal     SCAN  Press to enter scan mode   The radio will display Scanning   then goes to the next station  plays  for a few seconds  then continues  on to the next station  Press SCAN  again to stop scanning  The radio  only stops at stations with a   strong signal     INFO  Information   FM RDS   XM    Satellite Radio Service  and  MP3 Features   Press to display  information for the current FM RDS   XM station  or MP3 song  Choose  from Channel  Song  Artist  and  CAT  category      NO INFO displays when information  is not available from the station     6 4    Infotainment    Setting Preset Stations    FAV  Favorites   Press to select  up to six pages of favorites    Each page contains six favorite  stations  and each page of favorites  can contain any combination of  AM  FM  or XM    stations     For vehicles without XM  only    four pages of favorites are available     To setup the number of favorites  pages     ils    Press the MENU button to  display the radio setup menu       Press the button located below    the FAV 1 6 label       Select the desired number of    favorites pages by pressing  the button located below  the displayed page numbers       Press the FAV button  or let the    menu time out  to return to the  radio screen        To store a radio station as a favorite     1   2     Tune to the desired radio s
123. UTION    Z  CAUTION       Do not load the vehicle any  heavier than the Gross Vehicle  Weight Rating  GVWR   or  either the maximum front or  rear Gross Axle Weight Rating   GAWR   If you do  parts on  the vehicle can break  and it  can change the way your  vehicle handles  These could  cause you to lose control and  crash  Also  overloading can  shorten the life of the vehicle                 Things you put inside your  vehicle can strike and injure  people in a sudden stop or  turn  or in a crash      Put things in the rear area  of your vehicle  Try to  spread the weight evenly   If you have fold down rear  seats  you will find four  anchors on the back wall     Continued           of your trunk  You can use  these anchors to tie down  lighter loads  They are not  strong enough for heavy  things  however  so put  them as far forward as  you can in the trunk or  rear area    Never stack heavier  things  like suitcases   inside the vehicle so that  some of them are above  the tops of the seats    Do not leave an  unsecured child restraint  in your vehicle    When you carry something  inside the vehicle  secure  it whenever you can    Do not leave a seat folded  down unless you need to                    8 36    Fuel    Use of the recommended fuel   is an important part of the proper  maintenance of this vehicle  To help  keep the engine clean and maintain  optimum vehicle performance  we  recommend the use of gasoline  advertised as TOP TIER Detergent  Gasoline     Gasoline 
124. Y     Starting the Engine    Automatic Transmission   Move the shift lever to P  Park  or  N  Neutral   The engine will not start  in any other position  To restart  when you are already moving    use N  Neutral  only     Notice  Shifting into P  Park   with the vehicle moving could  damage the transmission   Shift into P  Park  only when  your vehicle is stopped     Driving and Operating       Manual Transmission    The shift lever should be in  NEUTRAL and the parking brake  engaged  Hold the clutch pedal   to the floor and start the engine   The vehicle will not start if the clutch  pedal is not all the way down     Starting Procedure    1  With your foot off the accelerator  pedal  turn the ignition to START   When the engine starts  let go of  the key  The idle speed will go  down as the engine gets warm     Vehicles equipped with   the 1 8L engine have a  Computer Controlled Cranking  System  This feature assists in  starting the engine and protects  components  If the ignition key is  turned to the START position   and then released when the  engine begins cranking  the  engine will continue cranking for  a about 30 seconds or until the  vehicle starts  If the engine does       not start and the key is held in  START for many seconds   cranking will be stopped after   25 seconds to prevent cranking  motor damage  To prevent gear  damage  this system also  prevents cranking if the engine is  already running  Engine cranking  can be stopped by turning   the ignition swit
125. ads  generating extra heat    In addition  the trailer adds  considerably to wind resistance   increasing the pulling requirements     9 78    If You Do Decide To Pull A  Trailer    If you do  here are some important  points       There are many different laws   including speed limit restrictions   having to do with trailering  Make  sure the rig will be legal  not only  where you live but also where you  will be driving  A good source for  this information can be state or  provincial police       Consider using a sway control   Ask a hitch dealer about sway  controls       Do not tow a trailer at all during  the first 1 000 miles  1 600 km   the new vehicle is driven  The  engine  axle or other parts could  be damaged        Vehicle Service and Care      Then  during the first 500 miles   800 km  that trailer is towed  do  not drive over 50 mph  80 km h   and do not make starts at full  throttle  This helps the engine  and other parts of the vehicle  wear in at the heavier loads       Obey speed limit restrictions  when towing a trailer  Do not drive  faster than the maximum posted  speed for trailers  or no more than  55 mph  90 km h   to save wear  on the vehicle   s parts     Three important considerations have  to do with weight       the weight of the trailer    the weight of the trailer tongue      and the total weight on your  vehicle   s tires       Weight of the Trailer  How heavy can a trailer safely be     It should never weigh more than  1 500 Ibs  680 kg   But e
126. afety belt  pretensioners cannot be seen  they  are part of the safety belt assembly   They can help tighten the safety belts  during the early stages of a moderate  to severe frontal and near frontal  crash if the threshold conditions for  pretensioner activation are met    And  if the vehicle has side impact  airbags  safety belt pretensioners  can help tighten the safety belts ina  side crash        If the passenger sensing system  detects that there is not a passenger  in the right front passenger position   the safety belt pretensioner for that  position will not activate  See  Passenger Sensing System on  page 1 28     Pretensioners work only once  If the  pretensioners activate in a crash   they will need to be replaced  and  probably other new parts for your  safety belt system  See Replacing  Safety Belt System Parts After a  Crash on page 1 20     Safety Belt Use During  Pregnancy    Safety belts work for everyone   including pregnant women  Like all  occupants  they are more likely   to be seriously injured if they do not  wear safety belts        A pregnant woman should wear a  lap shoulder belt  and the lap portion  should be worn as low as possible   below the rounding  throughout   the pregnancy        The best way to protect the fetus is  to protect the mother  When a safety  belt is worn properly  it is more likely  that the fetus will not be hurt ina  crash  For pregnant women  as for  anyone  the key to making safety  belts effective is wearing them  proper
127. an cause injury  Keep  hands  clothing  and tools away  from any underhood electric fan           Z  CAUTION          Heater and radiator hoses  and  other engine parts  can be very  hot  Do not touch them  If you do   you can be burned     Do not run the engine if there  is a leak  If you run the engine  it  could lose all coolant  That could  cause an engine fire  and you  could be burned  Get any leak  fixed before you drive the vehicle                 Engine Coolant    The coolant in the vehicle should  last for five years or 150 000 miles   240 000 km   whichever occurs  first  When coolant is added   or changed  use DEX COOL    coolant     The following explains the cooling  system and how to add coolant when  itis low  If there is a problem with  engine overheating  see Engine  Overheating on page 9 22 Engine  Overheating     What to Use    Use a 50 50 mixture of clean   drinkable water and DEX COOL    coolant  which will not damage  aluminum parts  If this coolant  mixture is used  nothing else  needs to be added        Z  CAUTION       Adding only plain water to the  cooling system can be dangerous   Plain water  or some other liquid  such as alcohol  can boil before  the proper coolant mixture will   The vehicle   s coolant warning  system is set for the proper  coolant mixture  With plain water  or the wrong mixture  the engine  could get too hot but would not  get the overheat warning  The  engine could catch fire and you  or others could be burned  Use a  50 50 m
128. an engine compartment  fire or other damage  Spin the  wheels as little as possible and  avoid going above 35 mph    55 km h  as shown on the  speedometer        transmission wear  wait until the  wheels stop spinning before shifting  gears  Release the accelerator pedal  while shifting  and press lightly on  the accelerator pedal when the  transmission is in gear  Slowly  spinning the wheels in the forward  and reverse directions causes a  rocking motion that could free the  vehicle  If that does not get the  vehicle out after a few tries  it might          For information about using tire  chains on the vehicle  see Tire  Chains on page 9 60     need to be towed out  If the vehicle  does need to be towed out  see  Towing Your Vehicle on page 9 75        8 32    Loading the Vehicle    It is very important to know how  much weight your vehicle can  carry  Two labels on the vehicle  show how much weight it may  properly carry  the Tire and  Loading Information label and  the Certification label        Z  CAUTION       Do not load the vehicle any  heavier than the Gross Vehicle  Weight Rating  GVWR   or  either the maximum front or  rear Gross Axle Weight Rating   GAWR   If you do  parts on  the vehicle can break  and it  can change the way your  vehicle handles  These could  cause you to lose control and  crash  Also  overloading can  shorten the life of the vehicle                 Driving and Operating    Tire and Loading Information  Label       Cc D C D    Label Example    
129. and check wheel  alignment  Also check for  damaged tires or wheels   See When It Is Time for New       Vehicle Service and Care    Tires on page 9 54 and Wheel  Replacement on page 9 59 for  more information     es         WR n    Es  r FF       When rotating the vehicle   s tires   always use the correct rotation  pattern shown here     Tires should only be moved from  front to rear and rear to front on  the same side of the vehicle     Do not include the compact  spare tire in the tire rotation     After the tires have been rotated   adjust the front and rear inflation  pressures to the amounts   shown on the Tire and   Loading Information label        9 53    See Inflation   Tire Pressure on  page 9 47 and Loading the  Vehicle on page 8 32        Z  CAUTION       Rust or dirt on a wheel  or on  the parts to which it is fastened   can make wheel nuts become  loose after time  The wheel  could come off and cause an  accident  When you change a  wheel  remove any rust or dirt  from places where the wheel  attaches to the vehicle  In an  emergency  you can use a  cloth or a paper towel to do  this  but be sure to use a  scraper or wire brush later  if  needed  to get all the rust or  dirt off  See Changing a Flat  Tire on page 9 62              Make certain that all wheel  nuts are properly tightened   See    Wheel Nut Torque    under  Capacities and Specifications  on page 10 2     9 54    When It Is Time for New  Tires    Various factors  such as  maintenance  temperatures 
130. ange   speed rating  and construction type   radial and bias belted tires  as the  vehicle   s original tires  This way  the  vehicle will continue to have tires  that are designed to give the same  performance and vehicle safety   during normal use  as the original  tires  See Tire Sidewall Labeling on  page 9 42 for additional information     GM recommends replacing tires  in sets of four  This is because  uniform tread depth on all tires will  help keep the vehicle performing  most like it did when the tires were  new  Replacing less than a full set  of tires can affect the braking and    handling performance of the vehicle     See Tire Inspection and Rotation on  page 9 53     Vehicle Service and Care 9 55       CAUTION  Continued           Z  CAUTION    damage to the vehicle    Be sure to use the correct  size  brand  and type of tires  on all wheels  It is all right  to drive with the compact  spare temporarily  as it was  developed for use on the  vehicle  See Compact  Spare Tire on page 9 70           Mixing tires could cause you to  lose control while driving  If you  mix tires of different sizes   brands  or types  radial and  bias belted tires   the vehicle  may not handle properly  and  you could have a crash  Using  tires of different sizes  brands   or types may also cause     Continued           Z  CAUTION          If you use bias ply tires on the  vehicle  the wheel rim flanges  could develop cracks after  many miles of driving  A tire  and or wheel could fail
131. ange  push  the dipstick back in all the way   then press the tab down to  lock the dipstick in place     How to Add Automatic  Transmission Fluid    Refer to the Maintenance  Schedule to determine what  kind of transmission fluid to use   Part D  Recommended Fluids  and Lubricants on page 11 18    If the fluid level is low  add   only enough of the proper fluid  to bring the level into the area  between dimples on the dipstick   1  Pull out the dipstick     2  Using a long neck funnel  add  enough fluid at the dipstick    hole to bring it to the proper level     It does not take much fluid   generally less than one pint   0 5 L   Do not overfill        9 15    Notice  Too much or too   little fluid can damage your  transmission  Too much can mean  that some of the fluid could come  out and fall on hot engine parts or  exhaust system parts  starting a  fire  Too little fluid could cause the  transmission to overheat  Be sure  to get an accurate reading if you  check your transmission fluid     3  After adding fluid  recheck the  fluid level as described under   How to Check Automatic  Transmission Fluid     earlier  in this section     4  When the correct fluid level is  obtained  push the dipstick  back in all the way  then press  the tab down to lock the dipstick  in place     9 16    Manual Transmission  Fluid    When to Check    A good time to have your manual  transmission fluid level checked   is when the engine oil is changed   However  the fluid in your manual  transm
132. applied or lightly  applied  This does not mean  something is wrong with the brakes     Properly torqued wheel nuts are  necessary to help prevent brake  pulsation  When tires are rotated   inspect brake pads for wear and  evenly tighten wheel nuts in   the proper sequence to torque  specifications in Capacities and  Specifications on page 10 2     Brake linings should always be  replaced as complete axle sets     Brake Pedal Travel    See your dealer retailer if the brake  pedal does not return to normal   height  or if there is a rapid increase  in pedal travel  This could be a sign    that brake service might be required        9 29    Brake Adjustment    Every time the brakes are applied   with or without the vehicle moving   the brakes adjust for wear     Replacing Brake System Parts    The braking system on a vehicle is  complex  Its many parts have to be  of top quality and work well together  if the vehicle is to have really good  braking  The vehicle was designed  and tested with top quality brake  parts  When parts of the braking  system are replaced     for example   when the brake linings wear down  and new ones are installed     be  sure to get new approved  replacement parts  If this is not done   the brakes might not work properly   For example  if someone puts in  brake linings that are wrong for   the vehicle  the balance between  the front and rear brakes can  change     for the worse  The braking  performance expected can change  in many other ways if the w
133. aracter in the tire size  means the tire is for temporary  use only     9 44    Tire Size    The following illustration  shows an example of a typical  passenger vehicle tire size     P225 60R16 97S    ITT    B CDE F        A  Passenger  P Metric  Tire   The United States version of a  metric tire sizing system  The  letter P as the first character in  the tire size means a passenger  vehicle tire engineered to  standards set by the U S  Tire  and Rim Association  Tires  engineered to European  standards do not use the   letter P as the first character   in the tire size        Vehicle Service and Care     B  Tire Width  The three digit  number indicates the tire section  width in millimeters from sidewall  to sidewall      C  Aspect Ratio  A two digit  number that indicates the tire  height to width measurements   For example  if the tire size  aspect ratio is 60  as shown in  item C of the illustration  it would  mean that the tire   s sidewall is  60 percent as high as it is wide      D  Construction Code  A letter  code is used to indicate the type  of ply construction in the tire    The letter R means radial ply  construction  the letter D means  diagonal or bias ply construction   and the letter B means  belted bias ply construction      E  Rim Diameter  Diameter of  the wheel in inches         F  Service Description  These  characters represent the load  range and speed rating of the  tire  The load index represents  the load carry capacity a tire is  certified to carr
134. as you are driving  check   to make sure the luggage carrier  and cargo are still securely fastened     Loading cargo on the roof rack will  make the center of the vehicle gravity  higher  Avoid high speeds  sudden  starts  sharp turns  sudden braking  or abrupt maneuvers  otherwise it  may result in loss of control or  vehicle rollover due to failure to  operate the vehicle correctly     If driving for a long distance  on  rough roads  or at high speeds  stop  the vehicle now and then during   the trip to make sure the cargo  remains in its place     Driver Storage  Compartment    The driver storage compartment is  located near the left side of the  steering column on the bottom of  the instrument panel  Pull up on the  lever to open the cover        Floor Mats    The driver side floor mat is held in  place by two locator hooks     The floor mat must be properly  placed on the floor so that it does  not block the movement of the  accelerator pedal     How to Remove and Replace  the Floor Mat       To remove the floor mat  pull up on  the rear of the mat to disconnect  it from the locator hooks        Storage 3 3    To reinstall the floor mat  line up  the openings in the floor mat  over the locator hooks and push  down into place     Hooks    There are hooks for hanging items  in the cabin  luggage compartment   and in the cargo management  system  if the vehicle has one     On the front passenger side   press the hook to open and  use it  There is a weight limit of  44 Ib  
135. ase with a clean cloth   During very cold  damp weather  frequent application may be required   See    Fluids and Lubricants    in the  Index of the    Maintenance and  Warranty and Owner assistance  Information    manual     9 88    Wheels and Trim     Aluminum  or Chrome    Your vehicle may have either  aluminum or chrome plated wheels     Keep the wheels clean using a  soft clean cloth with mild soap and  water  Rinse with clean water   After rinsing thoroughly  dry with a  soft clean towel  A wax may then  be applied     Notice  Chrome wheels and  other chrome trim may be  damaged if you do not wash your  vehicle after driving on roads  that have been sprayed with  magnesium  calcium or sodium  chloride  These chlorides are  used on roads for conditions  such as ice and dust  Always  wash your vehicle   s chrome with  soap and water after exposure        Vehicle Service and Care    Notice  If you use strong soaps   chemicals  abrasive polishes   cleaners  brushes  or cleaners  that contain acid on aluminum  or chrome plated wheels    you could damage the surface of  the wheel s   The repairs would  not be covered by your warranty   Use only approved cleaners on  aluminum or chrome plated  wheels     The surface of these wheels is  similar to the painted surface of your  vehicle  Do not use strong soaps   chemicals  abrasive polishes   abrasive cleaners  cleaners with  acid  or abrasive cleaning brushes  on them because you could damage  the surface  Do not use chrome  pol
136. ation Number  VIN   and  delivery date of the vehicle      Description of the problem    Coverage    Services are provided up to  5 years 100 000 miles  160 000 km    whichever comes first     In the U S   anyone driving the  vehicle is covered  In Canada  a  person driving the vehicle without  permission from the owner is not  covered        Customer Information    Roadside Assistance is not a part of  the New Vehicle Limited Warranty   Pontiac and General Motors of  Canada Limited reserve the right to  make any changes or discontinue  the Roadside Assistance program at  any time without notification     Pontiac and General Motors of  Canada Limited reserve the right to  limit services or payment to an owner  or driver if they decide the claims are  made too often  or the same type of  claim is made many times     Services Provided      Emergency Fuel Delivery   Delivery of enough fuel  for the vehicle to get to the  nearest service station       Lock Out Service  Service is  provided to unlock the vehicle if  you are locked out  A remote  unlock may be available if you  have OnStar    For security  reasons  the driver must present  identification before this service  is given        Emergency Tow From a Public  Road or Highway  Tow to the  nearest Pontiac dealer for  warranty service  or if the vehicle  was in a crash and cannot be  driven  Assistance is also given  when the vehicle is stuck in sand   mud  or snow     Flat Tire Change  Service is  provided to change a flat 
137. ats    Rear Seat Operation    You can fold either side of the  seatback down  The rear right side  seatback can also be used as a  temporary table while the vehicle is  stopped        Z  CAUTION       A rear seatback folded forward  or  any other object contacting or  pressing the front seatback may  affect the proper functioning of the  passenger sensing system  See  Passenger Sensing System on  page 1 28              To fold either seatback down     1  Move the front seat forward and  the seatback to the upright  position     2  Move the headrests all the  way down        Seats and Restraints 1 7       3  Pull up on the lock release knob   located on the top outboard side  of the seatback     Notice  Folding a rear seat with  the safety belts still fastened may  cause damage to the seat or the  safety belts  Always unbuckle the  safety belts and return them to  their normal stowed position  before folding a rear seat     4  Fold the seatback down     1 8    To raise the seatback     1  Pull the seatback up and push it  back to lock it into place  The  safety belts should not be twisted  or caught in the seatback     Seats and Restraints       Z  CAUTION       A safety belt that is improperly  routed  not properly attached    or twisted will not provide the  protection needed in a crash    The person wearing the belt could  be seriously injured  After raising  the rear seatback  always check  to be sure that the safety belts  are properly routed and attached   and are not tw
138. be adjusted        5  To increase the time or date   do one of the following  turn  the TUNE ADJ  Tune Adjust   knob clockwise  press  SEEK TRACK A  press    FWD A  Forward   or continue  to press the button under the  category to be adjusted    6  To decrease the time or date   do one of the following   turn the TUNE ADJ knob  counterclockwise  press  SEEK TRACK V  or press    REV X    Reverse    7  To save the settings  press    the CLOCK button  or let  the display time out        To change the time default setting  from 12 hour to 24 hour  and to  change the date default setting from  month day year to day month year     1  Press the CLOCK button  and then the button below the  forward arrow label on the  display  The 12H and 24H  and  the date MMDD  month and  day  and DDMM  day and month   categories will display     2  Press the button below the  12H or 24H label  and the  date MMDD  month and day  or  DDMM  day and month  label  to choose how the radio displays  the time and date     3  To save the settings  press  the CLOCK button  or let  the screen time out     Radio s        Radio with CD  MP3  shown  Radio with CD  Base  similar    Playing the Radio  PWR VOL  Power Volume   Press  to turn the radio on and off  Turn    the PWR VOL knob to adjust  the volume        CLOCK  Press to adjust the time   See Setting the Clock on page 6 2  for more information        Infotainment 6 3    Finding a Station    BAND  Press to select AM  FM   or XM     TUNE ADJ  Tune Adjust   
139. been blinded  Use  a flashlight if you need more light      Continued        Be sure the battery has enough  water  You do not need to add  water to the battery installed in  your new vehicle  But if a battery  has filler caps  be sure the right  amount of fluid is there  If it is  low  add water to take care of  that first  If you don   t  explosive  gas could be present     Battery fluid contains acid that  can burn you  Do not get it on  you  If you accidentally get it in  your eyes or on your skin  flush  the place with water and get  medical help immediately           Z  CAUTION                Fans or other moving engine  parts can injure you badly  Keep  your hands away from moving  parts once the engine is running                 5  Check that the jumper cables    do not have loose or missing  insulation  If they do  you could  get a shock  The vehicles could  be damaged too     Before you connect the cables   here are some basic things you  should know  Positive     will go  to positive     or to a remote  positive     terminal if the vehicle  has one  Negative       will go to a  heavy  unpainted metal engine  part or to a remote negative        terminal if the vehicle has one     Do not connect positive     to  negative       or you will get a short  that would damage the battery  and maybe other parts too  And  do not connect the negative      cable to the negative       terminal  on the dead battery because this  can cause sparks     Vehicle Service and Care 9 73 
140. blem with the system     Have it checked by your dealer   retailer     The four wheel drive indicator will  light up when the All Wheel drive  is active        Instruments and Controls    Highbeam On Light    This light comes on when the    high beam headlamps are in use     See Headlamp High Low Beam  Changer on page 4 7 for more  information     Door Ajar Light       This light comes on if any door   the rear liftgate  or the rear liftglass  are not completely closed        Fuel Gage  F e  B  E     United States Canada    The fuel gage shows about how  much fuel is in the fuel tank    An arrow on the fuel gage indicates  that the fuel filler door is on the driver  side of the vehicle  The fuel gage  works only when the ignition switch is  turned to ON RUN  When the gage  first indicates E or empty  there is still  about 2 gallons   7 6 L  of fuel left   but more needs to be added right  away  When the vehicle is low on fuel  the low fuel warning light  located  below the empty mark  comes on     4 25    Instruments and Controls    Five things that do not indicate a  problem with the fuel gage       At the gas station  the fuel pump  shuts off before the gage reads  F or full       It takes a little more or less fuel  to fill up than the gage indicated   For example  the gage may  have indicated the tank was half  full  but it actually took more  or less than half the tank   s  capacity to fill it       It takes the gage several minutes  to read F or full after filling the  
141. brake  system  Each of these is covered in  this manual  and the Index will help  find them quickly  If you are trailering   it is a good idea to review this  information before starting your trip     Check periodically to see that all  hitch nuts and bolts are tight     Engine Cooling When Trailer  Towing    The cooling system could  temporarily overheat during severe  operating conditions  See Engine  Overheating on page 9 22     Appearance Care    Interior Cleaning    Your vehicle s interior will continue  to look its best if it is cleaned often   Although not always visible  dust  and dirt can accumulate on your  upholstery  Dirt can damage carpet   fabric  leather  and plastic surfaces   Regular vacuuming is recommended  to remove particles from the  upholstery  It is important to keep  your upholstery from becoming and  remaining heavily soiled  Soils  should be removed as quickly as  possible  Your vehicle   s interior may  experience extremes of heat that  could cause stains to set rapidly     Lighter colored interiors may require  more frequent cleaning  Use care  because newspapers and garments  that transfer color to your home  furnishings may also transfer   color to your vehicle   s interior        Vehicle Service and Care    When cleaning your vehicle   s  interior  only use cleaners specifically  designed for the surfaces being  cleaned  Permanent damage may  result from using cleaners on  surfaces for which they were not  intended  Use glass cleaner only   on 
142. ce build up for clear radio reception     If the vehicle has a sunroof  the  performance of the XM system may  be affected if the sunroof is open     Loading items onto the roof of  the vehicle can interfere with the  performance of the XM system   Make sure the XM Satellite Radio  antenna is not obstructed     Climate Controls    Climate Controls    Climate Control System        7 1  Outlet Adjustment                 7 3  Passenger Compartment   Air  Filter secs  cseeeessiieren tees 7 4       Climate Controls    Climate Control System    Climate Controls 7 1    The heating  cooling  and ventilation for the vehicle can be controlled with    this system              Fan Control     8  Fan   Turn the center knob  toward 4 to turn the system  on or increase fan speed        If the airflow seems low when the  fan is at the highest setting  the  passenger compartment air filter  may need to be replaced  For more  information  see Passenger  Compartment Air Filter on page 7 4  and Scheduled Maintenance on  page 11 4     7 2 Climate Controls    Temperature Control    Turn the right knob clockwise or  counterclockwise to increase or  decrease the temperature inside  the vehicle     Air Delivery Mode Control    Turn the left knob to select from the  following modes     7  Vent   Air is directed to the  upper instrument panel outlets     Wi  Bi Level   Air is directed to  the upper instrument panel outlets  and the floor outlets     td  Floor   Air is directed to the  floor and side wi
143. ce repairs        8 23    Steering Tips    It is important to take curves at a  reasonable speed     Traction in a curve depends on the  condition of the tires and the road  surface  the angle at which the curve  is banked  and your speed  While in  a curve  speed is the one factor you  can control     If you need to reduce speed  do it  before you enter the curve  while the  front wheels are straight ahead     Try to adjust the speed so you can  drive through the curve  Maintain   a reasonable  steady speed  Wait  to accelerate until you are out of the  curve  and then accelerate gently  into the straightaway     8 24    Steering in Emergencies    There are times when steering can  be more effective than braking    For example  you come over a hill  and find a truck stopped in your lane   or a car suddenly pulls out from  nowhere  or a child darts out from  between parked cars and stops right  in front of you  You can avoid these  problems by braking     if you can  stop in time  But sometimes you  cannot  there is not room  That is the  time for evasive action     steering  around the problem     Your vehicle can perform very   well in emergencies like these    First apply the brakes  See Braking  on page 8 19  It is better to remove  as much speed as you can from a  possible collision  Then steer around  the problem  to the left or right  depending on the space available        Driving and Operating       An emergency like this requires  close attention and a quick decisio
144. ch it will be used     For most basic types of child  restraints  there are many  different models available   When purchasing a child  restraint  be sure it is designed  to be used in a motor vehicle   If it is  the restraint will have   a label saying that it meets  federal motor vehicle safety  standards        The restraint manufacturer   s  instructions that come with the  restraint state the weight and  height limitations for a particular  child restraint  In addition  there  are many kinds of restraints  available for children with special  needs        Z  CAUTION          Z  CAUTION          To reduce the risk of neck and  head injury during a crash  infants  need complete support  This is  because an infant   s neck is not  fully developed and its head  weighs so much compared with  the rest of its body  In a crash   an infant in a rear facing child  restraint settles into the restraint   so the crash forces can be  distributed across the strongest  part of an infant   s body  the back  and shoulders  Infants should  always be secured in rear facing  child restraints        A young child   s hip bones are still  so small that the vehicle   s regular  safety belt may not remain low  on the hip bones  as it should   Instead  it may settle up around  the child   s abdomen  In a crash   the belt would apply force ona  body area that is unprotected by  any bony structure  This alone  could cause serious or fatal  injuries  To reduce the risk of  serious or fatal injuries 
145. ch to ACC   ACCESSORY or LOCK OFF     Vehicles equipped with the  2 4L engine should not be  cranked for more than   30 seconds at a time    This may overheat the  starter and wiring systems     Notice  Holding the key in  START for longer than 15 seconds  at a time will cause the battery to  be drained much sooner  And   the excessive heat can damage  the starter motor  Wait about   15 seconds between each try to  help avoid draining the battery   or damaging the starter       If the engine does not start  wait  about 15 seconds and try again  to start the engine by turning   the ignition to START  Wait about  15 seconds between each try     When the engine has run   about 10 seconds to warm up   the vehicle is ready to be driven   Do not run the engine at high  speed when it is cold     If the weather is below freezing   32  F or 0  C   let the engine run  for a few minutes to warm up       If the engine still will not start  or  starts but then stops  it could be  flooded with too much gasoline   Try pushing the accelerator pedal  all the way to the floor and holding  it there as you hold the key in  START for about three seconds    If the vehicle starts briefly but then  stops again  do the same thing   but this time keep the pedal down  for five or six seconds  This clears  the extra gasoline from the  engine        Notice  The engine is designed  to work with the electronics in  the vehicle  If electrical parts or  accessories are added  you could  change the way the en
146. cle   s TPMS can warn you  about a low tire pressure condition  but it does not replace normal tire  maintenance  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53 and Tires  on page 9 41     TPMS Malfunction Light    The TPMS will not function properly  if one or more of the TPMS sensors  are missing or inoperable  When the  system detects a malfunction  the  low tire warning light flashes for  about one minute and then stays   on for the remainder of the ignition  cycle  The low tire warning light  comes on at each ignition cycle until  the problem is corrected  Some of  the conditions that can cause the  malfunction light to come on are     e One of the road tires has been  replaced with the spare tire  The  spare tire does not have a TPMS  sensor  The TPMS malfunction  light and DIC message should go  off once you re install the road tire  containing the TPMS sensor        Vehicle Service and Care      The initialization  reset  procedure  failed  See    TPMS Reset    later in  this section       One or more TPMS sensors  are missing or damaged   The TPMS malfunction light  should go off when the TPMS  sensors are installed and the  sensor matching process is  performed successfully  See  your dealer retailer for service       Replacement tires or wheels do  not match the vehicle   s original  equipment tires or wheels  Tires  and wheels other than those  recommended for your vehicle  could prevent the TPMS from  functioning properly  See Buying  New Tires on page 9 54      
147. cle with the engine running   The vehicle could move suddenly  if the shift lever is not fully in   P  Park  with the parking brake  firmly set  And  if you leave the  vehicle with the engine running   it could overheat and even catch  fire  You or others could be  injured  Do not leave the vehicle  with the engine running              If you have to leave an automatic  transmission vehicle with the engine  running  be sure the vehicle is in   P  Park  and the parking brake   is firmly set before you leave it        Driving and Operating    Torque Lock  Automatic  Transmission     If you are parking on a hill and you  do not shift into P  Park  properly  the  weight of the vehicle may put too  much force on the parking pawl in  the transmission  You may find it  difficult to pull the shift lever out of   P  Park   This is called    torque lock      To prevent torque lock  set the  parking brake and then shift into   P  Park  properly before you leave  the driver seat  To find out how  see  Shifting Into Park on page 8 13     Move the shift lever out of P  Park   before you release the parking  brake     If torque lock does occur  you may  need to have another vehicle push  yours a little uphill to take some of  the pressure from the parking pawl in  the transmission  so you can pull the  shift lever out of P  Park         Shifting Out of Park    This vehicle has an electronic shift  lock release system  The shift  lock release is designed to       Prevent ignition key removal
148. d  seat mounted side impact airbag   if equipped   the off indicator will  light and stay lit to remind you that  the airbags are off  See Passenger  Airbag Status Indicator on   page 4 15     The passenger sensing system is  designed to turn on  may inflate  the  right front passenger frontal airbag  and seat mounted side impact  airbag  if equipped  anytime   the system senses that a person   of adult size is sitting properly in   the right front passenger seat     When the passenger sensing  system has allowed the airbags and  pretensioner to be enabled  the   on indicator will light and stay lit to  remind you that the airbags and  pretensioner are active     Seats and Restraints       For some children who have  outgrown child restraints and for  very small adults  the passenger  sensing system may or may not turn  off the right front passenger frontal  airbag and seat mounted side impact  airbag  if equipped   depending   upon the person s seating posture  and body build  Everyone in the  vehicle who has outgrown child  restraints should wear a safety belt  properly     whether or not there is an  airbag for that person     If the airbag readiness light and the  OFF light in the passenger airbag  status indicator come on together  it  may mean there is a malfunction in  the passenger sensing system   Secure the child in the child restraint  in a rear seat position in the vehicle  and check with your dealer retailer        Z  CAUTION          If the airbag readiness ligh
149. d cargo     DOT Markings  A code  molded into the sidewall of a  tire signifying that the tire is   in compliance with the U S   Department of Transportation   DOT  motor vehicle safety  standards  The DOT code  includes the Tire Identification  Number  TIN   an alphanumeric  designator which can also  identify the tire manufacturer   production plant  brand  and  date of production     GVWR  Gross Vehicle Weight  Rating  See Loading the Vehicle  on page 8 32     GAWR FRT  Gross Axle  Weight Rating for the front axle   See Loading the Vehicle on  page 8 32        9 45    GAWR RR  Gross Axle  Weight Rating for the rear axle   See Loading the Vehicle on  page 8 32     Intended Outboard Sidewall   The side of an asymmetrical tire   that must always face outward  when mounted on a vehicle     Kilopascal  kPa   The metric  unit for air pressure     Light Truck  LT Metric  Tire   A tire used on light duty trucks  and some multipurpose  passenger vehicles     Load Index  An assigned  number ranging from 1 to 279  that corresponds to the load  carrying capacity of a tire     Maximum Inflation Pressure   The maximum air pressure   to which a cold tire can   be inflated  The maximum   air pressure is molded onto  the sidewall     9 46    Maximum Load Rating    The load rating for a tire at the  maximum permissible inflation  pressure for that tire     Maximum Loaded Vehicle  Weight  The sum of curb weight   accessory weight  vehicle  capacity weight  and production  options weight     
150. d deaths involve  alcohol  In most cases  these deaths  are the result of someone who was  drinking and driving  In recent years   more than 17 000 annual motor  vehicle related deaths have been  associated with the use of alcohol   with about 250 000 people injured     For persons under 21  it is against  the law in every U S  state to  drink alcohol  There are good  medical  psychological  and  developmental reasons for   these laws     The obvious way to eliminate the  leading highway safety problem   is for people never to drink alcohol  and then drive     Medical research shows that alcohol  in a person   s system can make crash  injuries worse  especially injuries       to the brain  spinal cord  or heart   This means that when anyone who  has been drinking     driver or  passenger     is in a crash  that  person   s chance of being killed or  permanently disabled is higher than  if the person had not been drinking     Control of a Vehicle    The following three systems help  to control your vehicle while   driving     brakes  steering  and  accelerator  At times  as when  driving on snow or ice  it is easy to  ask more of those control systems  than the tires and road can provide   Meaning  you can lose control of  your vehicle     Adding non dealer non retailer  accessories can affect your vehicle   s  performance  See Accessories  and Modifications on page 9 3     Braking    See Brake System Warning Light on  page 4 17     Braking action involves perception  time and
151. d legal speed limit     1  Put the shift lever in Neutral     2  Turn the ignition to  ACC ACCESSORY to avoid  locking the steering wheel   Make sure the audio system  is turned off and that nothing is  plugged into the power outlets     3  Release the parking brake     After dinghy towing  let the engine  idle for more than three minutes  before driving the vehicle           Do not tow your vehicle from   the rear  Your vehicle could be badly  damaged and the repairs would   not be covered by your warranty     Dolly Towing   All Wheel Drive Vehicles     All wheel drive vehicles must not  be towed with two wheels on the  ground  To properly tow these  vehicles  they should be placed  on a platform trailer with all four  wheels off of the ground        Dolly Towing   Front Wheel Drive  Vehicles Only           To tow your front wheel drive  vehicle using a dolly  follow  these steps     1  Put the front wheels on a dolly     2  Move the shift lever to P  Park   for an automatic transmission  or Neutral for a manual  transmission     3  Set the parking brake     4  Clamp the steering wheel in a  straight ahead position with a  clamping device designed  for towing     5  Remove the key from the  ignition    6  Secure the vehicle to the dolly    7  Release the parking brake     Towing a Trailer       Z  CAUTION       The driver can lose control when  pulling a trailer if the correct  equipment is not used or the  vehicle is not driven properly   For example  if the trailer is too 
152. d of hearing  or speech impaired  and who use Text Telephones   TTYs   Pontiac has TTY equipment  available at its Customer Assistance  Center  Any TTY user in the U S   can communicate with Pontiac   by dialing  1 800 833 PONT  7668     TTY users in Canada can dial  1 800 263 3830         Customer Assistance  Offices    Pontiac encourages customers   to call the toll free number for  assistance  However  if a customer  wishes to write or e mail Pontiac   the letter should be addressed to     United States     Customer  Assistance    Pontiac Customer Assistance Center  P O  Box 33172  Detroit  MI 48232 5172    www Pontiac com   1 800 762 2737 or   1 800 833 7668    For Text Telephone devices  TTYs    Roadside Assistance   1 800 ROADSIDE  762 3743     From Puerto Rico   1 800 496 9992  English   1 800 496 9993  Spanish   From U S  Virgin Islands   1 800 496 9994    Canada     Customer  Assistance    General Motors of Canada Limited  Customer Communication Centre   CA1 163 005   1908 Colonel Sam Drive   Oshawa  Ontario L1H 8P7    www gmcanada com  1 800 263 3777  English   1 800 263 7854  French   1 800 263 3830  For Text  Telephone devices  TTYs    Roadside Assistance   1 800 268 6800    Overseas     Customer  Assistance    Please contact the local General  Motors Business Unit        Mexico  Central America  and Caribbean Islands   Countries  Except Puerto  Rico and U S  Virgin  Islands      Customer  Assistance    General Motors de Mexico    S  de R L  de C V    Customer Ass
153. d pull on the  seatback to be sure it is locked                          Sitting in a reclined position when  your vehicle is in motion can be  dangerous  Even if you buckle up   your safety belts cannot do their  job when you are reclined like this     The shoulder belt cannot do its job  because it will not be against your  body  Instead  it will be in front of  you  In a crash  you could go into  it  receiving neck or other injuries     The lap belt cannot do its job  either  In a crash  the belt could go  up over your abdomen  The belt  forces would be there  not at your  pelvic bones  This could cause  serious internal injuries     For proper protection when the  vehicle is in motion  have the  seatback upright  Then sit well  back in the seat and wear your  safety belt properly              1 4 Seats and Restraints    On vehicles with manual reclining  seatbacks the lever used to operate  them is located on the outboard  side of the seat        To recline the seatback   1  Lift the recline lever     2  Move the seatback to the desired  position  then release the lever to  lock the seatback in place     3  Push and pull on the seatback to  make sure it is locked        To return the seatback to an upright  position     1  Lift the lever fully  without    applying pressure to the  seatback  and the seatback will  return to the upright position       Push and pull on the seatback to    make sure it is locked     Passenger Folding  Seatback       Z  CAUTION       If you fol
154. d restraint    See Head Restraints on  page 1 6     If the on indicator is still lit  secure   the child in the child restraint in   a rear seat position in the vehicle    and check with your dealer retailer     Seats and Restraints       1 31    If the Off Indicator is Lit for an  Adult Size Occupant       If a person of adult size is sitting in  the right front passenger seat    but the off indicator is lit  it could be  because that person is not sitting  properly in the seat     1 32    lf this happens  use the following  steps to allow the system to detect  that person and enable the right  front passenger frontal airbag   and seat mounted side impact  airbag  if equipped      1  Turn the vehicle off     2  Remove any additional material  from the seat  such as blankets   cushions  seat covers  seat  heaters  or seat massagers     3  Place the seatback in the fully  upright position     4  Have the person sit upright in  the seat  centered on the seat  cushion  with legs comfortably  extended     5  Restart the vehicle and have the  person remain in this position for  two to three minutes after the  on indicator is lit     Seats and Restraints       Additional Factors Affecting  System Operation    Safety belts help keep the passenger  in position on the seat during vehicle  maneuvers and braking  which helps  the passenger sensing system  maintain the passenger airbag  status  See  Safety Belts    and  Child  Restraints    in the Index for additional  information about 
155. d the seatback forward to  carry longer objects  such as skis   be sure any such cargo is not  near an airbag  In a crash  an  inflating airbag might force that  object toward a person  This  could cause severe injury or even  death  Secure objects away from  the area in which an airbag would  inflate  For more information  see  Where Are the Airbags  on   page 1 23 and Loading the  Vehicle on page 8 32                    Z  CAUTION       Things you put on this seatback  can strike and injure people in a  sudden stop or turn  or in a crash   Remove or secure all items  before driving              On vehicles with this feature  the  seatback folds down to allow   for more cargo space  When the  area is not being used for more  cargo space or as a temporary table   put the seatback in the locked   upright position  Only adjust the seat  when the vehicle is not moving        To fold the seatback down   1  Move the seat rearward     2  Lower the head restraint to the  lowest position and make sure  the seatback is at the most  upright position and locked        3  Pull up on one of the levers  located on either side of the back  of the passenger seatback     4  Fold the seatback down     Seats and Restraints       1 5    To raise the seatback     1  Pull up on one of the levers  located on either side of the back  of the passenger s seatback     2  Pull the seatback up and push it  back to lock it into place  Make  sure the safety belt is not twisted  or caught in the seatback   
156. d to  the vehicle     4  Turn the ignition to ON RUN with  the engine off        5  Press and hold the tire pressure  warning reset switch until the tire  pressure warning light flashes  slowly on off three times        Wait for a few minutes with the  ignition in ON RUN  and then turn  the ignition to ACC ACCESSORY  or LOCK OFF     If the low tire pressure warning  light does not flash three times  while you press and hold the  reset button  the reset has failed   Repeat the reset process  If the  reset cannot be performed  see  your dealer retailer for service     If you press the tire pressure reset  switch while the vehicle is moving   the reset is not performed  If you  press the tire pressure reset switch  accidentally and initialization is  performed  adjust the tire pressure  to the specified level and perform  the reset procedure again     Tire Inspection and  Rotation    We recommend that you  regularly inspect the vehicle s  tires  including the spare tire  for  signs of wear or damage  See  When It Is Time for New Tires on  page 9 54 for more information     Tires should be rotated every  5 000 to 8 000 miles  8 000 to  13 000 km   See Part A   Scheduled Maintenance  Services on page 11 3     The purpose of a regular tire  rotation is to achieve a uniform  wear for all tires on the vehicle   This will ensure that the vehicle  continues to perform most like it  did when the tires were new     Any time you notice unusual  wear  rotate the tires as soon  as possible 
157. d to your  satisfaction  the following steps  should be taken     STEP ONE  Discuss your concern  with a member of dealership  management  Normally  concerns  can be quickly resolved at that level   If the matter has already been  reviewed with the sales  service  or  parts manager  contact the owner   of the dealership or the general  manager     12 2    STEP TWO  If after contacting a  member of dealership management   it appears your concern cannot be  resolved by the dealership without  further help  in the U S   call the  Pontiac Customer Assistance  Center at 1 800 762 2737  In  Canada  call General Motors of  Canada Customer Communication  Centre at 1 800 263 3777  English   or 1 800 263 7854  French      We encourage you to call the toll free  number in order to give your inquiry  prompt attention  Have the following  information available to give the  Customer Assistance  Representative       Vehicle Identification Number   VIN   This is available from the  vehicle registration or title  or the  plate at the top left of the  instrument panel and visible  through the windshield     e Dealership name and location       Vehicle delivery date and present  mileage        Customer Information    When contacting Pontiac  remember  that your concern will likely be  resolved at a dealer   s facility    That is why we suggest you follow  Step One first     STEP THREE     U S  Owners   Both General Motors and your  dealer are committed to making  sure you are completely satisfi
158. d will be riding in  the vehicle  see Older Children on  page 1 36 or Infants and Young  Children on page 1 38  Follow those  rules for everyone s protection     It is very important for all occupants  to buckle up  Statistics show that  unbelted people are hurt more often  in crashes than those who are  wearing safety belts     Occupants who are not buckled up  can be thrown out of the vehicle   in a crash  And they can strike  others in the vehicle who are  wearing safety belts     1 12    First  before you or your  passenger s  wear a safety belt   there is important information  you should know                             Sit up straight and always keep    your feet on the floor in front of you     The lap part of the belt should be    Seats and Restraints          worn low and snug on the hips  just  touching the thighs  In a crash  this  applies force to the strong pelvic  bones and you would be less likely  to slide under the lap belt  If you slid  under it  the belt would apply force  on your abdomen  This could cause  serious or even fatal injuries  The  shoulder belt should go over the  shoulder and across the chest   These parts of the body are best  able to take belt restraining forces     The shoulder belt locks if there is a  sudden stop or crash     Q  What is wrong with this             a       Q  QD     hl nl a E                A  The shoulder belt is too loose   It will not give as much  protection this way        Z  CAUTION       You can be seriously hurt i
159. de   the transmission will remain  in the driver selected range   When coming to a stop  the  vehicle will automatically shift  into 1  First  gear     2  Move the shift lever forward to  increase the gear range  or  rearward to decrease the gear  range available based upon your  current driving conditions and  needs        Driving and Operating    The number displayed in the  instrument cluster is the highest gear  that the transmission will be allowed  to operate in  However  your vehicle  can automatically shift to lower gears  as required by various driving  conditions  This means that all gears  below that number are available     The display in the instrument  cluster will change from the currently  displayed message to 4  Fourth   when you enter S  Shift Control    and change to indicate the requested  gear range when moving the shift  lever forward or rearward     While using the DSC feature the  transmission will have firmer shifting  and sportier performance  You can  use this for sport driving or when  climbing hills to stay in gear longer  or to downshift for more power or  engine braking        The transmission will only allow  shifting into gears appropriate   for the vehicles speed and engine  revolutions per minute  RPM        The transmission will not  automatically shift to the next  higher gear if the vehicle speed  or engine RPM is too high       The transmission will not allow  shifting to the next lower gear if  the vehicle speed or engine RPM  is too hi
160. ds and lubricants identified below by name  part number  or specification can be obtained from your    dealer retailer   Fluid Lubricant    Engine oil which meets GM Standard GM6094M and displays the  American Petroleum Institute Certified for Gasoline Engines starburst  symbol  To determine the proper viscosity for your vehicle s engine   see Engine Oil on page 9 9       50 50 mixture of clean  drinkable water and use only DEX COOL    Engine Coolant Coolant  See Engine Coolant on page 9 18   Hydraulic Brake Clutch System Delco   Supreme 11 Brake Fluid or equivalent DOT 3 brake fluid   Windshield Washer Solvent Optikleen   Washer Solvent     GM Goodwrench   Synthetic Manual Transmission Fluid  Manual Transmission  GM Part No  U S  12346190  in Canada 10953477     1 quart  or  SAE 75W 90 GL 5 gear oil     f a Use only T IV Automatic Transmission Fluid  GM Part No  U S  88900925   Automatic Transmission in Canada 22689186        Multi Purpose Lubricant  Superlube  GM Part No  U S  12346241   Key Lock Cylinders in Canada 10953474      Chassis Lubricant  GM Part No  U S  12377985  in Canada 88901242  or    Manual Transmission Shift Linkage lubricant meeting requirements of NLGI  2  Category LB or GC LB        Clutch Linkage Pivot Points    Floor Shift Linkage    Chassis Lubrication   Hood Latch Assembly  Secondary  Latch  Pivots  Spring Anchor  and  Release Pawl    Hood and Door Hinges    Weatherstrip Conditioning    Service and Maintenance 11 19    Fluid Lubricant    Chassis Lub
161. during a  crash  young children should  always be secured in appropriate  child restraints                    Child Restraint Systems        A  Rear Facing Infant Seat    A rear facing infant seat  A  provides  restraint with the seating surface  against the back of the infant     The harness system holds the infant  in place and  in a crash  acts to  keep the infant positioned in   the restraint        Seats and Restraints    1 41        B  Forward Facing Child Seat    A forward facing child seat  B   provides restraint for the child   s body  with the harness         C  Booster Seats    A booster seat  C  is a child  restraint designed to improve the fit  of the vehicle   s safety belt system   A booster seat can also help a child  to see out the window     1 42    Securing an Add On Child  Restraint in the Vehicle    Seats and Restraints       Z  CAUTION       A child can be seriously injured  or killed in a crash if the child  restraint is not properly secured in  the vehicle  Secure the child  restraint properly in the vehicle  using the vehicle   s safety belt or  LATCH system  following the  instructions that came with that  child restraint and the instructions  in this manual                 To help reduce the chance of injury   the child restraint must be secured  in the vehicle  Child restraint  systems must be secured in vehicle  seats by lap belts or the lap belt  portion of a lap shoulder belt  or by  the LATCH system  See Lower  Anchors and Tethers for Children 
162. e     2  This device must accept any  interference received  including  interference that may cause    undesired operation of the device     Changes or modifications to this  system by other than an authorized  service facility could void  authorization to use this equipment        If there is a decrease in the  RKE operating range  try this       Check the distance   The transmitter may be  too far from the vehicle   Stand closer during rainy or  snowy weather       Check the location  Other  vehicles or objects may be  blocking the signal  Take a  few steps to the left or right   hold the transmitter higher  and  try again      Check the transmitter   s battery   See    Battery Replacement     later in this section       If the transmitter is still not  working correctly  see your  dealer retailer or a qualified  technician for service     2 4 Keys  Doors and Windows    Remote Keyless Entry   RKE  System Operation    The Remote Keyless Entry  RKE   transmitter functions work up to    30 feet  9 m  away from the vehicle           Lock   Press to lock all of the  doors and liftgate   The hazard warning flashers flash    once to confirm that the doors  have locked        u  Unlock   Press once to unlock    the driver door  If g is pressed  again within three seconds    all remaining doors unlock  The  hazard warning flashers flash twice  to confirm that the door has  unlocked     HOLD  M  Panic   Press to arm  the alarm  The lights flash and the  horn sounds  The alarm turns  
163. e     Wherever a child restraint is  installed  be sure to secure the child  restraint properly     1 44    Keep in mind that an unsecured  child restraint can move around   in a collision or sudden stop   and injure people in the vehicle    Be sure to properly secure any child  restraint in the vehicle     even  when no child is in it     Lower Anchors and  Tethers for Children   LATCH    The LATCH system holds a child    restraint during driving or in a crash   This system is designed to make    installation of a child restraint easier     The LATCH system uses anchors  in the vehicle and attachments   on the child restraint that are made  for use with the LATCH system     Seats and Restraints       Make sure that a LATCH compatible  child restraint is properly installed  using the anchors  or use the  vehicle s safety belts to secure the  restraint  following the instructions  that came with that restraint  and  also the instructions in this manual   When installing a child restraint with  a top tether  you must also use either  the lower anchors or the safety belts  to properly secure the child restraint   A child restraint must never be  installed using only the top tether  and anchor     In order to use the LATCH system in  the vehicle  you need a child restraint  has LATCH attachments  The child  restraint manufacturer provides  instructions on how to use the child  restraint and its attachments  The  following explains how to attach a  child restraint with these attac
164. e  Must be over  250 kilometres from where your  trip was started to qualify   General Motors of Canada Limited  requires pre authorization   original detailed receipts  anda  copy of the repair orders  Once  authorization has been received   the Roadside Assistance advisor  will help you make arrangements  and explain how to receive  payment     Alternative Service    If assistance cannot be provided  right away  the Roadside  Assistance advisor may give you  permission to get local emergency  road service  You will receive  payment  up to  100  after  sending the original receipt to  Roadside Assistance  Mechanical  failures may be covered  however  any cost for parts and labor for  repairs not covered by the  warranty are the owner  responsibility     12 8    Scheduling Service  Appointments   for Service     When your vehicle requires warranty  service  contact your dealer retailer  and request an appointment    By scheduling a service appointment  and advising your service consultant  of your transportation needs  your  dealer retailer can help minimize  your inconvenience     lf your vehicle cannot be scheduled  into the service department  immediately  keep driving it until it  can be scheduled for service   unless  of course  the problem is  safety related  If it is  please call  your dealership retailer  let them  know this  and ask for instructions     lf the dealer retailer requests   you to bring the vehicle for service   you are urged to do so as early   in the w
165. e Immobilizer Operation on  page 2 9 for additional information        Do not do any of the following to  keys with a transponder       Cover the key       Hit the key hard against other  objects       Expose it to high temperatures  for a long time       Put the key in water       Use the key with electromagnetic  materials     Any new Immobilizer key must be  programmed before it will start   the vehicle  See your dealer retailer   If you make your own duplicate  key  you will not be able to cancel  the system or start the vehicle     In an emergency  contact Roadside  Assistance  See Roadside  Assistance Program on page 12 5  for more information     Notice  If you ever lock your  keys in the vehicle  you may have  to damage the vehicle to get in   Be sure you have spare keys     Remote Keyless  Entry  RKE  System    If this vehicle has the Remote  Keyless Entry  RKE  system    it operates on a radio frequency  subject to Federal Communications  Commission  FCC  Rules and   with Industry Canada     This device complies with  Part 15 of the FCC Rules   Operation is subject to the  following two conditions     1  This device may not cause  interference     2  This device must accept any  interference received  including  interference that may cause    undesired operation of the device        Keys  Doors and Windows 2 3    This device complies with  RSS 210 of Industry Canada   Operation is subject to the  following two conditions     1  This device may not cause  interferenc
166. e child restraint instructions  will show you how     Seats and Restraints 1 53       3  Push the latch plate into the  buckle until it clicks     If the latch plate will not go fully  into the buckle  check if the  correct buckle is being used     Position the release button   on the buckle so that the safety  belt could be quickly unbuckled  if necessary        1 54 Seats and Restraints       4  Pull the rest of the shoulder belt  all the way out of the retractor to  set the lock          To tighten the belt  push down    on the child restraint  pull the  shoulder portion of the belt   to tighten the lap portion of the  belt  and feed the shoulder   belt back into the retractor  When  installing a forward facing child  restraint  it may be helpful to use  your knee to push down on   the child restraint as you tighten  the belt        6  If the child restraint has a top  tether  follow the child restraint  manufacturer   s instructions  regarding the use of the top  tether  See Lower Anchors and  Tethers for Children  LATCH   on page 1 44 for more  information     7  Push and pull the child restraint  in different directions to be sure  it is secure     To remove the child restraint   unbuckle the vehicle safety belt and  let it return to the stowed position    If the top tether is attached to a top  tether anchor  disconnect it     Keys  Doors and    Windows   Keys   KEYS acer eee eeeeeeene ees 2 2  Remote Keyless Entry   RKE  System 1    2 3    Remote Keyless Entry   RKE  
167. e not only  helps to keep the vehicle in good  working condition  but also helps   the environment  Improper vehicle  maintenance can even affect the  quality of the air we breathe   Improper fluid levels or the wrong tire  inflation can increase the level of  emissions from the vehicle  To help  protect the environment  and to keep  the vehicle in good condition  be sure  to maintain the vehicle properly        Service and Maintenance    How This Section is  Organized    This maintenance schedule is  divided into five parts        Part A  Scheduled Maintenance  Services    explains what to have  done and how often  Some of  these services can be complex    so unless you are technically  qualified and have the necessary  equipment  you should let your  dealer retailer do these jobs     Your dealer retailer has trained  and supported service people  that will perform the work using  genuine parts        Z  CAUTION       Performing maintenance work   on a vehicle can be dangerous    In trying to do some jobs  you can  be seriously injured  Do your own  maintenance work only if you  have the required know how and  the proper tools and equipment  for the job  If you have any doubt   have a qualified technician do the  work  See Doing Your Own          Service Work on page 9 4           To purchase service information   see Service Publications Ordering  Information on page 12 16        Part B  Owner Checks and  Services    tells what should be  checked and when  It also explains 
168. e the  lever down to  SET  Release the  lever and the accelerator pedal     e Move the cruise lever up  to  RES  Hold it there until the  desired speed is reached   and then release the lever       To increase the vehicle speed in  very small amounts  move the  lever to  RES briefly and then  release it  Each time this is done   the vehicle goes about 1 mph   1 6 km h  faster        Reducing Speed While Using  Cruise Control    There are two ways to reduce the  vehicle speed while using cruise  control       Push and hold the lever to  SET  until the desired lower speed is  reached  then release it       To slow down in very small  amounts  push the lever  down briefly  Each time this  is done  the vehicle will go about  1 mph  1 6 km h  slower     Passing Another Vehicle While  Using Cruise Control    Use the accelerator pedal to  increase the vehicle speed    When you take your foot off the  pedal  the vehicle slows down to  the cruise control speed set earlier     Using Cruise Control on Hills    The cruise control performance will  vary depending upon the vehicle  speed  load  and the steepness of  the hills        When going up steep hills  you might  have to step on the accelerator pedal  to maintain the vehicle speed     When going downhill  you might  have to brake or shift to a lower gear  to keep the vehicle speed down   Applying the brake or downshifting  to 2 SECOND or L LOW turns   off the cruise control     Ending Cruise Control    There are several ways to turn
169. e the vehicle repaired  immediately     Never park the vehicle with the  engine running in an enclosed  area such as a garage or a  building that has no fresh air  ventilation                             Running the Vehicle  While Parked  It is better not to park with the    engine running  But if you ever have  to  here are some things to know        Z  CAUTION       Idling a vehicle in an enclosed  area with poor ventilation is  dangerous  Engine exhaust may  enter the vehicle  Engine exhaust  contains Carbon Monoxide  CO   which cannot be seen or smelled   It can cause unconsciousness  and even death  Never run the  engine in an enclosed area that  has no fresh air ventilation  For  more information  see Engine  Exhaust Engine Exhaust on  page 8 16                 Driving and Operating       Z  CAUTION       It can be dangerous to get out   of the vehicle if the automatic  transmission shift lever is not fully  in P  Park  with the parking brake  firmly set  The vehicle can roll    Do not leave the vehicle when the  engine is running unless you have  to  If you have left the engine  running  the vehicle can move  suddenly  You or others could be  injured  To be sure the vehicle will  not move  even when you are on  fairly level ground  always set the  parking brake and move the shift  lever to P  Park               Follow the proper steps to be  sure the vehicle will not move     See Shifting Into Park on page 8 13     If parking on a hill and pulling a  trailer  see Towin
170. ed  with your new vehicle  However  if  you continue to remain unsatisfied  after following the procedure  outlined in Steps One and Two   you can file with the BBB Auto Line  Program to enforce your rights     The BBB Auto Line Program is an  out of court program administered  by the Council of Better Business  Bureaus to settle automotive  disputes regarding vehicle repairs or  the interpretation of the New  Vehicle Limited Warranty  Although  you may be required to resort to  this informal dispute resolution  program prior to filing a court action   use of the program is free of charge  and your case will generally be       heard within 40 days  If you do not  agree with the decision given in  your case  you may reject it   and proceed with any other venue  for relief available to you     You can contact the BBB Auto Line  Program using the toll free  telephone number or write them at  the following address     BBB Auto Line Program  Council of Better Business  Bureaus  Inc    4200 Wilson Boulevard  Suite 800   Arlington  VA 22203 1838    Telephone  1 800 955 5100  www dr bbb org goauto    This program is available in all  50 states and the District of  Columbia  Eligibility is limited by  vehicle age  mileage and other  factors  General Motors reserves  the right to change eligibility  limitations and or discontinue its  participation in this program     STEP THREE     Canadian  Owners  In the event that you do  not feel your concerns have   been addressed after following
171. ed and any  necessary replacements made   as soon as possible                 1 35    If an airbag inflates  you will need  to replace airbag system parts   See your dealer retailer for service     If the airbag readiness light stays  on after the vehicle is started   or comes on when you are driving   the airbag system may not work  properly  Have the vehicle serviced  right away  See Airbag Readiness  Light on page 4 14 for more  information     1 36 Seats and Restraints    Child Restraints  Older Children       Older children who have outgrown  booster seats should wear the  vehicle s safety belts     The manufacturer s instructions that  come with the booster seat  state the  weight and height limitations for that       booster  Use a booster seat with a  lap shoulder belt until the child  passes the below fit test     Sit all the way back on the seat   Do the knees bend at the seat  edge  If yes  continue  If no   return to the booster seat     Buckle the lap shoulder belt   Does the shoulder belt rest on the  shoulder  If yes  continue  If no   then return to the booster seat     Does the lap belt fit low and snug  on the hips  touching the thighs  If  yes  continue  If no  return to the  booster seat     Can proper safety belt fit be  maintained for the length of the  trip  If yes  continue  If no  return  to the booster seat        Q  What is the proper way to    A     wear Safety belts     An older child should wear a  lap shoulder belt and get the  additional restra
172. ee eee 8 36   Additives ar sui 8 37   California Fuel                    8 36   Filling a Portable Fuel   Container                cceeee 8 40  Filling the Tank                   8 38  Fuels in Foreign  Countries                cc eee 8 37  GaQe E NE NESS RENE see  4 24       Fuel  cont      Gasoline Octane                 8 36  Gasoline Specifications        8 36  Low Warning Light              4 25  System Inspection             11 16  Fuses   Engine Compartment   Fuse Block                 065 9 39  Fuses and Circuit   Breakers             ceccee eee 9 36  Instrument Panel Fuse   BIOGK riena 9 36  Windshield Wiper                9 36    G    Gage  Engine Coolant  Temperature 1    4 19  Fuel ccseeiansedsredediataeetnetes 4 24  Speedometer na    4 13  Tachometer a e 4 13  Gasoline  OCTANE 3 inuit lose abbed 8 36  Specifications sussie 8 36  Glove BOX        ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeee ees 3 1  GM Mobility Reimbursement  Programi 2s cais 5 ger sanina 125       H   Hazard Warning Flashers          4 3  Head Restraints                00 1 6  Headlamp   AINO acses 9 30  Headlamp Wiring 1    9 35  Headlamps   Bulb Replacement               9 31   Daytime Running Lamp         5 2   Exterior Lamps                00 5 1   Flash to Pass       4 7   Halogen Bulbs                    9 31   Headlamps and Parking   Fam PS keen 9 31   High Low Beam Changer       4 7  Heater estes cdc cntentsetenertasnekecead 7 1   Engine Coolant                 8 5  Height Adjuster  Seat                1 2  Highbea
173. ehicle Service and Care    Chemical Paint Spotting    Some weather and atmospheric  conditions can create a chemical  fallout  Airborne pollutants can   fall upon and attack painted surfaces  on the vehicle  This damage can  take two forms  blotchy  ring shaped  discolorations  and small  irregular  dark spots etched into the paint  surface     Although no defect in the paint job  causes this  we will repair  at no  charge to the owner  the surfaces  of new vehicles damaged by this  fallout condition within 12 months  or 12 000 miles  20 000 km  of  purchase  whichever occurs first        10 1    Technical Data    Technical Data    Vehicle Identification  Vehicle Identification   Number  VIN        10 1  Service Parts   Identification Label             10 1    Capacities and  Specifications  Capacities and  Specifications erener 10 2    Normal Maintenance  Replacement Parts  Maintenance    Replacement Parts            10 4  Engine Drive Belt  ROUTING si cccivnciesndctiie 10 5       Vehicle Identification    Vehicle Identification  Number  VIN     SAMPLE4UX1M072675    This is the legal identifier for your  vehicle  It appears on a plate in   the front corner of the instrument  panel  on the driver side  It can   be seen through the windshield from  outside the vehicle  The VIN also  appears on the Vehicle Certification  and Service Parts labels and the  certificates of title and registration     Engine Identification    The eighth character in the VIN is  the engine code  This
174. el  Injection System   Horn  Ignition  Meter    PTC Heater 1  PTC Heater 3    Air Conditioning          Vehicle Service and Care    Tires    Your new vehicle comes   with high quality tires made   by a leading tire manufacturer    If you ever have questions about  your tire warranty and where to  obtain service  see your vehicle  Warranty booklet for details    For additional information refer  to the tire manufacturer     9 41       CAUTION  Continued           Z  CAUTION       Poorly maintained and  improperly used tires are  dangerous    e Overloading your  vehicle   s tires can cause  overheating as a result  of too much flexing  You  could have an air out and  a serious accident  See  Loading the Vehicle on  page 8 32      Continued                    Underinflated tires pose  the same danger as  overloaded tires  The  resulting accident could  cause serious injury   Check all tires frequently to  maintain the recommended  pressure  Tire pressure  should be checked when  your vehicle   s tires are  cold  See Inflation   Tire  Pressure on page 9 47   Overinflated tires are more  likely to be cut  punctured   or broken by a sudden  impact     such as when  you hit a pothole  Keep  tires at the recommended  pressure    Worn  old tires can cause  accidents  If the tire   s tread  is badly worn  or if your  vehicle   s tires have been  damaged  replace them           9 42 Vehicle Service and Care    Tire Sidewall Labeling  Useful information about a    tire is molded into its
175. en  they are under inflated  Check  the tire   s inflation pressure when  the tires are cold  Cold means  your vehicle has been sitting for  at least three hours or driven no  more than 1 mile  1 6 km         Vehicle Service and Care    Remove the valve cap from the  tire valve stem  Press the tire  gage firmly onto the valve to   get a pressure measurement    If the cold tire inflation pressure  matches the recommended  pressure on the Tire and Loading  Information label  no further  adjustment is necessary  If the  inflation pressure is low  add air  until you reach the recommended  amount     If you overfill the tire  release air  by pushing on the metal stem   in the center of the tire valve   Re check the tire pressure with  the tire gage     Be sure to put the valve caps  back on the valve stems   They help prevent leaks by  keeping out dirt and moisture        Tire Pressure Monitor  System    The Tire Pressure Monitor System   TPMS  uses radio and sensor  technology to check tire pressure  levels  The TPMS sensors monitor  the air pressure in your vehicle   s  tires and transmit tire pressure  readings to a receiver located   in the vehicle     Each tire  including the spare    if provided   should be checked  monthly when cold and inflated to  the inflation pressure recommended  by the vehicle manufacturer on the  vehicle placard or tire inflation  pressure label   If your vehicle has  tires of a different size than the size  indicated on the vehicle placard or  tire 
176. engine  light is on with the engine  running  or if the key is in the  ON RUN and the light is not on       The vehicle will not pass  this inspection if the OBD II   on board diagnostic  system  determines that critical emission  control systems have not been  completely diagnosed by the  system  The vehicle would  be considered not ready for       Instruments and Controls    inspection  This can happen if  the battery has recently been  replaced or if the battery has run  down  The diagnostic system   is designed to evaluate critical  emission control systems  during normal driving  This can  take several days of routine  driving  If this has been done  and the vehicle still does not  pass the inspection for lack   of OBD II system readiness   your dealer retailer can prepare  the vehicle for inspection     Security Light   SECURITY O  For information regarding this light  and the vehicle   s security system     see Content Theft Deterrent  on page 2 10        Oil Pressure Light       Z  CAUTION       Do not keep driving if the oil  pressure is low  The engine can  become so hot that it catches fire   Someone could be burned  Check  the oil as soon as possible and  have the vehicle serviced              Notice  Lack of proper engine oil  maintenance can damage the  engine  The repairs would not be  covered by the vehicle warranty   Always follow the maintenance  schedule in this manual for  changing engine oil     T7    The oil pressure light should come  on briefly as the 
177. engine is started   If it does not come on have the  vehicle serviced by your  dealer retailer     If the light comes on and stays on   it means that oil is not flowing  through the engine properly    The vehicle could be low on oil and  might have some other system  problem     Fog Lamp Light     0    For vehicles with this feature   this light comes on whenever the  front fog lamps are on     See Exterior Lamps Controls on  page 5 1 for more information        Instruments and Controls 4 23    Lights On Reminder    This light comes on whenever the  headlights are on     See Exterior Lamps Controls on  page 5 1 for more information     Taillamp Indicator Light      N  Canada Only    This light will come on when your  taillamps are on     See Exterior Lamps Controls on  page 5 1 for more information        Cruise Control Light  CRUISE    The CRUISE light comes on when  the cruise control is on     See Cruise Control on page 4 4 for  more information     Low Washer Fluid  Warning Light    Canada Only    This light comes on when the  windshield washer fluid is low   See Windshield Washer Fluid on  page 9 24 for more information     4 24    Service All Wheel Drive    Light  AWD    This light will come on briefly when  the ignition is turned on  and the  engine is not running  as a check to  show you it is working     It should go out when the engine is  started  It should go out when the  engine is started  If it stays on  or  comes on while you are driving  you    may have a pro
178. eone  Store all these  in the proper place                  gt          nmoow    Vehicle Service and Care         ITA    N  PE CEN         Compact Spare Tire     Valve Stem Pointed Down   Jack      Cargo Area Floor     Tire Wheel Retainer Nut    Jack Handle     Wheel Wrench      Place the jack handle  E  and    wheel wrench  F  back in their  original location in the passenger  side of the cargo area        5     Place the jack  B  back in its  original location on the driver  side of the cargo area and close  the latch over the jack  B      Place the compact spare tire  A    valve stem pointed down  back  in its original location in the  center of the cargo area     Turn the tire wheel retainer  nut  D  clockwise to secure it  on the compact spare tire  A      Close the cargo area floor  C      Storing the Full Size Flat Tire       Z  CAUTION          Storing a jack  a tire  or other  equipment in the passenger  compartment of the vehicle could  cause injury  In a sudden stop or  collision  loose equipment could  strike someone  Store all these in  the proper place           Vehicle Service and Care 9 69    The standard tire cannot be 4  Hook the end closest to the  stored in the compact spare tire buckle  to the front cargo hooks   storage area     To store the standard flat tire     1  If your vehicle has aluminum Ks LDN  wheels  remove the center wheel Mow  N    im    cap before storing the flat tire     2  Place the flat tire on the rear  cargo area floor panel with  the
179. er Windows and  Other Power Options    Circuit breakers in the fuse block  protect the power windows and other  power accessories  When the current  load is too heavy  the circuit breaker  opens and closes  protecting the  circuit until the problem is fixed or  goes away        Vehicle Service and Care    Fuses and Circuit  Breakers    The wiring circuits in the vehicle  are protected from short circuits  by a combination of fuses  circuit  breakers and fusible thermal  links  This greatly reduces the  chance of fires caused by  electrical problems     Look at the silver colored band  inside the fuse  If the band is broken  or melted  replace the fuse  Be sure  you replace a bad fuse with a new  one of the identical size and rating     Fuses of the same amperage   can be temporarily borrowed from  another fuse location  if a fuse goes  out  Replace the fuse as soon as  you can        Instrument Panel Fuse  Block       The fuse block is located under  the instrument panel on the driver  side of the vehicle     Vehicle Service and Care 9 37    Outside Rearview  Mirrors  Audio  System  Main Body  Engine Control   Unit  ECU   Clock   Brake Transmission  Shift Interlock    Airbag System   Multiport Fuel  Injection System   Sequential Multiport    Fuel Injection  System  Front  Passenger Occupant  Classification  System      Fuses     Parking Lamps  LE  License Plate Air Conditioning  Lamps  Taillamp    13 System  Rear  Multiport Fuel Window Defogger  Injection System    6 Sunroof 
180. ered under   the vehicle warranty     Some gasolines that are   not reformulated for low   emissions can contain an  octane enhancing additive called  methylcyclopentadienyl manganese  tricarbonyl  MMT   ask the attendant  where you buy gasoline whether the  fuel contains MMT  We recommend  against the use of such gasolines     Driving and Operating 8 37    Fuels containing MMT can reduce  the life of spark plugs and the  performance of the emission   control system could be affected   The malfunction indicator lamp might  turn on  If this occurs  return to your  dealer retailer for service     Fuels in Foreign  Countries    If you plan on driving in another  country outside the United States or  Canada  the proper fuel might be  hard to find  Never use leaded  gasoline or any other fuel not  recommended in the previous text  on fuel  Costly repairs caused   by use of improper fuel would not  be covered by the vehicle warranty     To check the fuel availability  ask  an auto club  or contact a major  oil company that does business  in the country where you will   be driving        8 38    Filling the Tank       Z  CAUTION       Fuel vapor burns violently and a  fuel fire can cause bad injuries   To help avoid injuries to you and  others  read and follow all the  instructions on the pump island   Turn off the engine when you are  refueling  Do not smoke if you are  near fuel or refueling the vehicle   Do not use cellular phones  Keep  sparks  flames  and smoking  materials awa
181. etc  You are responsible for fuel  usage charges and may also be  responsible for taxes  levies  usage  fees  excessive mileage  or rental  usage beyond the completion of   the repair     It may not be possible to provide a  like vehicle as a courtesy rental        Additional Program  Information    All program options  such as shuttle  service  may not be available at  every dealer  Please contact   your dealer for specific information  about availability  All Courtesy  Transportation arrangements   will be administered by appropriate  dealer personnel     General Motors reserves the right  to unilaterally modify  change   or discontinue Courtesy  Transportation at any time and to  resolve all questions of claim  eligibility pursuant to the terms and  conditions described herein at   its sole discretion        Collision Damage Repair    If your vehicle is involved in a  collision and it is damaged  have  the damage repaired by a qualified  technician using the proper  equipment and quality replacement  parts  Poorly performed collision  repairs diminish your vehicle   s resale  value  and safety performance can  be compromised in subsequent  collisions     Collision Parts    Genuine GM Collision parts are   new parts made with the same  materials and construction methods  as the parts with which your vehicle  was originally built  Genuine GM  Collision parts are your best choice  to ensure that your vehicle   s  designed appearance  durability  and  safety are preserved  The
182. etermined that the  condition is caused by the type of  fuel used  repairs might not be  covered by the vehicle warranty     Additives    To provide cleaner air  all gasolines  in the United States are now required  to contain additives that help prevent  engine and fuel system deposits  from forming  allowing the emission  control system to work properly    In most cases  you should not have  to add anything to the fuel  However   some gasolines contain only   the minimum amount of additive  required to meet U S  Environmental  Protection Agency regulations    To help keep fuel injectors and  intake valves clean  or if the vehicle  experiences problems due to dirty  injectors or valves  look for gasoline  that is advertised as TOP TIER  Detergent Gasoline  Also  your  dealer retailer has additives that   will help correct and prevent most  deposit related problems     Gasolines containing oxygenates   such as ethers and ethanol  and  reformulated gasolines might   be available in your area        We recommend that you use these  gasolines  if they comply with the  specifications described earlier   However  E85  85  ethanol  and  other fuels containing more than  10  ethanol must not be used in  vehicles that were not designed for  those fuels     Notice  This vehicle was not  designed for fuel that contains  methanol  Do not use fuel  containing methanol  It can  corrode metal parts in the fuel  system and also damage plastic  and rubber parts  That damage  would not be cov
183. f the straps  to the hooks in a criss cross  pattern  Pull on the straps at the  buckle to tighten as needed     Cargo Management  System    A cargo management system    for vehicles that have it  can be  used for organizing and separating  items in the rear of the vehicle           To use   1  Open the cover     2  Unfold the side panels out and  lock them into place to hold up  the cover     3  Hook the nets into the cover  slots on the lid to use as  dividers        There are also hooks on the inside  cover to hold items     Additional storage is available on  both sides of the cargo management  system  Turn the knobs to the  UNLOCK position  and remove   the deck boards to access the  storage area     Instruments and  Controls    Instrument Panel    Overview  Instrument Panel   Overview              ssssseseeeeeeeeeeee 4 2  Hazard Warning Flashers     4 3  fale   alee ener es eer reer te 4 3  Tilt Wheel           00  eeeeeeeeeees 4 4  Turn Signal Multifunction   LOVET Senstneccsticeidiretenacenrted 4  Cruise Control  s es 4 4  Turn and Lane Change   Signals srcsrer iej 4 7  Headlamp High    Low Beam Changer            4 7  Flash to Pass          sssseeeeree 4 7  Windshield Wipers                4 7  Windshield Washer               4 8  Rear Window Wiper    Washer               00eeeeeeeee ees 4 8  Accessory Power   OUTEUS  krn 4 9       Power Outlet 115 Volt  Alternating Current  Ashtray s     Warning Lights  Gages     and Indicators  Warning Lights  Gages   and Indicator
184. f the warning light comes on  there  is a brake problem  Have the brake  system inspected right away     O    Canada    BRAKE    United States    If the vehicle has anti lock brakes   this light should come on when  the key is turned to START        Instruments and Controls    If it does not come on  have it  fixed so it will be ready to warn if  there is a problem     When the ignition is on  the brake  system warning light also comes  on when the parking brake is   set  The light will stay on if the    parking brake does not fully release     If it stays on after the parking  brake is fully released  it means  there is a brake problem     4 17       Z  CAUTION       The brake system might not be  working properly if the brake  system warning light is on   Driving with the brake system  warning light on can lead toa  crash  If the light is still on after the  vehicle has been pulled off the  road and carefully stopped  have  the vehicle towed for service                 See Antilock Brake System  ABS   Warning Light later in this section  and Towing Your Vehicle on  page 9 75     4 18    Antilock Brake System   ABS  Warning Light    OH    Canada    ABS    United States    The ABS warning light comes on  briefly when the ignition key is  turned to ON RUN  This is normal   If the light does not come on then   have it fixed so it will be ready   to warn you if there is a problem     If the light stays on  turn the ignition  to LOCK OFF  If the light comes   on while driving  st
185. f your  shoulder belt is too loose  In a  crash  you would move forward  too much  which could increase  injury  The shoulder belt should fit       snugly against your body              Q  What is wrong with this              A  The lap belt is too loose  It will  not give nearly as much  protection this way              Seats and Restraints 1 13       Z  CAUTION    Z  CAUTION       You can be seriously hurt if your  lap belt is too loose  In a crash   you could slide under the lap belt  and apply force on your abdomen   This could cause serious or even  fatal injuries  The lap belt should  be worn low and snug on the  hips  just touching the thighs              Q  What is wrong with this                 A  The belt is buckled in the wrong  buckle        You can be seriously injured if  your belt is buckled in the wrong  place like this  In a crash  the belt  would go up over your abdomen   The belt forces would be there   not on the pelvic bones  This  could cause serious internal  injuries  Always buckle your belt  into the buckle nearest you              1 14 Seats and Restraints    Q  What is wrong with this                       A  The belt is over an armrest           Z  CAUTION          You can be seriously injured if  your belt goes over an armrest  like this  The belt would be much  too high  In a crash  you can slide  under the belt  The belt force  would then be applied on the  abdomen  not on the pelvic  bones  and that could cause  serious or fatal injuries  Be s
186. failure   to pass a required Emission  Inspection Maintenance test    See Accessories and  Modifications on page 9 3     This light comes on during a  malfunction in one of two ways     Light Flashing  A misfire condition  has been detected  A misfire  increases vehicle emissions and  could damage the emission control  system on the vehicle  Diagnosis  and service might be required     The following can prevent more  serious damage to the vehicle     e Reduce vehicle speed     Avoid hard accelerations     Avoid steep uphill grades       If towing a trailer  reduce the  amount of cargo being hauled  as soon as it is possible     If the light continues to flash  when  it is safe to do so  stop the vehicle   Find a safe place to park the  vehicle  Turn the key off  wait at  least 10 seconds  and restart   the engine  If the light is still  flashing  follow the previous steps  and see your dealer retailer for  service as soon as possible        Instruments and Controls 4 21    Light On Steady  An emission  control system malfunction has been  detected on the vehicle  Diagnosis  and service might be required     An emission system malfunction  might be corrected by doing  the following     Make sure the fuel cap is fully  installed  See Filling the Tank on  page 8 38  The diagnostic system  can determine if the fuel cap   has been left off or improperly  installed  A loose or missing fuel  cap allows fuel to evaporate into  the atmosphere  A few driving  trips with the cap properl
187. fety belt with the shoulder belt  behind their back  A child can be  seriously injured by not wearing  the lap shoulder belt properly  Ina  crash  the child would not be  restrained by the shoulder belt      Continued                    1 38    Infants and Young  Children    Everyone in a vehicle needs  protection  This includes infants  and all other children  Neither the  distance traveled nor the age   and size of the traveler changes the  need  for everyone  to use safety  restraints  In fact  the law in   every state in the United States and  in every Canadian province says  children up to some age must   be restrained while in a vehicle     Seats and Restraints       Z  CAUTION       Children can be seriously injured  or strangled if a shoulder belt is  wrapped around their neck and  the safety belt continues to  tighten  Never leave children  unattended in a vehicle and never  allow children to play with the  safety belts                 Airbags plus lap shoulder belts offer  protection for adults and older  children  but not for young children  and infants  Neither the vehicle   s  safety belt system nor its airbag  system is designed for them        Every time infants and young  children ride in vehicles  they should  have the protection provided by  appropriate child restraints  Every  time infants and young children ride  in vehicles  they should have the  protection provided by appropriate  child restraints     Children who are not restrained  properly can strike 
188. filter  if you are driving in dusty    light and safety belt assemblies  are working properly  Look for  any other loose or damaged  safety belt system parts  If you  see anything that might keep   a safety belt system from   doing its job  have it repaired   Have any torn or frayed safety  belts replaced  Also see  Airbag System Check on   page 1 35    Replace passenger compartment  air filter     Inspect fuel tank  cap  cap  gasket  and lines for damage   or leaks  or every 24 months   whichever occurs first   Replace  parts as needed  An Emission  Control Service   See footnote f      Change manual transmission  fluid every 30 000 miles    48 000 km  only if your vehicle  is used to tow a trailer         or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See footnote        Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     40 000 Miles  64 000 km   Q Change engine oil and filter     or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection    and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See footnote           conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     45 000 Miles  72 000 km     m     m     Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Em
189. for a  basecoat clearcoat paint finish        Vehicle Service and Care    Notice  Machine compounding  or aggressive polishing ona  basecoat clearcoat paint finish  may damage it  Use only  non abrasive waxes and polishes  that are made for a basecoat   clearcoat paint finish on your  vehicle     Foreign materials such as calcium  chloride and other salts  ice melting  agents  road oil and tar  tree sap   bird droppings  chemicals from  industrial chimneys  etc   can  damage your vehicle   s finish if they  remain on painted surfaces  Wash  the vehicle as soon as possible    If necessary  use non abrasive  cleaners that are marked safe for  painted surfaces to remove foreign  matter        Exterior painted surfaces are subject  to aging  weather and chemical  fallout that can take their toll over   a period of years  You can help to  keep the paint finish looking new by  keeping your vehicle garaged or  covered whenever possible     Protecting Exterior Bright Metal  Parts    Bright metal parts should be  cleaned regularly to keep their  luster  Wash with water or   use chrome polish on chrome or  stainless steel trim  if necessary     Use special care with aluminum  trim  To avoid damaging protective  trim  never use auto or chrome  polish  steam or caustic soap to  clean aluminum  A coating of   wax  rubbed to high polish  is  recommended for all bright metal  parts     Washing Your Vehicle    The best way to preserve your  vehicle s finish is to keep it clean by  washing it
190. g  as you would  be if you were sitting on the edge  of your seat or leaning forward   Safety belts help keep you in  position before and during a  crash  Always wear your safety  belt  even with airbags  The driver  should sit as far back as possible  while still maintaining control of  the vehicle     Occupants should not lean on or  sleep against the door or side  windows in seating positions with  seat mounted side impact airbags  and or roof rail airbags        Children who are up against  or  very close to  any airbag when it  inflates can be seriously injured or  killed  Airbags plus lap shoulder  belts offer protection for adults  and older children  but not for  young children and infants   Neither the vehicle   s safety belt  system nor its airbag system is  designed for them  Young children  and infants need the protection  that a child restraint system can  provide  Always secure children  properly in your vehicle  To read  how  see Older Children on   page 1 36 or Infants and Young  Children on page 1 38                             1 23    Seats and Restraints    There is an airbag readiness light  on the instrument panel cluster   which shows the airbag symbol   The system checks the airbag  electrical system for malfunctions   The light tells you if there is an  electrical problem  See Airbag  Readiness Light on page 4 14   for more information        Where Are the Airbags        The driver frontal airbag is in the  middle of the steering wheel     The right fr
191. g a Trailer  on page 9 77        8 17    Driving Your Vehicle  Defensive Driving    Defensive driving means    always  expect the unexpected     The first  step in driving defensively is to wear  your safety belt  see Safety Belts on  page 1 8        Z  CAUTION       Assume that other road users   pedestrians  bicyclists  and other  drivers  are going to be careless  and make mistakes  Anticipate  what they might do and be ready   In addition      Allow enough following  distance between you and  the driver in front of you      Focus on the task of driving     Driver distraction can cause  collisions resulting in injury or  possible death  These simple  defensive driving techniques  could save your life              8 18    Drunk Driving       Z  CAUTION       Drinking and then driving is   very dangerous  Your reflexes   perceptions  attentiveness  and  judgment can be affected by   even a small amount of alcohol   You can have a serious     or even  fatal     collision if you drive after  drinking  Do not drink and drive or  ride with a driver who has been  drinking  Ride home in a cab  or if  you are with a group  designate a  driver who will not drink              Death and injury associated with  drinking and driving is a global  tragedy     Alcohol affects four things that  anyone needs to drive a vehicle   judgment  muscular coordination   vision  and attentiveness        Driving and Operating    Police records show that   almost 40 percent of all motor  vehicle relate
192. g safety belts     A label on the sun visor says    Never put a rear facing child  restraint in the front     This is  because the risk to the rear facing  child is so great  if the airbag  deploys     Seats and Restraints    1 43       Z  CAUTION    CAUTION  Continued           A child in a rear facing child  restraint can be seriously injured or  killed if the right front passenger  airbag inflates  This is because  the back of the rear facing child  restraint would be very close to  the inflating airbag  A child ina  forward facing child restraint can  be seriously injured or killed if   the right front passenger airbag  inflates and the passenger seat is  in a forward position     Even if the passenger sensing  system has turned off the right  front passenger frontal airbag  no  system is fail safe  No one can  guarantee that an airbag will not  deploy under some unusual  circumstance  even though it is  turned off      Continued                 Secure rear facing child restraints  in a rear seat  even if the airbag is  off  If you secure a forward facing  child restraint in the right front seat   always move the front passenger  seat as far back as it will go  Itis  better to secure the child restraint  in a rear seat     See Passenger Sensing System  on page 1 28 for additional  information              When securing a child restraint in  a rear seating position  study   the instructions that came with the  child restraint to make sure it is  compatible with this vehicl
193. gh  An audible warning  will sound and the downshift will  not be allowed  The downshift  request will have to be made  again once the vehicle reaches  an acceptable speed     Downshift Required   Requested Vehicle Speed  4  Fourth  to Below 95 mph  3  Third   153 km h            3  Third  to Below 60 mph  2  Second   97 km h   2  Second  to Below 30 mph  1  First   48 km h        8 11    Driving and Operating    Manual Transmission  Operation       1  First   Press the clutch pedal and  shift into 1  First   Then  slowly let  up on the clutch pedal as you press  the accelerator pedal        You can shift into 1  First  when  you are going less than 20 mph   32 km h   If you have come to a  complete stop and it is hard to shift  into 1  First   put the shift lever in  NEUTRAL and let up on the clutch   Press the clutch pedal back down   Then shift into 1  First      2  Second   Press the clutch pedal  as you let up on the accelerator  pedal and shift into 2  Second    Then  slowly let up on the clutch  pedal as you press the accelerator  pedal     3  Third   4  Fourth   5  Fifth    Shift into 3  Third   4  Fourth   and 5  Fifth  the same way you  do for 2  Second   Slowly let up  on the clutch pedal as you press  the accelerator pedal        To stop  let up on the accelerator  pedal and press the brake pedal   Just before the vehicle stops  press  the clutch pedal and the brake pedal   and shift to NEUTRAL     Neutral  Use this position when  you start or idle the engine     
194. ginal location  making sure the tabs reengage     Replacement Bulbs  Bulb  Number  9005  9006    7443    For replacement bulbs not listed  here  contact your dealer retailer     Exterior Lamp    High beam  Headlamps    Low beam  Headlamps    Sidemarker  Lamp Stoplamp   Taillamp          Vehicle Service and Care    Electrical System    Add On Electrical  Equipment    Notice  Do not add anything  electrical to the vehicle unless you  check with your dealer retailer  first  Some electrical equipment  can damage the vehicle and the  damage would not be covered by  the vehicle   s warranty  Some  add on electrical equipment can  keep other components from  working as they should        9 35    Add on equipment can drain the  vehicle battery  even if the vehicle  is not operating     The vehicle has an airbag system   Before attempting to add anything  electrical to the vehicle  see  Servicing Your Airbag Equipped  Vehicle on page 1 33     Headlamp Wiring    The headlamp wiring is protected  by a circuit breaker  An electrical  overload will cause the lamps to   go on and off  or in some cases to  remain off  If this happens  have your  headlamp wiring checked right away     9 36    Windshield Wiper Fuses    The windshield wiper motor is  protected by a circuit breaker and  a fuse  If the motor overheats due  to heavy snow or ice  the wiper will  stop until the motor cools  If the  overload is caused by some  electrical problem  and not snow  or ice  be sure to get it fixed     Pow
195. gine  operates  Before adding electrical  equipment  check with your  dealer retailer  If you do not    the engine might not perform  properly  Any resulting damage  would not be covered by the  vehicle warranty     Engine Coolant Heater    The engine coolant heater  if  available  can help in cold weather  conditions at or below 0  F     18  C   for easier starting and better fuel  economy during engine warm up   Plug in the coolant heater at least    four hours before starting the vehicle     Driving and Operating 8 5    To Use the Engine Coolant   Heater   1  Turn off the engine    2  Open the hood and unwrap the  electrical cord  The electrical    cord is located on the driver side  of the engine compartment     3  Plug it into a normal  grounded  110 volt AC outlet        Z  CAUTION       Plugging the cord into an  ungrounded outlet could cause   an electrical shock  Also  the  wrong kind of extension cord could  overheat and cause a fire  You  could be seriously injured  Plug the  cord into a properly grounded  three prong 110 volt AC outlet    If the cord will not reach  use a  heavy duty three prong extension  cord rated for at least 15 amps                 8 6 Driving and Operating    4  Before starting the engine  be  sure to unplug and store the  cord as it was before to keep  it away from moving engine  parts  If you do not  it could  be damaged     The length of time the heater should  remain plugged in depends on  several factors  Ask a dealer retailer  in the a
196. glass  Remove any accidental  over spray from other surfaces  immediately  To prevent over spray   apply cleaner directly to the cleaning  cloth     Notice  If you use abrasive  cleaners when cleaning glass  surfaces on your vehicle  you  could scratch the glass and or  cause damage to the rear window  defogger  When cleaning the glass  on your vehicle  use only a soft  cloth and glass cleaner     Many cleaners contain solvents that  may become concentrated in your  vehicle   s breathing space  Before  using cleaners  read and adhere to  all safety instructions on the label   While cleaning your vehicle   s interior        9 83    maintain adequate ventilation by  opening your vehicle   s doors and  windows     Dust may be removed from small  buttons and knobs using a small  brush with soft bristles     Your dealer retailer has a product for  cleaning your vehicle   s glass  You  can also obtain a product from your  dealer retailer to remove odors from  your vehicle   s upholstery     Do not clean your vehicle using the  following cleaners or techniques       Never use a knife or any  other sharp object to remove a  soil from any interior surface       Never use a stiff brush  It can  cause damage to your vehicle   s  interior surfaces     e Never apply heavy pressure or  rub aggressively with a cleaning  cloth  Use of heavy pressure can  damage the interior and does not  improve the effectiveness of soil  removal     9 84    Use only mild  neutral pH soaps   Avoid laundry de
197. h wheel     ABS can change the brake pressure  to each wheel  as required  faster  than any driver could  This can help  you steer around the obstacle while  braking hard     As you brake  the computer keeps  receiving updates on wheel speed  and controls braking pressure  accordingly     Remember  ABS does not change  the time you need to get your foot  up to the brake pedal or always       decrease stopping distance  If you  get too close to the vehicle in front of  you  you will not have time to apply  the brakes if that vehicle suddenly  slows or stops  Always leave enough  room up ahead to stop  even though  you have ABS     Using ABS    Do not pump the brakes  Just hold  the brake pedal down firmly and  let antilock work for you  You might  hear the antilock pump or motor  operate  and feel the brake   pedal pulsate  but this is normal     Braking in Emergencies    With ABS  you can steer and  brake at the same time  In many  emergencies  steering can help  you more than even the very best  braking     8 21    Driving and Operating    Traction Control  System  TCS     Your vehicle has a traction control  system that limits wheel spin  This   is especially useful in slippery road  conditions  The system operates  only if it senses that one or both of  the drive wheels are spinning or  beginning to lose traction  When this  happens  the system works the front  brakes and reduces engine power to  limit wheel spin     You may feel or hear the system  working  but this is no
198. he full width of the belt  to spread impact forces  If a belt  is twisted  make it straight so it  can work properly  or ask your  dealer retailer to fix it                 Lap Shoulder Belt    All seating positions in the vehicle  have a lap shoulder belt     The following instructions explain   how to wear a lap shoulder belt   properly    1  Adjust the seat so you can sit up  straight  To see how  see    Seats     in the Index        2  Pick up the latch plate and pull  the belt across you  Do not let  it get twisted        The lap shoulder belt may lock  if you pull the belt across   you very quickly  If this happens   let the belt go back slightly to  unlock it  Then pull the belt  across you more slowly     If the shoulder portion of a  passenger belt is pulled out all  the way  the child restraint  locking feature may be engaged   If this happens  let the belt go  back all the way and start again          Push the latch plate into the  buckle until it clicks     If the latch plate will not go fully  into the buckle  check if the  correct buckle is being used     Pull up on the latch plate to make  sure it is secure  If the belt is   not long enough  see Safety Belt  Extender on page 1 19     Position the release button on  the buckle so that the safety belt  could be quickly unbuckled if  necessary        4  If equipped with a shoulder belt    height adjuster  move it to the  height that is right for you    See    Shoulder Belt Height  Adjustment    later in this secti
199. he tether over the  seatback        If the position you are using  has an adjustable headrest  or head restraint and   you are using a dual tether   route the tether around   the headrest or head  restraint        If the position you are using  has an adjustable headrest  or head restraint and you are  using a single tether  raise  the headrest or head  restraint and route the tether  under the headrest or head  restraint and in between the  headrest or head restraint  posts     3  Push and pull the child restraint  in different directions to be sure  it is Secure     Seats and Restraints       1 49    Replacing LATCH  System Parts After a  Crash       Z  CAUTION    A crash can damage the LATCH  system in the vehicle  A damaged  LATCH system may not properly  secure the child restraint  resulting  in serious injury or even death in  a crash  To help make sure the  LATCH system is working  properly after a crash  see your  dealer retailer to have the system  inspected and any necessary  replacements made as soon as  possible                 If the vehicle has the LATCH  system and it was being used during  a crash  new LATCH system   parts may be needed     1 50    New parts and repairs may be  necessary even if the LATCH  system was not being used at the  time of the crash     Securing Child Restraints   Right Front Seat     This vehicle has airbags  A rear  seat is a safer place to secure  a forward facing child restraint   See Where to Put the Restraint  on page 1 43     In
200. heels or  tires  Keep your spare tire and   its wheel together     Notice  Tire chains will not   fit the compact spare  Using  them can damage the vehicle  and can damage the chains too   Do not use tire chains on the  compact spare     Jump Starting    lf your vehicle s battery has run  down  you may want to use another  vehicle and some jumper cables   to start your vehicle  Be sure to use  the following steps to do it safely        Z  CAUTION       Batteries can hurt you  They can  be dangerous because     They contain acid that can  burn you     They contain gas that can  explode or ignite     They contain enough  electricity to burn you   If you do not follow these steps    exactly  some or all of these  things can hurt you                 Vehicle Service and Care    Notice  Ignoring these steps  could result in costly damage  to your vehicle that would not  be covered by your warranty     Trying to start your vehicle   by pushing or pulling it will  not work  and it could damage  your vehicle     1  Check the other vehicle  It must  have a 12 volt battery with a  negative ground system     Notice  If the other vehicle   s  system is not a 12 volt system  with a negative ground  both  vehicles can be damaged  Only  use vehicles with 12 volt systems  with negative grounds to jump  start your vehicle     2  Get the vehicles close enough  so the jumper cables can reach   but be sure the vehicles are not  touching each other  If they are  it  could cause a ground connection
201. hments  in the vehicle        Not all vehicle seating positions or  child restraints have lower anchors  and attachments or top tether  anchors and attachments     Lower Anchors       Lower anchors  A  are metal bars  built into the vehicle  There are  two lower anchors for each  LATCH seating position that will  accommodate a child restraint with  lower attachments  B      Top Tether Anchor       A top tether  A  C  anchors the   top of the child restraint to the  vehicle  A top tether anchor is built  into the vehicle  The top tether  attachment  B  on the child restraint  connects to the top tether anchor in  the vehicle in order to reduce the  forward movement and rotation of  the child restraint during driving or in  a crash        The child restraint may have a single  tether  A  or a dual tether  C   Either  will have a single attachment  B  to  secure the top tether to the anchor     Some child restraints with top  tethers are designed for use with or  without the top tether being attached   Others require the top tether always  to be attached  In Canada  the law  requires that forward facing child  restraints have a top tether  and that  the tether be attached  Be sure to  read and follow the instructions for  the child restraint     If the child restraint does not have a  top tether  one can be obtained   in kit form  for many child restraints   Ask the child restraint manufacturer  whether or not a kit is available     Seats and Restraints 1 45    Lower Anchor and 
202. ht  front passenger head and chest   However  they are only designed  to inflate if the impact exceeds a       predetermined deployment  threshold  Deployment thresholds  are used to predict how severe a  crash is likely to be in time for the  airbags to inflate and help restrain  the occupants     Whether the frontal airbags will or  should deploy is not based on  how fast the vehicle is traveling    It depends largely on what you hit   the direction of the impact    and how quickly your vehicle  slows down     Frontal airbags may inflate at  different crash speeds  For example     e lf the vehicle hits a stationary  object  the airbags could inflate at  a different crash speed than if the  vehicle hits a moving object       Ifthe vehicle hits an object that  deforms  the airbags could inflate  at a different crash speed than if  the vehicle hits an object that  does not deform     e Ifthe vehicle hits a narrow object   like a pole   the airbags could  inflate at a different crash speed  than if the vehicle hits a wide  object  like a wall        Ifthe vehicle goes into an object  at an angle  the airbags could  inflate at a different crash speed  than if the vehicle goes straight  into the object     Thresholds can also vary with  specific vehicle design     Frontal airbags are not intended   to inflate during vehicle rollovers   rear impacts  or in many side  impacts  Frontal airbags for the  driver and right front passenger  may also deploy if a serious impact  occurs to 
203. icle  and  can be used with OnStar Pre Paid  Minute Packages  Most vehicles  include 30 trial minutes good for   60 days  Hands Free Calling can  also be linked to a Verizon Wireless  service plan in the U S  or a Bell  Mobility service plan in Canada   depending on eligibility     To find out more  refer to the OnStar  Owner s Guide in the vehicle   s glove  box  visit www onstar com or  www onstar ca  or speak with   an OnStar advisor by pressing   the OnStar button or calling  1 888 4 ONSTAR  1 888 466 7827      OnStar Virtual Advisor    OnStar Virtual Advisor is a feature of  OnStar Hands Free Calling that uses  minutes to access location based  weather  local traffic reports  and  stock quotes  Press the phone  button and give a few simple voice  commands to browse through the  various topics  See the OnStar  Owner s Guide for more information   This feature is only available in the  continental U S     How OnStar Service Works    The OnStar system can record   and transmit vehicle information   This information is automatically  sent to an OnStar Call Center when  the OnStar button is pressed  the  emergency button is pressed  or if       Instruments and Controls    the airbags deploy  This information  usually includes the vehicles GPS  location and  in the event of a crash   additional information regarding the  crash that the vehicle was involved in   e g  the direction from which the  vehicle was hit   When the Virtual  Advisor feature of OnStar  Hands Free Calling 
204. ight  front end  or side sheet metal  they may  keep the airbag system from  working properly  Changing or  moving any parts of the front  seats  safety belts  the airbag  sensing and diagnostic module   steering wheel  instrument  panel  roof rail airbag modules   ceiling headliner or pillar  garnish trim  front sensors  or  airbag wiring can affect the  operation of the airbag system        In addition  the vehicle has a  passenger sensing system for the  right front passenger position   which includes sensors that are  part of the passenger   s seat    The passenger sensing system  may not operate properly if the  original seat trim is replaced with  non GM covers  upholstery or  trim  or with GM covers   upholstery or trim designed for a  different vehicle  Any object  such  as an aftermarket seat heater or a  comfort enhancing pad or device   installed under or on top of the  seat fabric  could also interfere  with the operation of the  passenger sensing system    This could either prevent proper  deployment of the passenger  airbag s  or prevent the  passenger sensing system from  properly turning off the passenger  airbag s   See Passenger  Sensing System on page 1 28     If you have any questions  call  Customer Assistance  The phone  numbers and addresses for  Customer Assistance are in   Step Two of the Customer  Satisfaction Procedure in       this manual  See Customer  Satisfaction Procedure on  page 12 1    Q  Because   have a disability    I have to get my vehic
205. il is not completely  removed  use a mild soap  solution and repeat the cleaning  process that was used with  plain water     If any of the soil remains  a  commercial fabric cleaner or spot  lifter may be necessary  When a  commercial upholstery cleaner or  spot lifter is to be used  test a small  hidden area for colorfastness first    If the locally cleaned area gives any  impression that a ring formation may  result  clean the entire surface     After the cleaning process has been  completed  a paper towel can be  used to blot excess moisture   from the fabric or carpet        Vehicle Service and Care    Leather    A soft cloth dampened with   water can be used to remove dust   If a more thorough cleaning is  necessary  a soft cloth dampened  with a mild soap solution can be  used  Allow the leather to dry  naturally  Do not use heat to dry   Never use steam to clean leather   Never use spot lifters or spot  removers on leather  Many  commercial leather cleaners and  coatings that are sold to preserve  and protect leather may permanently  change the appearance and   feel of your leather and are not  recommended  Do not use silicone  or wax based products  or those  containing organic solvents to clean  your vehicle   s interior because   they can alter the appearance by  increasing the gloss in a non uniform  manner  Never use shoe polish on  leather        9 85    Instrument Panel  Vinyl  and  Other Plastic Surfaces    A soft cloth dampened with water  may be used to remo
206. ill go  It is  better to secure the child restraint  in a rear seat     See Passenger Sensing System  on page 1 28 for additional  information              If the child restraint has the LATCH  system  see Lower Anchors and  Tethers for Children  LATCH  on  page 1 44 for how to install the child  restraint using LATCH  If a child  restraint is secured in the seating  position using a safety belt and it  uses a top tether  see Lower Anchors  and Tethers for Children  LATCH   on page 1 44 for top tether anchor  locations     Do not secure a child seat in a  position without a top tether anchor  if a national or local law requires  that the top tether be anchored    or if the instructions that come with  the child restraint say that the   top strap must be anchored     In Canada  the law requires that  forward facing child restraints have  a top tether  and that the tether   be attached        You will be using the lap shoulder  belt to secure the child restraint in  this position  Follow the instructions  that came with the child restraint     1  Move the seat as far back as it  will go before securing the  forward facing child restraint     When the passenger sensing  system has turned off the   right front passenger frontal   and seat mounted side impact  airbag  the off indicator on   the passenger airbag status  indicator should light and stay lit  when you start the vehicle    See Passenger Airbag Status  Indicator on page 4 15     2  Put the child restraint on the seat   
207. inflation pressure label  you  should determine the proper tire  inflation pressure for those tires      As an added safety feature  your  vehicle has been equipped with   a tire pressure monitoring system   TPMS  that illuminates a low  tire pressure telltale when one or  more of your tires is significantly  under inflated     Accordingly  when the low tire  pressure telltale illuminates  you  should stop and check your tires as  soon as possible  and inflate them  to the proper pressure  Driving on  a significantly under inflated tire  causes the tire to overheat and can  lead to tire failure  Under inflation  also reduces fuel efficiency and  tire tread life  and may affect the  vehicle s handling and stopping  ability     Please note that the TPMS is   not a substitute for proper tire  maintenance  and it is the driver s  responsibility to maintain correct  tire pressure  even if under inflation  has not reached the level to trigger  illumination of the TPMS low tire  pressure telltale        Vehicle Service and Care    Your vehicle has also been  equipped with a TPMS malfunction  indicator to indicate when the system  is not operating properly  The TPMS  malfunction indicator is combined  with the low tire pressure telltale   When the system detects a  malfunction  the telltale will flash   for approximately one minute and    then remain continuously illuminated     This sequence will continue upon  subsequent vehicle start ups as  long as the malfunction exists     When
208. ing  Press again   and the system begins playing  audio from the connected portable  audio player        Infotainment 6 9    Using an MP3    MP3 CD R Disc  MP3 Format    The MP3 player will only play  CD R discs  It can read and play a  maximum of     e 50 folders     11 folders in depth     50 playlists   e 10 sessions   e 255 files   All folders  playlists  sessions and   files over the maximum are ignored    Record an MP3 disc      Onto a CD R disc    e Record playlists with an  m3u or   wpl extension      Do not mix standard audio and  MP3 files on the same disc      Record the entire disc at once      Finalize the disc when recording  an MP3 disc with multiple  sessions     6 10 Infotainment    Root Directory    The root directory is treated as a  folder  All  mp3 files in the root  directory are accessed before  folders in the root directory     Empty Directory or Folder    Empty folders and directories do  not display  The system ignores  empty directories and folders and  advances to the next directory   or folder that has  mp3 files in it     No Folder    On a CD that contains only  mp3  files in the root directory the   next and previous folder functions  do not work     On a CD that contains playlists   and  mp3 files the next and previous  folder functions search playlists   first and then search  mp3 files in  the root folder        Order of Play    CDs that have playlists play the  tracks in the following order     1  After the first track in the first  playlist
209. ing a  safety belt     A  You could be     whether you are  wearing a safety belt or not  But  your chance of being conscious  during and after an accident  so  you can unbuckle and get out  is  much greater if you are belted   And you can unbuckle a safety  belt  even if you are upside down     Q  If my vehicle has airbags  why  should I have to wear safety  belts     A  Airbags are supplemental  systems only  so they work with  safety belts     not instead of  them  Whether or not an airbag is  provided  all occupants still have  to buckle up to get the most  protection  That is true not only in  frontal collisions  but especially in  side and other collisions        Q  If I am a good driver  and I  never drive far from home   why should I wear safety  belts     A  You may be an excellent driver   but if you are in a crash     even  one that is not your fault     you  and your passenger s  can be  hurt  Being a good driver does not  protect you from things beyond  your control  such as bad drivers     Most accidents occur within   25 miles  40 km  of home  And  the greatest number of serious  injuries and deaths occur at  speeds of less than 40 mph   65 km h      Safety belts are for everyone     Seats and Restraints       1 11    How to Wear Safety Belts  Properly    This section is only for people of  adult size     Be aware that there are special  things to know about safety   belts and children  And there are  different rules for smaller children  and infants  If a chil
210. ington D C   20590    You can also obtain other  information about motor  vehicle safety from  http   www safercar gov        12 15    Reporting Safety Defects  to the Canadian  Government    If you live in Canada  and you  believe that your vehicle has   a safety defect  notify Transport  Canada immediately  in addition  to notifying General Motors of  Canada Limited  Call them at  1 800 333 0510 or write to     Transport Canada   Road Safety Branch  2780 Sheffield Road  Ottawa  Ontario K1B 3V9    12 16    Reporting Safety Defects  to General Motors    In addition to notifying NHTSA   or Transport Canada  in a  situation like this  please notify  General Motors     Call 1 800 762 2737  or write     Pontiac Customer Assistance Center  P O  Box 33172  Detroit  MI 48232 5172    In Canada  call 1 800 263 3777   English  or 1 800 263 7854   French   or write     General Motors of Canada Limited  Customer Communication Centre   CA1 163 005   1908 Colonel Sam Drive   Oshawa  Ontario L1H 8P7       Customer Information    Service Publications  Ordering Information    Service Manuals    Service Manuals have the diagnosis  and repair information on engines   transmission  axle suspension   brakes  electrical  steering  body  etc     Service Bulletins    Service Bulletins give additional  technical service information   needed to knowledgeably service  General Motors cars and trucks   Each bulletin contains instructions  to assist in the diagnosis and service  of your vehicle     Owner 
211. instruments often     Hill and Mountain Roads    Driving on steep hills or through  mountains is different than driving  on flat or rolling terrain  Tips for  driving in these conditions include       Keep the vehicle serviced  and in good shape       Check all fluid levels and brakes   tires  cooling system  and  transmission       Going down steep or long hills   shift to a lower gear        Z  CAUTION       If you do not shift down  the  brakes could get so hot that they  would not work well  You would  then have poor braking or even  none going down a hill  You could  crash  Shift down to let the engine  assist the brakes on a steep       downhill slope                 Z  CAUTION          Coasting downhill in N  Neutral  or  with the ignition off is dangerous   The brakes will have to do all the  work of slowing down and they  could get so hot that they would  not work well  You would then  have poor braking or even none  going down a hill  You could crash   Always have the engine running  and the vehicle in gear when going  downhill             Stay in your own lane  Do not  swing wide or cut across the  center of the road  Drive at  speeds that let you stay in  your own lane      Top of hills  Be alert     something  could be in your lane  stalled car   accident       Pay attention to special road  signs  falling rocks area  winding  roads  long grades  passing or  no passing zones  and take  appropriate action        Driving and Operating    Winter Driving    Driving o
212. int a shoulder belt  can provide  The shoulder belt  should not cross the face or neck   The lap belt should fit snugly  below the hips  just touching the  top of the thighs  This applies belt  force to the child   s pelvic bones in  a crash  It should never be worn  over the abdomen  which could  cause severe or even fatal  internal injuries in a crash     According to accident statistics   children and infants are safer when  properly restrained in a child restraint  system or infant restraint system  secured in a rear seating position     In a crash  children who are not  buckled up can strike other people  who are buckled up  or can be  thrown out of the vehicle  Older  children need to use safety belts  properly        Z  CAUTION       Seats and Restraints    1 37       CAUTION  Continued                 Never do this     Never allow two children to wear  the same safety belt  The safety  belt can not properly spread the  impact forces  In a crash  the two  children can be crushed together  and seriously injured  A safety  belt must be used by only one       Z  CAUTION    The child could move too far  forward increasing the chance of  head and neck injury  The child  might also slide under the lap  belt  The belt force would then be  applied right on the abdomen   That could cause serious or fatal  injuries  The shoulder belt should  go over the shoulder and across  the chest                 person at a time           Never do this     Never allow a child to wear the  sa
213. involving the  rear side of your vehicle  that only the  roof mounted airbag will deploy     In any particular crash  no one can  say whether an airbag should have  inflated simply because of the  damage to a vehicle or because   of what the repair costs were    For frontal airbags  inflation is  determined by what the vehicle hits   the angle of the impact  and how  quickly the vehicle slows down    For seat mounted side impact and  roof rail airbags  deployment is  determined by the location and  severity of the side impact     1 26    What Makes an Airbag  Inflate     In a deployment event  the sensing  system sends an electrical signal  triggering a release of gas from the  inflator  Gas from the inflator fills  the airbag causing the bag to break  out of the cover and deploy  The  inflator  the airbag  and related  hardware are all part of the airbag  module     Frontal airbag modules are located  inside the steering wheel and  instrument panel  For vehicles with  seat mounted side impact airbags   there are airbag modules in the side  of the front seatbacks closest to   the door  For vehicles with roof rail  airbags  there are airbag modules   in the ceiling of the vehicle  near the  side windows that have occupant  seating positions     Seats and Restraints       How Does an Airbag  Restrain     In moderate to severe frontal or  near frontal collisions  even belted  occupants can contact the steering  wheel or the instrument panel    In moderate to severe side  collisi
214. ion has a message   The message displays the artist   song title  call in phone numbers   etc  If the entire message does not  display  parts of the message appear  every three seconds until the  message is completed  MSG  disappears from the display once the  completed message has displayed     Radio Messages for XM Only    See XM Radio Messages on  page 6 12 later in this section for  further detail     Playing a CD  The CD player can play the smaller    3 inch  8 cm  single CDs with an  adapter ring     1  Insert a CD label side up  partway into the slot     2  The CD player pulls the CD in  and begins playing    3  The CD symbol and track  number displays     4  The CD stays in the player if the  ignition or radio is turned off     5  If the CD was the last source  selected  it resumes playing  when the radio is turned on     L  EJECT   Press and release to  eject a CD  Once ejected it can be  removed  If the CD is not removed  after several seconds the CD player  automatically pulls the disc back into  the player and starts playing        TUNE ADJ  Turn the TUNE ADJ  knob to select tracks on the CD        SEEK TRACK V  Press    to  go to the start of the current   track  if more than ten seconds  have played  Press V to go to the  next track  Holding or pressing   A or V multiple times causes the  player to continue moving backward  or forward through the tracks on  the CD     A FWD REV X  Fast Forward   Fast Reverse   Press and hold A  to advance playback quickly within
215. ion puts you in danger or   you are instructed to move it by a  police officer       Give only the necessary and  requested information to police  and other parties involved in the  crash  Do not discuss your  personal condition  mental frame  of mind  or anything unrelated to  the crash  This will help guard  against post crash legal action        Customer Information 12 13    If you need roadside assistance   call GM Roadside Assistance   See Roadside Assistance  Program on page 12 5 for more  information     If your vehicle cannot be driven   know where the towing service  will be taking it  Get a card from  the tow truck operator or write  down the driver s name    the service   s name  and the  phone number     Remove any valuables from your  vehicle before it is towed away   Make sure this includes your  insurance information and  registration if you keep these  items in your vehicle     Gather the important information  you will need from the other  driver  Things like name  address   phone number  driver s license  number  vehicle license       plate  vehicle make  model and  model year  Vehicle Identification  Number  VIN   insurance  company and policy number  and  a general description of the  damage to the other vehicle     If possible  call your insurance  company from the scene of the  crash  They will walk you through  the information they will need    If they ask for a police report   phone or go to the police  department headquarters the next  day and you can
216. ir        Z  CAUTION       In freezing weather  do not use  your washer until the windshield  is warmed  Otherwise the   washer fluid can form ice on the          windshield  blocking your vision              Rear Window  Wiper Washer  Rear Wiper  Turn the end of    the lever to low or high  to turn  on the rear window wiper                 Gi         Low   For steady rear wiping at  low speed          High   For steady rear wiping  at high speed     Ku  Rear Washer   Turn the end  of the lever up or down as far   as it will go  to squirt washer fluid  on the rear window  The knob  automatically returns from these  positions after it is released     The windshield washer reservoir is  used for the windshield and the  rear window  Check the fluid level  in the reservoir if either washer   is not working  See Windshield  Washer Fluid on page 9 24        Z  CAUTION       In freezing weather  do not use  your washer until the windshield  is warmed  Otherwise the  washer fluid can form ice on the  windshield  blocking your vision              Accessory Power  Outlet s     Accessory power outlets can be  used to plug in auxiliary electrical  equipment     The vehicle has an accessory  power outlet on the center floor  console below the shift lever     To use the outlet  the ignition  must be in ON RUN or  ACC ACCESSORY  Pull down the  small cover to access the outlet        Instruments and Controls 4 9    Notice  Leaving electrical  equipment on for extended  periods will drain the
217. irbag system  If this ever  happens  have the vehicle  serviced promptly  because an  adult size person sitting in the  right front passenger s seat may  not have the protection of the  airbag s   See Airbag Readiness  Light on page 4 14 for more on  this  including important safety  information                 Instruments and Controls    Service Airbag  Notification System  Message    If the Service Airbag Notification  System message appears on the  radio display  the vehicle may not  be able to provide the Automatic  Notification of Airbag Deployment  feature  See OnStar   System on  page 4 25 for information on this  feature  See your dealer retailer for  service        Charging System Light    The charging system light comes on  briefly when the ignition is turned  on  but the engine is not running   as a check to show the light is  working  It should go out when the  engine is started     If the light stays on  or comes on  while driving  there could be a  problem with the electrical charging  system  Have it checked by your  dealer retailer  Driving while this light  is on could drain the battery     If a short distance must be driven  with the light on  be sure to turn off  all accessories  such as the   radio and air conditioner     Brake System Warning  Light    The vehicle s hydraulic brake  system is divided into two parts    If one part is not working  the other  part can still work and stop the  vehicle  For good braking both parts  need to be working well     I
218. is going to skid during  driving  the traction control system  warning light flashes and an alarm  sounds intermittently  Adjust your  driving accordingly     en  ee    OFF    To turn off both the traction control  system and StabiliTrak  press   and hold the  amp  switch while the  vehicle is stopped     VSC  OFF    The traction control system warning  light and the VSC OFF light will come  on  To turn the systems back on   press the  amp  switch again  If both  systems are turned off  they will not  turn back on automatically when  vehicle speed increases     If the VSC OFF light flashes   there is a problem in the traction  control system or StabiliTrak        Driving and Operating    Steering    If the engine stalls while you are  driving  the power steering assist  system will continue to operate until  you are able to stop your vehicle    If you lose power steering assist  because the electric power steering  system is not functioning  you can  steer  but it will take more effort     If you turn the steering wheel in  either direction several times until it  stops  or hold the steering wheel in  the stopped position for an extended  amount of time  you may notice a  reduced amount of power steering  assist  The normal amount of power  steering assist should return shortly  after a few normal steering  movements     The electric power steering   system does not require regular  maintenance  If you suspect steering  system problems  contact your  dealer retailer for servi
219. is used  the  vehicle also sends OnStar the  vehicles GPS location so they can  provide services where it is located     OnStar service cannot work unless  the vehicle is in a place where  OnStar has an agreement with a  wireless service provider for service  in that area  OnStar service also  cannot work unless the vehicle is in  a place where the wireless service  provider OnStar has hired for that  area has coverage  network capacity  and reception when the service is  needed  and technology that is  compatible with the OnStar service   Not all services are available  everywhere  particularly in remote  or enclosed areas  or at all times        4 27    Location information about the  vehicle is only available if the GPS  satellite signals are unobstructed  and available     The vehicle must have a working  electrical system  including adequate  battery power  for the OnStar  equipment to operate  There are  other problems OnStar cannot  control that may prevent OnStar from  providing OnStar service at any  particular time or place  Some  examples are damage to important  parts of the vehicle in a crash  hills   tall buildings  tunnels  weather or  wireless phone network congestion     Your Responsibility    Increase the volume of the radio if  the OnStar advisor cannot be heard   If the light next to the OnStar buttons  is red  the system may not be  functioning properly  If the light  appears clear  no light is appearing    your OnStar subscription has  expired and all se
220. ish on aluminum wheels        Notice  Using chrome polish on  aluminum wheels could damage  the wheels  The repairs would  not be covered by your warranty   Use chrome polish on chrome  wheels only     Use chrome polish only on  chrome plated wheels  but avoid  any painted surface of the wheel   and buff off immediately after  application     Notice  If you drive your  vehicle through an automatic  car wash that has silicone  carbide tire cleaning brushes   you could damage the aluminum  or chrome plated wheels  The  repairs would not be covered by  your warranty  Never drive a  vehicle equipped with aluminum  or chrome plated wheels through  an automatic car wash that uses  silicone carbide tire cleaning  brushes     Windshield and Wiper Blades    Clean the outside of the windshield  with glass cleaner     Clean the rubber blades using a lint  free cloth or paper towel soaked with  windshield washer fluid or a mild  detergent  Wash the windshield    thoroughly when cleaning the blades     Bugs  road grime  sap  and a buildup  of vehicle wash wax treatments may  cause wiper streaking  Replace the  wiper blades if they are worn or  damaged     Wipers can be damaged by     Extreme dusty conditions    Sand and salt    Heat and sun      Snow and ice  without proper  removal       Vehicle Service and Care    Tires    To clean the tires  use a stiff brush  with tire cleaner     Notice  Using petroleum based  tire dressing products on your  vehicle may damage the paint  finish and o
221. ission  Control Service     Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See footnote        Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     Inspect passenger compartment  air filter     50 000 Miles  80 000 km     m     Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See footnote        Q Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     55 000 Miles  88 000 km     QO Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See footnote           Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary        Service and Maintenance 11 7    60 000 Miles  96 000 km   Q Change engine oil and filter     or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See footnote        Replace engine air cleaner filter   or every 24 months  whichever
222. ission does not require  changing     How to Check    This operation can be difficult  you  may choose to have this done   at your dealer retailer service  department     If you do it yourself  be sure to  follow all the instructions here   or you could get a false reading     Notice  Too much or too   little fluid can damage your  transmission  Too much can  mean that some of the fluid could       Vehicle Service and Care    come out and fall on hot engine  parts or exhaust system parts   starting a fire  Too little fluid  could cause the transmission  to overheat  Be sure to get   an accurate reading if you  check your transmission fluid     Check the fluid level only when your  engine is off  the vehicle is parked on  a level place and the transmission is  cool enough for you to rest your  fingers on the transmission case     Then  follow these steps   1  Remove the filler plug     2  Check that the lubricant level is  up to the bottom of the filler  plug hole     3  If the fluid level is good  install  the plug and be sure it is fully  seated  If the fluid level is low   add more fluid as described in  the next steps        How to Add Fluid    Here is how to add fluid  Refer   to the Maintenance Schedule   to determine what kind of fluid to   use  Part D  Recommended   Fluids and Lubricants on   page 11 18    1  Remove the filler plug    2  Add fluid at the filler plug hole   Add only enough fluid to bring    the fluid level up to the bottom  of the filler plug hole     3
223. istance Center  Paseo de la Reforma  2740   Col  Lomas de Bezares   C P  11910  Mexico  D F   01 800 508 0000   Long Distance  011 52 53 29 0 800    GM Mobility  Reimbursement Program    EXMOBILITY     This program  available to qualified  applicants  can reimburse you   up to  1 000 of the cost of   eligible aftermarket adaptive  equipment required for your  vehicle  such as hand controls   or a wheelchair scooter lift     Customer Information       12 5    The offer is available for a very  limited period of time from the  date of vehicle purchase lease   For more details  or to determine  your vehicle   s eligibility  visit  gmmobility com or call the   GM Mobility Assistance Center at  1 800 323 9935  Text telephone   TTY  users  call 1 800 833 9935     General Motors of Canada   also has a Mobility Program    Call 1 800 GM DRIVE  463 7483   for details  TTY users call  1 800 263 3830     Roadside Assistance  Program   For U S  purchased vehicles  call  1 800 ROADSIDE  762 3743     Text telephone  TTY    1 888 889 2438      For Canadian purchased vehicles   call 1 800 268 6800     Service is available 24 hours a day   365 days a year     12 6    Calling for Assistance    When calling Roadside Assistance   have the following information ready       Your name  home address  and  home telephone number      Telephone number of your  location      Location of the vehicle    e Model  year  color  and license  plate number of the vehicle    e Odometer reading  Vehicle  Identific
224. isted                 2  Push and pull the top of the  seatback to check that it is locked  into position        Z  CAUTION       If the seatback is not locked  it  could move forward in a sudden  stop or crash  That could cause  injury to the person sitting there   Always push and pull on the          seatback to be sure it is locked           Safety Belts    This section of the manual describes  how to use safety belts properly    It also describes some things not to  do with safety belts        Z  CAUTION       Do not let anyone ride where   a safety belt cannot be worn  properly  In a crash  if you or your  passenger s  are not wearing  safety belts  the injuries can be  much worse  You can hit things  inside the vehicle harder or be  ejected from the vehicle  You   and your passenger s  can be  seriously injured or killed  In the  same crash  you might not be  if  you are buckled up  Always fasten  your safety belt  and check that  your passenger s  are restrained  properly too              Seats and Restraints 1 9       Z  CAUTION       It is extremely dangerous to ride  in a cargo area  inside or outside  of a vehicle  In a collision  people  riding in these areas are more  likely to be seriously injured or  killed  Do not allow people to ride  in any area of your vehicle that   is not equipped with seats and  safety belts  Be sure everyone in  your vehicle is in a seat and using  a safety belt properly              This vehicle has indicators as a  reminder to buckle 
225. iven with no  coolant  your vehicle can be badly  damaged  The costly repairs  would not be covered by the  vehicle warranty     If No Steam Is Coming From  Your Engine    If an engine overheat warning is  displayed but steam is not heard or  seen escaping  the problem may  not be too serious  Sometimes   the engine can get a little too   hot when the vehicle       Climbs a long hill on a hot day     Stops after high speed driving     Idles for long periods in traffic      Tows a trailer        9 23    If the overheat warning is displayed  with no sign of steam  try this for  a minute or so     1  In heavy traffic  let the engine  idle in N  Neutral  while stopped   If it is safe to do so  pull off  the road  shift to P  Park   or N  Neutral  and let the  engine idle     2  Turn on the heater to full hot at  the highest fan speed and open  the windows as necessary     If the overheat warning is no longer  displayed  the vehicle can be driven   Just to be safe  drive slower for about  10 minutes  If the warning does not  come back on  continue to drive     If the warning continues  pull over   stop  and park the vehicle right away     If there is still no sign of steam  idle  the engine for three minutes while  the vehicle is parked  If the warning  is still displayed  turn off the engine  and get everyone out of the vehicle  until it cools down     9 24    You may decide not to lift the  hood but to get service help  right away     Power Steering Fluid    The vehicle has elec
226. ixture of clean  drinkable  water and DEX COOL   coolant              Notice  If an improper coolant  mixture is used  the engine could  overheat and be badly damaged   The repair cost would not be  covered by the vehicle warranty   Too much water in the mixture  can freeze and crack the engine   radiator  heater core  and other  parts        Vehicle Service and Care    Notice  If you use extra  inhibitors and or additives in  your vehicle   s cooling system   you could damage your vehicle   Use only the proper mixture of  the engine coolant listed in this  manual for the cooling system   See Part D  Recommended Fluids  and Lubricants on page 11 18 for  more information       Gives freezing protection down to   34 F      38  C       Gives boiling protection up to  265  F  129  C       Protects against rust and  corrosion      Helps keep the proper engine  temperature      Lets the warning lights and gages  work as they should     Notice  Using coolant other than  DEX COOL can cause premature  engine  heater core or radiator  corrosion  In addition  the engine       9 19    coolant may require changing  sooner  at 30 000 miles    50 000 km  or 24 months   whichever occurs first  Any  repairs would not be covered by  the vehicle warranty  Always  use DEX COOL  silicate free   coolant in your vehicle     Checking Coolant    The vehicle must be on a level  surface  When the engine is cold   the coolant level should be at LOW   or alittle higher  When the engine  is warm  the leve
227. king brake  firmly set  The vehicle can roll     Do not leave the vehicle when the  engine is running unless you have  to  If you have left the engine  running  the vehicle can move  suddenly  You or others could be  injured  To be sure the vehicle will  not move  even when you are on  fairly level ground  always set the  parking brake and move the shift  lever to P  Park   See Shifting Into  Park on page 8 13  If you are  pulling a trailer  see Towing a  Trailer on page 9 77              Make sure the shift lever is  fully in P  Park  before starting  the engine  The vehicle has  an automatic transmission  shift lock control system     You must fully apply the regular  brake first and move the shift lever to  the right before shifting from P  Park   while the ignition key is in ON RUN   If you cannot shift out of P  Park    ease pressure on the shift lever and  push the shift lever all the way into   P  Park  as you maintain brake  application  Then move the shift  lever into another gear  See Shifting  Out of Park on page 8 14     R  Reverse   Use this gear to  back up     Notice  Shifting to R  Reverse   while the vehicle is moving  forward could damage the  transmission  The repairs would  not be covered by the vehicle  warranty  Shift to R  Reverse   only after the vehicle is stopped     To rock your vehicle back and   forth to get out of snow  ice  or sand  without damaging the transmission   see lf Your Vehicle is Stuck in  Sand  Mud  Ice  or Snow on   page 8 31       
228. l and Mountain Roads    8 28  Winter Driving                    8 29    If Your Vehicle is Stuck in  Sand  Mud  Ice  or Snow    8 31  Rocking Your Vehicle to    Get It Out 2    8 31  Loading the Vehicle            8 32  Fuel   FUGE aa aE seler Sanus         Gasoline Octane  Gasoline Specifications       8 36    California Fuel 0 0 0 2    8 36  Additie S eiei eni 8 37  Fuels in Foreign   Countries ceecee 8 37  Filling the Tank              8 38  Filling a Portable Fuel  Container 222022 meteren 8 40    8 2 Driving and Operating    Starting and  Operating Your  Vehicle    New Vehicle Break In    Notice  The vehicle does   not need an elaborate break in   But it will perform better in   the long run if you follow  these guidelines       Do not drive at any one  constant speed  fast or slow     for the first 500 miles  805 km      Do not make full throttle  starts  Avoid downshifting  to brake or slow the vehicle          Avoid making hard stops for  the first 200 miles  322 km  or  so  During this time the new  brake linings are not yet broken  in  Hard stops with new linings  can mean premature wear and  earlier replacement  Follow this  breaking in guideline every  time you get new brake linings       Do not tow a trailer during  break in  See Towing a Trailer  on page 9 77 for the trailer  towing capabilities of your  vehicle and more information    Following break in  engine speed   and load can be gradually   increased        Ignition Positions  The ignition switch has four
229. l should be up to  FULL  or a little higher  If it is not   there could be a leak at the pressure  cap or in the radiator hoses  heater  hoses  radiator  water pump  or  somewhere else in the cooling  system     See Engine Compartment Overview  on page 9 6 Engine Compartment  Overview for the location of the  coolant recovery tank     9 20    How to Add Coolant to the  Coolant Recovery Tank       If you need more coolant  add the  proper DEX COOL   coolant mixture  at the coolant recovery tank  but   be careful not to spill it     Occasionally check the coolant level  in the radiator  For information on  how to add coolant to the radiator   see Cooling System on page 9 18  Cooling System     Vehicle Service and Care       Z  CAUTION    CAUTION  Continued        You can be burned if you spill  coolant on hot engine parts   Coolant contains ethylene glycol   and it will burn if the engine parts  are hot enough  Do not spill  coolant on a hot engine           Z  CAUTION          Adding only plain water to your  cooling system can be dangerous   Plain water  or some other liquid  such as alcohol  can boil before  the proper coolant mixture will   Your vehicle   s coolant warning  system is set for the proper  coolant mixture  With plain water  or the wrong mixture  your engine  could get too hot but you would  not get the overheat warning   Your engine could catch fire and     Continued                 you or others could be burned   Use a 50 50 mixture of clean   drinkable water
230. l unlock when the driver   s door  is opened     Lock out Timer  This feature allows  for changing how long of a delay  there is before all of the doors lock  when pressing the lock button on the  RKE transmitter  When the vehicle  left the factory the delay was set for   1 minute  This can be changed to   30 seconds or 2 minutes     12 10    Courtesy Transportation    To enhance your ownership  experience  we and our participating  dealers are proud to offer Courtesy  Transportation  a customer support  program for vehicles with the Bumper  to Bumper  Base Warranty Coverage  period in Canada  and extended  powertrain warranty in both the   U S  and Canada     Several courtesy transportation  options are available to assist   in reducing your inconvenience  when warranty repairs are required     Courtesy Transportation is not a part  of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty   A separate booklet entitled    Warranty  and Owner Assistance Information     furnished with each new vehicle  provides detailed warranty coverage  information        Customer Information    Transportation Options    Warranty service can generally be  completed while you wait  However   if you are unable to wait  GM helps to  minimize your inconvenience by  providing several transportation  options  Depending on the  circumstances  your dealer can   offer you one of the following     Shuttle Service    Shuttle service is the preferred  means of offering Courtesy  Transportation  Dealers may provide  you with 
231. lable for use only on FM stations  that broadcast RDS information     With RDS      Stations can be selected based  on programming      Stations with traffic  announcements can be selected     e Announcements concerning local  and national emergencies can be  received     e Messages display from radio  stations     RDS relies on receiving specific  information from radio stations and  only works when the information   is available  In rare cases  a   radio station could broadcast  incorrect information that causes the  radio features to work improperly   Contact the radio station if this  happens        When the radio is tuned to an RDS  station  the station name or call  letters display instead of the  frequency  RDS stations can also  provide the time of day  a program  type  PTY  for current programming   and the name of the program being  broadcast     RDS Messages    ALERT  Displays when local or  national emergency announcements  are received  If the radio tunes to   a related network station for the  announcement  it returns to the  original station when the  announcement ends  The  announcement should be heard  even if the volume is low or a CD is  playing  If a CD is playing  it will stop  playing during the announcement      The RDS alert feature is not    supported by all RDS radio  stations        e The RDS alert feature cannot be  turned off       Alertis not affected by tests of the  emergency broadcast system     MSG  Message   Displays if the  current RDS stat
232. le  modified  How can   find out  whether this will affect my  airbag system    A  If you have questions  call  Customer Assistance  The phone  numbers and addresses for  Customer Assistance are in  Step Two of the Customer  Satisfaction Procedure in this  manual  See Customer  Satisfaction Procedure on  page 12 1    In addition  your dealer retailer and   the service manual have information   about the location of the airbag  sensors  sensing and diagnostic  module and airbag wiring     Airbag System Check    The airbag system does not need  regularly scheduled maintenance  or replacement  Make sure the  airbag readiness light is working   See Airbag Readiness Light   on page 4 14 for more information     Notice  If an airbag covering   is damaged  opened  or broken   the airbag may not work properly   Do not open or break the airbag  coverings  If there are any opened  or broken airbag covers  have  the airbag covering and or airbag  module replaced  For the   location of the airbag modules   see What Makes an Airbag  Inflate  on page 1 26  See your  dealer retailer for service     Replacing Airbag System  Parts After a Crash    Seats and Restraints       Z  CAUTION          A crash can damage the   airbag systems in your vehicle    A damaged airbag system may  not work properly and may not  protect you and your passenger s   in a crash  resulting in serious  injury or even death  To help  make sure your airbag systems  are working properly after a crash   have them inspect
233. lexing   e Too much heat   e Tire overloading      Premature or irregular wear     Poor handling      Reduced fuel economy    If your tires have too much air   over inflation   you can get  the following        Unusual wear     Poor handling     Rough ride      Needless damage from road  hazards       9 47    A vehicle specific Tire and  Loading Information label is  attached to your vehicle  This  label shows your vehicle   s  original equipment tires and the  correct inflation pressures for  your tires when they are cold   The recommended cold tire  inflation pressure  shown on the  label  is the minimum amount of  air pressure needed to support  your vehicle   s maximum load  carrying capacity     For additional information  regarding how much weight  your vehicle can carry  and an  example of the Tire and Loading  Information label  see Loading  the Vehicle on page 8 32   How you load your vehicle  affects vehicle handling and  ride comfort  Never load your  vehicle with more weight than  it was designed to carry     9 48    When to Check    Check your tires once a month  or more  Do not forget to   check the compact spare tire    it should be at 60 psi  420 kPa    For additional information  regarding the compact spare  tire  see Compact Spare Tire  on page 9 70     How to Check    Use a good quality pocket type  gage to check tire pressure    You cannot tell if your tires are  properly inflated simply by  looking at them  Radial tires may  look properly inflated even wh
234. load  capacity                         O     i          If using a weight carrying hitch or a  weight distributing hitch  the trailer  tongue  A  should weigh 10 to   15 percent of the total loaded trailer  weight  B         9 79    After the trailer is loaded  weigh  the trailer and then the tongue   separately  to see if the weights  are proper  If they are not  you may  be able to get them right simply   by moving some items around in  the trailer     Total Weight on Your Vehicle   s  Tires    Be sure your vehicle   s tires are  inflated to the upper limit for cold  tires  These numbers are located on  the Tire and Loading Information  label located on the vehicle   s center  pillar  B pillar   See Loading the  Vehicle on page 8 32  Then be sure  you do not go over the GVW limit  for your vehicle  including the weight  of the trailer tongue     9 80    Hitches    It is important to have the correct  hitch equipment  Crosswinds   large trucks going by and rough  roads are a few reasons why  you will need the right hitch   Here are some rules to follow       Do not let the steel in a hitch  contact the aluminum on your  bumper because it can corrode   Use something like paint or plastic  tape to separate the steel and  aluminum  The same steel to  aluminum problem can happen  with fasteners too       Will you have to make any holes  in the body of your vehicle when  you install a trailer hitch  If you  do  then be sure to seal the holes  later when you remove the hitch   If 
235. lter is   in the engine compartment on   the driver side of the vehicle    See Engine Compartment Overview  on page 9 6 for more information   on location     When to Inspect the Engine  Air Cleaner Filter    If you are driving in dusty dirty  conditions  inspect the air  cleaner filter at each engine oil  change  Replace the filter every  30 000 miles  48 000 km  or   24 months  whichever occurs first   See Part A  Scheduled Maintenance  Services on page 11 3 for more  information        Vehicle Service and Care    How to Inspect the Engine Air  Cleaner Filter    To inspect the air cleaner filter  remove the filter from the vehicle  and lightly shake the filter to release  loose dust and dirt  If the filter  remains caked with dirt  a new   filter is required     To inspect or replace the engine air  cleaner filter        1 8L Engine    1  Release the two clips that hold  the cover             Lift the cover     Inspect or replace the engine air    cleaner filter       Reinstall the cover     1     2 4L Engine    Release the three clips that hold  the cover        Vehicle Service and Care 9 13         Lift the cover     Inspect or replace the engine air    cleaner filter       Reinstall the cover           Z  CAUTION       Operating the engine with the air  cleaner filter off can cause you   or others to be burned  The air  cleaner not only cleans the air    it helps to stop flames if the engine  backfires  If it is not there and the  engine backfires  you could be  burned  
236. luding airbag  notification and emergency services   may be deactivated and no longer  available  For more information   visit www onstar com  U S   or  www onstar ca  Canada   or press  the OnStar button to speak with an  advisor     Not all OnStar services are available  on all vehicles  To check if this  vehicle is able to provide the  services described below  or for a  full description of OnStar services       Instruments and Controls    and system limitations  see the  OnStar Owner   s Guide in the   glove box or visit www onstar com   U S   or www onstar ca  Canada    contact OnStar at 1 888 4 ONSTAR   1 888 466 7827  or TTY  1 877 248 2080  or press the  OnStar button to speak with an  OnStar advisor 24 hours a day    7 days a week     OnStar Services Available  with the Safe  amp  Sound Plan      Automatic Notification of  Airbag Deployment      Link to Emergency Services    Roadside Assistance      Stolen Vehicle Location  Assistance      Remote Door Unlock Vehicle  Alert      OnStar Hands Free Calling with  30 trial minutes      OnStar Virtual Advisor  U S  Only        OnStar Services Included with  Directions  amp  Connections Plan      All Safe and Sound Plan Services      Driving Directions   Advisor  Delivered    e RideAssist    e Information and Convenience  Services    OnStar Hands Free Calling    OnStar Hands Free Calling allows  eligible OnStar subscribers to make  and receive calls using voice  commands  Hands Free Calling is  fully integrated into the veh
237. ly     Safety Belt Extender    If the vehicle   s safety belt will fasten  around you  you should use it     But if a safety belt is not long  enough  your dealer retailer will order  you an extender  When you go in to  order it  take the heaviest coat you  will wear  so the extender will be   long enough for you  To help avoid  personal injury  do not let someone  else use it  and use it only for the  seat it is made to fit  The extender  has been designed for adults  Never  use it for securing child seats    To wear it  just attach it to the regular  safety belt  For more information  see  the instruction sheet that comes with  the extender     Seats and Restraints 1 19    When a safety belt extender is  installed in the right front passenger  safety belt  make sure the passenger  airbag status indicator displays ON   See Passenger Airbag Status  Indicator on page 4 15  lf the  indicator shows OFF  disconnect   the extender   s latch from the buckle  then reconnect the safety belt    The passenger airbag status  indicator light should be ON and  then the safety belt extender can   be reconnected  If the safety belt  extender is used while the passenger  airbag status indicator light is OFF   the right front passenger frontal and  seat mounted side impact airbags    if equipped  may not activate  correctly     Always disconnect the extender  from the safety belt after you use  it so that the airbag will work  properly the next time someone  uses that seat        1 20    Safe
238. m  Make  sure the safety belt reminder  light and safety belt assemblies  are working properly  Look for  any other loose or damaged  safety belt system parts  If you  see anything that might keep          a safety belt system from   doing its job  have it repaired   Have any torn or frayed   safety belts replaced  Also   see Airbag System Check on  page 1 35    Replace passenger compartment  air filter     Inspect engine accessory drive  belts  or 12 months since last  inspection   An Emission  Control Service     Inspect fuel tank  cap  cap  gasket  and lines for damage   or leaks  or every 24 months   whichever occurs first   Replace  parts as needed  An Emission  Control Service   See footnote t      Change manual transmission  fluid every 30 000 miles    48 000 km  only if your vehicle  is used to tow a trailer     11 10    95 000 Miles  152 000 km     Q Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53  for proper rotation pattern  and additional information    See footnote        Q  Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     100 000 Miles  160 000 km     Q Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53  for proper rotation pattern  and additional information    
239. m  leaving the vehicle        Z  CAUTION       When an airbag inflates  there  may be dust in the air  This dust  could cause breathing problems  for people with a history of  asthma or other breathing trouble   To avoid this  everyone in the  vehicle should get out as soon as  it is safe to do so  If you have     Continued                    CAUTION  Continued        breathing problems but cannot get  out of the vehicle after an airbag  inflates  then get fresh air by  opening a window or a door    If you experience breathing  problems following an airbag  deployment  you should seek  medical attention              The vehicle has a feature that may  automatically unlock the doors   turn the interior lamps on  and turn  the hazard warning flashers on  when the airbags inflate  You can  lock the doors  turn the interior  lamps off  and turn the hazard  warning flashers off by using the  controls for those features     In many crashes severe enough to  inflate the airbag  windshields  are broken by vehicle deformation     Seats and Restraints 1 27    Additional windshield breakage may  also occur from the right front  passenger airbag       Airbags are designed to inflate  only once  After an airbag inflates   you will need some new parts for  the airbag system  If you do not  get them  the airbag system will  not be there to help protect you in  another crash  A new system will  include airbag modules and  possibly other parts  The service  manual for your vehicle covers  the
240. m On Light                4 24  Highway Hypnosis                  8 28  Hill and Mountain Roads         8 28  Hood   Release i is 9 5  HOOKS nean ER aien asnata 3 3  POTM eaan aE 4 3  How to Wear Safety Belts   Properly sovsen ak 1 11  Hydraulic Clutch 2    9 17    l   Ignition Positions             8 2  Immobilizer   2 2    eee 2 9  Immobilizer Operation               2 9  Infants and Young Children    Restraints           ceeeeeeeeees 1 38  Inflation   Tire Pressure           9 47  Inspection   Brake System             0 11 17    Engine Cooling System      11 17    Exhaust System              5 11 16  Fuel System               0 0 11 16  Part C   Periodic  Maintenance                 11 16  Steering  Suspension and  Front Drive Axle Boot  and Seal                00005 11 16  Throttle System               11 17  Instrument Panel  Brightness 22233 skrantede 5 3  GIUSION aechis dee AE 4 12  Overview 0 0    ccc eeeeeee cece ee ees 4 2  J  Jump Starting 1    9 71       K  Keyless Entry System              KEYS oicipcisdethicctersdoancornnas cate  L  Labeling  Tire Sidewall             Lamp  Malfunction Indicator            Lamps  DOME       ccc cece eee ee cece neta eee  Readingin ieiti ane    Lap Shoulder Belt  LATCH System  Replacing Parts After a  Crash  LATCH System for Child  Restraints  License Plate Lamps  Liftgate  Carbon Monoxide  Light  Airbag Readiness  Antilock Brake System   ABS  Warning  Brake System Warning  Charging System       INDEX i 5  Light  cont     Cruise 
241. mation can be  found in one place     The Online Owner Center  allows you to     e Get e mail service reminders       Access information about your  specific vehicle  including tips  and videos and an electronic  version of this owner manual     e Keep track of your vehicle   s  service history and maintenance  schedule     e Find GM dealers retailers for  service nationwide       Receive special promotions and  privileges only available to  members     Refer to MyGMLink com on the web  for updated information and to  register your vehicle     12 4    My GM Canada  Canada only     My GM Canada is a  password protected section of  gmcanada com where you can  save information on GM vehicles   get personalized offers  and   use handy tools and forms with  greater ease     Here are a few of the valuable  tools and services you will have  access to       My Showroom  Find and save  information on vehicles and  current offers in your area       My Dealers Retailers  Save  details such as address and  phone number for each of your  preferred GM Dealers or  Retailers       My Driveway  Receive service  reminders and helpful advice  on owning and maintaining  your vehicle        Customer Information      My Preferences  Manage your  profile  subscribe to E News  and use tools and forms  with greater ease     To sign up to My GM Canada   visit the My GM Canada section  within gmcanada com     Customer Assistance for  Text Telephone  TTY   Users    To assist customers who are deaf   har
242. mission  performance  to monitor the  conditions for airbag deployment  and deploy airbags in a crash and  if  so equipped  to provide antilock  braking to help the driver control   the vehicle  These modules may  store data to help your dealer retailer  technician service your vehicle   Some modules may also store data  about how you operate the vehicle   such as rate of fuel consumption or  average speed  These modules  may also retain the owner   s personal  preferences  such as radio pre sets   seat positions  and temperature  settings        12 17    Event Data Recorders    This vehicle has an Event Data  Recorder  EDR   The main purpose  of an EDR is to record  in certain  crash or near crash like situations   such as an airbag deployment   or hitting a road obstacle  data that  will assist in understanding how   a vehicle   s systems performed    The EDR is designed to record data  related to vehicle dynamics and  safety systems for a short period   of time  typically 30 seconds or less   The EDR in this vehicle is designed  to record such data as     e How various systems in your  vehicle were operating      Whether or not the driver and  passenger safety belts were  buckled fastened     How far  if at all  the driver was  pressing the accelerator and or  brake pedal      How fast the vehicle was  traveling    12 18    This data can help provide a better  understanding of the circumstances  in which crashes and injuries occur     Important  EDR data is recorded  by yo
243. n   If you are holding the steering wheel  at the recommended 9 and 3 o   clock  positions  you can turn it a full   180 degrees very quickly without  removing either hand  But you have  to act fast  steer quickly  and just as  quickly straighten the wheel once  you have avoided the object     The fact that such emergency  situations are always possible is a  good reason to practice defensive  driving at all times and wear  safety belts properly        Off Road Recovery    Your vehicle   s right wheels can drop  off the edge of a road onto the  shoulder while driving        If the level of the shoulder is   only slightly below the pavement   recovery should be fairly easy   Ease off the accelerator and then  if  there is nothing in the way  steer so  that your vehicle straddles the edge  of the pavement  Turn the steering  wheel 3 to 5 inches  76 to 127 mm    about one eighth turn  until the right  front tire contacts the pavement  edge  Then turn the steering wheel  to go straight down the roadway     Passing    Passing another vehicle on a   two lane road can be dangerous    To reduce the risk of danger   while passing      Look down the road  to the sides   and to crossroads for situations  that might affect a successful  pass  If in doubt  wait       Watch for traffic signs  pavement  markings  and lines that could  indicate a turn or an intersection   Never cross a solid or  double solid line on your side  of the lane     e Do not get too close to the vehicle  you want t
244. n Snow or Ice    Drive carefully when there is snow  or ice between the tires and the road   creating less traction or grip  Wet ice  can occur at about 32  F  0  C  when  freezing rain begins to fall  resulting  in even less traction  Avoid driving on  wet ice or in freezing rain until roads  can be treated with salt or sand     Drive with caution  whatever the  condition  Accelerate gently so  traction is not lost  Accelerating too  quickly causes the wheels to spin  and makes the surface under the  tires slick  so there is even less  traction     Try not to break the fragile traction   If you accelerate too fast  the drive  wheels will spin and polish the  surface under the tires even more        8 29    The Antilock Brake System  ABS   on page 8 20 improves vehicle  stability during hard stops on   a slippery roads  but apply the  brakes sooner than when on   dry pavement     Allow greater following distance   on any slippery road and watch for  slippery spots  Icy patches can occur  on otherwise clear roads in shaded  areas  The surface of a curve or an  overpass can remain icy when the  surrounding roads are clear  Avoid  sudden steering maneuvers and  braking while on ice     Turn off cruise control  if equipped   on slippery surfaces     8 30    Blizzard Conditions    Being stuck in snow can be in   a serious situation  Stay with the  vehicle unless there is help nearby   If possible  use the Roadside  Assistance Program on page 12 5   To get help and keep everyone in
245. n how to keep  the vehicle in good condition  see  your dealer retailer     This part tells you the maintenance  services that should be done  and when to schedule them     When you go to your dealer retailer  for service  trained and supported  service people will perform the work  using genuine parts     11 4    The proper fluids and lubricants to  use are listed in Part D  Make  sure whoever services the vehicle  uses these  All parts should be  replaced and all necessary repairs  done before you or anyone else  drives the vehicle     These schedules are for  vehicles that       carry passengers and cargo  within recommended limits on  the Tire and Loading Information  label  See Loading the Vehicle  on page 8 32     e are driven on reasonable road    surfaces within legal driving limits     e use the recommended fuel   See Gasoline Octane on  page 8 36        Service and Maintenance    Scheduled Maintenance    The services shown in this schedule  up to 120 000 miles  192 000 km   should be repeated after   120 000 miles  192 000 km  at the  same intervals for the life of this  vehicle     See Part B  Owner Checks and  Services on page 11 12  Part C   Periodic Maintenance Inspections  on page 11 16  and Part D   Recommended Fluids and  Lubricants on page 11 18     Footnotes    t The U S  Environmental Protection  Agency or the California Air  Resources Board has determined  that the failure to perform this  maintenance item will not nullify the  emissions warranty or limit
246. n is finished   the disc starts playing   Playing an MP3    The MP3 player can play the  smaller 3 inch  8 cm  single CDs  with an adapter ring     1  Insert a CD label side up  partway into the slot    2  The CD player pulls the CD in  and begins playing        3  The CD stays in the player if the  ignition or radio is turned off     4  If the CD was the last source  selected  it resumes playing  when the radio is turned on     A  EJECT   Press and release  to eject a CD  Once the disc is  ejected it can be removed    If the CD is not removed after  several seconds the CD player  automatically pulls the disc back  into the player and starts playing        SEEK TRACK V  Press to go to  the start of the current track  if   more than ten seconds have played   Press V to go to the next track     Holding or pressing A or V multiple  times will cause the player to  continue moving backward or  forward through the tracks on   the CD        Infotainment 6 11    ZX FWD REV     Fast Forward   Fast Reverse   Press and hold SY  to advance playback quickly within  atrack  Release AA to resume  playing the track  Press and hold S   to reverse playback quickly within a  track  Release AA to resume  playing the track     BAND  Press to listen to the radio  when a CD is playing     INFO  Information   Press when  an MP3 CD is loaded  then press  the button below the Song  Artist   Album  or Folder label to view  the information     CD AUX  CD Auxiliary   Press to  play a CD when listening to
247. n page 10 2     Notice  Do not add too much oil   If the engine has so much oil  that the oil level gets above the  upper hole  the engine could   be damaged        Fo    AKAN    See Engine Compartment Overview  on page 9 6 for the location of  the engine oil fill cap     Add enough oil to put the level  somewhere in the proper operating  range  Push the dipstick all the  way back in when you are through     What Kind of Engine Oil  to Use   Look for three things    e GM6094M    Use only an oil that meets  GM Standard GM6094M     e SAE 5W 20    SAE 5W 20 is best for the  vehicle        RECOMMENDED SAE VISCOSITY GRADE  HOT WEATHER    SAE SW 20  SAE OW 20       COLD WEATHER    DO NOT USE SAE 10W 40  SAE 20W 50  OR ANY OTHER VISCOSITY GRADE  OIL NOT RECOMMENDED    These numbers on an oil  container show its viscosity   or thickness  Do not use  other viscosity oils such as  SAE 20W 50     e Oils meeting these requirements  should have the starburst symbol  on the container  This symbol  indicates that the oil has been  certified by the American  Petroleum Institute  API         Notice  Use only engine oil  identified as meeting GM Standard  GM6094M and showing the  American Petroleum Institute  Certified For Gasoline Engines  starburst symbol  Failure to use  the recommended oil can result in  engine damage not covered by the  vehicle warranty        Vehicle Service and Care    If you are in an area of extreme  cold  where the temperature  falls below    20  F     29  C   it is 
248. nance    Weatherstrip Lubrication    Silicone grease on weatherstrips  will make them last longer  seal  better  and not stick or squeak   Apply silicone grease with a clean  cloth  During very cold  damp  weather more frequent application  may be required  See Part D   Recommended Fluids and  Lubricants on page 11 18     Fluid Level Check    Check the power steering pump   rear axle  transfer case  and  automatic or manual transmission  fluid levels and add as needed   See Automatic Transmission  Fluid on page 9 14 or Manual  Transmission Fluid on page 9 16   Check for leaks  A fluid loss in these  systems could indicate a problem   Have the system inspected and  repaired at once        11 13    At Least Once a Year    Key Lock Cylinders Service    Lubricate the key lock cylinders with  the lubricant specified in Part D     Seat Operation Check    Make sure the head restraints stay  in position and all seat latches   lock  Check that the recliner holds  by pushing and pulling the seatback  while it is reclined     Body Lubrication Service    Lubricate all hood latch assembly   secondary latch  pivots  spring  anchor  release pawl  hood and body  door hinges  rear compartment  and  any folding seat hardware  Part D  tells you what to use  More frequent  lubrication might be required when  exposed to a corrosive environment     11 14    Starter Switch Check       Z  CAUTION       When you are doing this  inspection  the vehicle could move  suddenly  If the vehicle moves   you 
249. nance  Schedule cscidesccciatsiinccces 11 3  Scheduled Maintenance       Part B  Owner Checks   and Services               06 11 12  At Each Fuel Fill               11 12       Service and Maintenance    At Least Once a Month    11 13  At Least Twice a Year     11 13  At Least Once a Year       11 13  Part C  Periodic   Maintenance   INSPECtiONS siirsin 11 16  Steering  Suspension and   Front Drive Axle Boot    and Seal Inspection         11 16  Exhaust System  Inspection            0  11 16    Fuel System Inspection      Engine Cooling System    Inspection                11 17  Throttle System   INSPECTION 2    11 17  Brake System   Inspection               11 17    Part D  Recommended  Fluids and Lubricants       Part E  Maintenance  Record seerias ass 11 20          11 1    Service and  Maintenance    Introduction    Important  Keep engine oil at  the proper level and change as  recommended     Protection    Plan    Have you purchased the GM  Protection Plan  The Plan  supplements the vehicle warranties   See the Warranty and Owner  Assistance booklet or your  dealer retailer for details     11 2    Maintenance  Requirements    Maintenance intervals  checks   inspections and recommended fluids  and lubricants as prescribed in this  manual are necessary to keep this  vehicle in good working condition   Any damage caused by failure to  follow scheduled maintenance   may not be covered by the vehicle  warranty     Your Vehicle and the  Environment    Proper vehicle maintenanc
250. nd  the VSC OFF light will come on     8 22    To turn the systems back on    press the  amp  switch again  If both  systems are turned off  they will not  turn back on automatically when  vehicle speed increases     lf the VSC OFF light flashes   there is a problem in the traction  control system or StabiliTrak     Adding non GM accessories can  affect your vehicle   s performance   See Accessories and Modifications  on page 9 3 Accessories and  Modifications for more information     All Wheel Drive  AWD   System    If your vehicle has this feature   engine power is sent to all four  wheels all the time  This is like  four wheel drive  but it is fully  automatic        Driving and Operating    StabiliTrak   System    Your vehicle has StabiliTrak  This  system helps provide integrated  control of systems such as the  Antilock Brake System  traction  control and engine control  This  system automatically controls the  brakes and engine to help prevent  the vehicle from skidding when  cornering on a slippery road surface  or turning the steering wheel  abruptly     This system activates when your  vehicle speed reaches or exceeds  9 mph  15 km h   and deactivates  when the vehicle speed reduces to  below 9 mph  15 km h      You may hear a sound in the engine  compartment for a few seconds  when the engine is started or just  after the vehicle begins to move   This means that the system is in   the self check mode  but does not  indicate a problem        f  ee    If the vehicle 
251. nd of wheel you need     Each new wheel should have  the same load carrying capacity   diameter  width  offset and be  mounted the same way as the  one it replaces        Vehicle Service and Care 9 59    If you need to replace any of the  wheels  wheel bolts or wheel  nuts  replace them only with new  GM original equipment parts    This way  you will be sure to have  the right wheel  wheel bolts and  wheel nuts for the vehicle        Z  CAUTION       Using the wrong replacement  wheels  wheel bolts  or wheel  nuts on your vehicle can be  dangerous  It could affect the  braking and handling of your  vehicle  make your tires lose  air and make you lose control   You could have a collision in  which you or others could be  injured  Always use the correct  wheel  wheel bolts  and wheel  nuts for replacement                 Notice  The wrong wheel can  also cause problems with bearing  life  brake cooling  speedometer  or odometer calibration  headlamp  aim  bumper height  vehicle  ground clearance  and tire or tire  chain clearance to the body and  chassis     See Changing a Flat Tire on  page 9 62 for more information     Used Replacement Wheels       Z  CAUTION       Putting a used wheel on the  vehicle is dangerous  You cannot  know how it has been used   or how far it has been driven    It could fail suddenly and cause  a crash  If you have to replace a  wheel  use a new GM original  equipment wheel              9 60    Tire Chains    Vehicle Service and Care          Z  CAUT
252. ndow outlets     NA  Defog   Air is directed between  the windshield  side windows   instrument panel outlets and the  floor outlets        Use the defog mode to clear the  inside of the windshield of fog   or moisture and to warm the  passengers  The air conditioning  compressor runs automatically   in this setting without pressing A C   unless the outside temperature   is at or below 32  F  0  C       P  Defrost   Air is directed to  the windshield  instrument panel  outlets and the side windows     Use the defrost mode to remove  fog or frost from the outside of the  windshield more quickly  The air  conditioning compressor runs  automatically in this setting without  pressing A C  unless the outside  temperature is at or below   32  F  0  C      Do not drive the vehicle until all the  windows are clear        Air Conditioning    For vehicles with this feature  there  will be the following controls     A C  Air Conditioning   Press to  turn the air conditioning system  on or off  An indicator light shows  that it is on     MAX A C  Maximum Air  Conditioning   Press the A C and  recirculation buttons at the same  time to select MAX A C     On hot days  open the windows to  let hot inside air escape  then close  them  The vehicle will cool quicker  and the A C system operates more  efficiently     Because the A C system removes  moisture from the air  it is normal  for a small amount of water to   drip under the vehicle while idling  or just after turning the engine off     
253. ng    If a Tire Goes Flat    It is unusual for a tire to blowout  while you are driving  especially if  you maintain your vehicle s tires  properly  If air goes out of a tire  it is  much more likely to leak out slowly   But if you should ever have a  blowout  here are a few tips about  what to expect and what to do     If a front tire fails  the flat tire  creates a drag that pulls the vehicle  toward that side  Take your foot off  the accelerator pedal and grip the       Vehicle Service and Care    steering wheel firmly  Steer to  maintain lane position  and then  gently brake to a stop well out of  the traffic lane     A rear blowout  particularly on a  curve  acts much like a skid and  may require the same correction  you would use in a skid  In any   rear blowout remove your foot   from the accelerator pedal  Get the  vehicle under control by steering the  way you want the vehicle to go  It  may be very bumpy and noisy  but  you can still steer  Gently brake to a  stop  well off the road if possible     9 61       Z  CAUTION       Lifting a vehicle and getting under  it to do maintenance or repairs is  dangerous without the appropriate  safety equipment and training  If a  jack is provided with the vehicle  it  is designed only for changing a  flat tire  If it is used for anything  else  you or others could be badly  injured or killed if the vehicle slips  off the jack  If a jack is provided  with the vehicle  only use it for  changing a flat tire                 If a ti
254. ng  System on page 1 28   Security Light  See Content  Theft Deterrent on page 2 10   G  Hazard Warning Flashers on  page 4 3   H  Audio System s  on page 6 1      Traction Control System  TCS   on page 8 21   J  Content Theft Deterrent on  page 2 10   K  Driver Storage Compartment  on page 3 3   L  Hood Release on page 9 5        yO voz    n    Instruments and Controls      Audio Steering Wheel Controls    on page 6 13       Tilt Wheel on page 4 4     Horn on page 4 3     Cruise Control on page 4 4     If Equipped        Ignition Positions on page 8 2     Tire Pressure Reset Button     Out of View   See Tire Pressure  Monitor Operation on page 9 50       Power Outlet 115 Volt Alternating    Current on page 4 10 On Off  Button     Cigarette Lighter  If Equipped   or Accessory Power Outlet   Ashtray s  on page 4 10   or Accessory Power Outlet s   on page 4 9       Shift Lever  Automatic    Transmission Operation   Four Speed  on page 8 6 or  Automatic Transmission  Operation  Five Speed    on page 8 8 or Manual  Transmission Operation   on page 8 11        4 3    V  Power Outlet 115 Volt Alternating  Current on page 4 10    W  Climate Control System on  page 7 1    X  Hooks on page 3 3    Y  Glove Box on page 3 1     Hazard Warning Flashers    A  Hazard Warning Flasher    Press this button located on   the instrument panel  to make the  front and rear turn signal lamps flash  on and off  This warns others that  you are having trouble     Press A again to turn the  flashers off
255. ng can  occur to the lighter or heating    element  or a fuse could be blown     Do not hold a cigarette lighter in  while it is heating     It is not recommended to use the  cigarette lighter to plug in auxiliary  electrical equipment  Use the  accessory power outlet for phones  and other electrical equipment   See Accessory Power Outlet s   on page 4 9 or Power Outlet   115 Volt Alternating Current   on page 4 10        Instruments and Controls    Warning Lights   Gages  and Indicators    Warning lights and gages can  signal that something is wrong  before it becomes serious enough  to cause an expensive repair or  replacement  Paying attention to the  warning lights and gages could  prevent injury     Warning lights come on when there  may be or is a problem with one   of the vehicle s functions  Some  warning lights come on briefly when  the engine is started to indicate  they are working        4 11    Gages can indicate when there may  be or is a problem with one of the  vehicle s functions  Often gages and  warning lights work together to  indicate a problem with the vehicle     When one of the warning lights  comes on and stays on while  driving  or when one of the gages  shows there may be a problem   check the section that explains what  to do  Follow this manual s advice   Waiting to do repairs can be   costly and even dangerous     4 12 Instruments and Controls    Instrument Panel Cluster    This feature is designed to show at a glance how the vehicle is running  
256. ng in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     QO Inspect passenger compartment  air filter     Q Inspect engine accessory drive  belts  or 12 months since last  inspection   An Emission  Control Service     80 000 Miles  128 000 km     Q Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53  for proper rotation pattern  and additional information    See footnote        Q Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     85 000 Miles  136 000 km     QO Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53  for proper rotation pattern  and additional information    See footnote        Q  Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary        Service and Maintenance 11 9    90 000 Miles  144 000 km   Q Change engine oil and filter     or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53 for  proper rotation pattern and  additional information     See footnote        Replace engine air cleaner filter   or every 24 months  whichever  occurs first   See Engine Air  Cleaner Filter on page 9 12   for more information     Check restraint syste
257. nition while  the lamps are on     5 2 Lighting    Daytime Running  Lamps  DRL     Daytime Running Lamps  DRL  can  make it easier for others to see   the front of your vehicle during the  day  Fully functional DRL are  required on all vehicles first sold   in Canada     The DRL system makes the  headlamps come on at a reduced  brightness when the following  conditions are met       The ignition is on with the  engine running       The exterior lamps switch is off     The parking brake is released     When the exterior lamp switch   is turned to the headlamp position   the DRL go off and the headlamps  come on  The other lamps that  come on with the headlamps also  come on        The headlamps automatically switch  from DRL to the regular headlamps  depending on the darkness of   the surroundings  See    Automatic  Headlamp System    following     DRL also comes on if only the  parking lamps are being used     Automatic Headlamp  System    When it is dark enough outside   the automatic headlamp system  turns on the low beam headlamps at  the normal brightness along with  other lamps such as the taillamps   sidemarker  parking lamps and  instrument panel lights  An indicator  light on the instrument panel comes  on when the headlamps are on   See  nstrument Panel Cluster on  page 4 12        If the vehicle is driven through a  parking garage  overcast weather  or  a tunnel  the automatic headlamp  system may turn on  There is   a delay before the lights turn on  when starting 
258. note           Inspect engine air cleaner filter  if you are driving in dusty  conditions  Replace filter if  necessary     120 000 Miles  192 000 km     Q Change engine oil and filter   or every 3 months  whichever  occurs first   An Emission  Control Service     Q Rotate tires  See Tire Inspection  and Rotation on page 9 53  for proper rotation pattern  and additional information    See footnote           Service and Maintenance    Q Replace engine air cleaner filter     or every 24 months  whichever  occurs first   See Engine Air  Cleaner Filter on page 9 12   for more information     Replace passenger compartment  air filter    Inspect engine accessory   drive belts  or every 48 months   whichever occurs first   Visually  inspect belt for fraying  excessive  cracks  or obvious damage   Replace belt if necessary    An Emission Control Service   Replace spark plugs    An Emission Control Service   Inspect for tappet noise and  engine vibration  Adjust valve  clearance to factory specifications  if necessary  or every 48 months   whichever occurs first     An Emission Control Service     Inspect fuel tank  cap  cap  gasket  and lines for damage   or leaks  or every 24 months   whichever occurs first   Replace  parts as needed  An Emission  Control Service   See footnote t         11 11    Q Change manual transmission  fluid every 30 000 miles   48 000 km  only if your vehicle  is used to tow a trailer     Q Change automatic transmission  fluid every 60 000 miles   96 000 km 
259. nt panel  to change the  direction of the air flowing through  the vents     Operation Tips    e Clear away any ice  snow or  leaves from the outside air  inlets at the base of the  windshield     e Use of non GM approved hood  deflectors can adversely affect  the performance of the system       Keep the area under the  front seats clear of objects for  more effective air circulation       Ifthe airflow seems low when  the fan is at the highest setting   the passenger compartment air  filter might need to be replaced   For more information  see  Passenger Compartment Air  Filter later in this section     7 4 Climate Controls    Passenger Compartment  Air Filter    Both outside and recirculated   air are routed through a passenger  compartment air filter  Pollen  dust  particles and other contaminants  are removed by the filter  Airflow  reductions indicate that the filter  needs to be replaced  For a  replacement filter see your dealer   retailer  See Scheduled Maintenance  on page 11 4 for replacement  intervals        The access panel for the air filter is  behind the glove box  To replace  the filter        1  Open the glove box door  Push  each side of the glovebox in  and pull out to remove           2  Push the side fastener to release  and remove the filter cover     Climate Controls 7 5    GT         c    3  Remove the air filter        4  Install a new air filter and  reassemble the unit by reversing  the steps     Replacing the air filter is  recommended  but will n
260. nt that operates within   the limit is plugged in        The power outlet is located below  the shift lever     Before using the outlet  turn on  the ignition and press the button  located on the instrument panel  below the climate control system        Instruments and Controls    An indicator light in the button  comes on  After using the outlet   press the button again to turn it off        The power outlet is not designed for  the following electrical equipment  and they may not work properly      Equipment with high initial peak  wattage  cathode ray tube type  televisions  compressor driven  refrigerators  or electric  power tools       Other equipment requiring an  extremely stable power supply   microcomputer controlled  electric blankets  touch sensor  lamps  etc        Ashtray s     For vehicles with a removable  ashtray  it is located in the front  cupholder in the center console  storage area     Notice  If papers  pins  or other  flammable items are put in   the ashtray  hot cigarettes or  other smoking materials could  ignite them and possibly damage  the vehicle  Never put flammable  items in the ashtray     For vehicles with a lighter  push  the lighter down and it will pop up  when it is ready to be used    The ignition switch must be in the  ACC ACCESSORY or ON RUN  position to use the lighter     Notice  Holding a cigarette  lighter in while it is heating does  not let the lighter back away from    the heating element when it is hot     Damage from overheati
261. o not use  cruise control on slippery roads              Instruments and Controls 4 5    Setting Cruise Conirol       Z  CAUTION       If you leave your cruise control on  when you are not using cruise   you might hit a button and go into  cruise when you do not want to   You could be startled and even  lose control  Keep the cruise  control switch off until you want to  use cruise control              1  Press the ON OFF button at the  end of the lever  The CRUISE  light on the instrument panel  cluster comes on  See Cruise  Control Light on page 4 23     2  Get to the desired speed     3  Move the lever down to  SET  and release it     4  Take your foot off the accelerator  pedal        If the cruise control indicator light  flashes  press the ON OFF button  once to deactivate the system  and  then press the button back on    If the cruise control speed cannot be  set or the cruise control cancels  immediately after being activated   there may be a problem with the  cruise control system  See your  dealer retailer     Resuming a Set Speed    If the brakes are applied after the  cruise control is set  the cruise  control is turned off     If the vehicle speed is 25 mph    40 km h  or greater  push the lever  up to  RES  Resume Accelerate    to return to the previously set speed     4 6 Instruments and Controls    Increasing Speed While Using  Cruise Control    There are three ways to increase   the vehicle speed      Use the accelerator pedal to get  to the higher speed  Mov
262. o pass  Doing so can  reduce your visibility     e Wait your turn to pass a slow  vehicle     e When you are being passed  ease  to the right        Loss of Control    Let us review what driving experts  say about what happens when the  three control systems     brakes   steering  and acceleration     do not  have enough friction where the tires  meet the road to do what the driver  has asked     In any emergency  do not give up   Keep trying to steer and constantly  seek an escape route or area of  less danger     Skidding    In a skid  a driver can lose control  of the vehicle  Defensive drivers  avoid most skids by taking  reasonable care suited to existing  conditions  and by not overdriving  those conditions  But skids are  always possible     Driving and Operating       8 25    The three types of skids correspond  to your vehicle   s three control  systems  In the braking skid  the  wheels are not rolling  In the steering  or cornering skid  too much speed  or steering in a curve causes tires   to slip and lose cornering force    And in the acceleration skid  too  much throttle causes the driving  wheels to spin     If your vehicle starts to slide  ease  your foot off the accelerator pedal  and quickly steer the way you want  the vehicle to go  If you start steering  quickly enough  your vehicle may  straighten out  Always be ready for  a second skid if it occurs     8 26    Driving and Operating    Of course  traction is reduced when  water  snow  ice  gravel  or other
263. ob to  select a category    3  Press A or V to go to the  category   s first station  when the  desired category is displayed    4  Press A or V to go to another  station within the selected  category    5  Press CAT to exit the category  select mode or wait for CAT to  time out     NOT FOUND displays if the desired  category cannot be found        Scanning Categories  CAT    XM Satellite Radio  Service Only     To scan a desired category     1  Press the CAT button to enter  the category select mode     2  Turn the TUNE ADJ knob to  select a category     3  Press A or V for two seconds  to scan the stations in the  selected category     4  Press A or V again to stop  scanning     NOT FOUND displays if the desired  category cannot be found        Infotainment 6 5    XM Satellite Radio Service    XM is a Satellite radio service   that is based in the 48 contiguous  United States and 10 Canadian  provinces  XM Satellite Radio   has a wide variety of programming  and commercial free music   coast to coast  and in digital quality  sound  During your trial or when you  subscribe  you will get unlimited  access to XM Radio Online for when  you are not in your vehicle  A service  fee is required to receive the XM  service  For more information   contact XM at www xmradio com   or call 1 800 929 2100 in the U S   and www xmradio ca or call  1 877 438 9677 in Canada     6 6 Infotainment    Radio Data System  RDS     The audio system has Radio Data  System  RDS   RDS features are  avai
264. on  for instructions on use and  important safety information     5  To make the lap part tight  pull    up on the shoulder belt     It may be necessary to pull  stitching on the safety belt  through the latch plate to fully  tighten the lap belt on smaller  occupants        Seats and Restraints 1 17       To unlatch the belt  push the button  on the buckle  The belt should  return to its stowed position     Before a door is closed  be sure the  safety belt is out of the way  If a  door is slammed against a safety  belt  damage can occur to both the  safety belt and the vehicle     Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster    The vehicle has a shoulder belt  height adjuster for the driver and  right front passenger seating  positions     1 18    Adjust the height so that the  shoulder portion of the belt is  centered on the shoulder  The belt  should be away from the face and  neck  but not falling off of the  shoulder  Improper shoulder belt  height adjustment could reduce the  effectiveness of the safety belt ina  crash        Push down on the release button  and move the height adjuster to   the desired position  The adjuster  can be moved up by pushing on the  front of the height adjuster     Seats and Restraints       After the adjuster is set to the  desired position  try to move it  down without pushing the button  to make sure it has locked into  position     Safety Belt Pretensioners    This vehicle has safety belt  pretensioners for the front outboard  occupants  Although the s
265. ons  even belted occupants    can contact the inside of the vehicle     Airbags supplement the protection  provided by safety belts  Frontal  airbags distribute the force of   the impact more evenly over the  occupant s upper body  stopping  the occupant more gradually   Seat mounted side impact and  roof rail airbags distribute the force  of the impact more evenly over  the occupant s upper body     But airbags would not help in many  types of collisions  primarily because  the occupant s motion is not toward  those airbags  See When Should an  Airbag Inflate  on page 1 24 for  more information        Airbags should never be regarded  as anything more than a supplement  to safety belts     What Will You See After  an Airbag Inflates     After the frontal airbags and  seat mounted side impact airbags  inflate  they quickly deflate  so  quickly that some people may not  even realize an airbag inflated   Roof rail airbags may still be at least  partially inflated for some time after  they deploy  Some components of  the airbag module may be hot for  several minutes  For location of the  airbag modules  see What Makes  an Airbag Inflate  on page 1 26     The parts of the airbag that come  into contact with you may be warm   but not too hot to touch  There  may be some smoke and dust  coming from the vents in the  deflated airbags  Airbag inflation  does not prevent the driver   from seeing out of the windshield  or being able to steer the vehicle   nor does it prevent people fro
266. ont passenger frontal  airbag is in the instrument panel on  the passenger s side        Driver Side shown  Passenger  Side similar    lf the vehicle has seat mounted side  impact airbags for the driver and  right front passenger  they are in the  side of the seatbacks closest to   the door        1 24 Seats and Restraints    lf the vehicle has roof rail airbags for  the driver  right front passenger  and  second row outboard passengers   they are in the ceiling above the side  windows        Z  CAUTION       If something is between an  occupant and an airbag  the  airbag might not inflate properly or  it might force the object into that  person causing severe injury or  even death  The path of an  inflating airbag must be kept  clear  Do not put anything  between an occupant and an  airbag  and do not attach or put  anything on the steering wheel  hub or on or near any other  airbag covering      Continued                    CAUTION  Continued        Do not use seat accessories  that block the inflation path of a  seat mounted side impact airbag     Never secure anything to the roof  of a vehicle with roof rail airbags  by routing a rope or tie down  through any door or window  opening  If you do  the path of an  inflating roof rail airbag will be  blocked              When Should an Airbag  Inflate     Frontal airbags are designed to  inflate in moderate to severe frontal  or near frontal crashes to help  reduce the potential for severe  injuries mainly to the driver or rig
267. op as soon   as possible and turn the ignition off   Then start the engine again to  reset the system  If the light   still stays on  or comes on again  while driving  the vehicle needs  service  If the regular brake system  warning light is not on  there are  still brakes  but no antilock brakes        Instruments and Controls    If the regular brake system  warning light is also on  there are  no antilock brakes and there is   a problem with the regular brakes   See Brake System Warning Light  on page 4 17     Speed Sensitive Power  Steering  SSPS   Warning Light    wl    Vehicles with this feature  have a  warning light that comes on briefly  when the ignition is turned to  ON RUN as a check to show it is  working     If the warning light does not come  on  have it fixed so it will be able to  warn if there is a problem        If the warning light stays on  or  comes on while driving  the Speed  Sensitive Power Steering may   not be working  See your  dealer retailer for service     Low Tire Pressure  Warning Light    This light should come on briefly as  the engine is started     If there is a tire with low tire  pressure  the light will stay on or  come back on     See Tire Pressure Monitor System  on page 9 48 for more information     Traction Control System   TCS  Warning Light            ee    This warning light comes on briefly  when the ignition is turned to  ON RUN     It also comes on when the Traction  Control System is turned off by  pressing the TRAC OFF button
268. or others could be injured              1  Before starting this check  be  sure there is enough room  around the vehicle     2  Firmly apply both the parking  brake and the regular brake     See Parking Brake on page 8 12     Do not use the accelerator  pedal  and be ready to turn off    the engine immediately if it starts        Service and Maintenance    3  For automatic transmission  vehicles  try to start the engine in  each gear  The vehicle should  start only in P  Park  or  N  Neutral   If the vehicle starts  in any other position  contact  your dealer retailer for service     For manual transmission  vehicles  put the shift lever   in Neutral  push the clutch pedal  down halfway  and try to start  the engine  The vehicle should  start only when the clutch  pedal is pushed down all the  way to the floor  If the vehicle  starts when the clutch pedal   is not pushed all the way down   contact your dealer retailer   for service        Automatic Transmission Shift  Lock Control System Check       Z  CAUTION       When you are doing this  inspection  the vehicle could move  suddenly  If the vehicle moves   you or others could be injured              1  Before starting this check  be  sure there is enough room  around the vehicle  It should be  parked on a level surface     2  Firmly apply the parking brake   See Parking Brake on page 8 12   Be ready to apply the regular  brake immediately if the vehicle  begins to move     3  With the engine off  turn the  ignition to ON RU
269. ork day as possible to allow  for the same day repair        Customer Information    Scheduling Service  Appointments  for  Vehicle Customization     Your vehicle may have lighting and  door lock features that can be  programmed to your preference   You will need to schedule an  appointment with your dealer retailer  if you would like to change the  way these features are currently  programmed  The following is a list  of the features that can be  programmed  See your  dealer retailer to change the  programming of these features     Driver Door Key Unlock Switch    If this feature is programmed on    all of the doors will unlock when the  key is turned twice in the driver s  door lock cylinder  When the vehicle  left the factory this feature was  programmed on        Courtesy Lamp Timer  This  feature allows for changing how  long the courtesy lamps stay   on when all the doors and liftgate  are closed and the key is out of  the ignition  in LOCK OFF  or   in ACC ACCESSORY  When the  vehicle left the factory the courtesy  lamps were programmed to stay  on for 15 seconds  This can   be changed to 7 5 seconds or   30 seconds     Interior Lamps when Ignition  Off  If this feature is programmed  on  the interior lamps will come on  when the ignition is turned off  when it is dark outside  When the  vehicle left the factory this   feature was programmed on     Interior Lamps on with Door   Key Unlock  If this feature is  programmed on  the interior lamps  will come on when the doo
270. ors will lock        Keys  Doors and Windows    To manually lock or unlock the door  from the inside  move the lever   on the door forward or rearward   The driver and front passenger door  open from the inside while locked     With manual locks  the key must be  used to lock and unlock the liftgate     Power Door Locks    On vehicles with this feature  the  power door lock switch is located on  the armrest of the driver and front  passenger door         Press to lock all the doors   A   Press to unlock all the doors        2 7    Rear Door Security Locks    Rear door security locks prevent  passengers from opening the  rear doors from the inside        Open the rear doors to access the  security locks     To set these locks  slide the lever  down on each door and close it   The doors can only be opened from  outside with the door unlocked    To return the doors to normal  operation  slide the lever up     2 8 Keys  Doors and Windows    Liftgate       Z  CAUTION       It can be dangerous to drive with  the liftgate open because carbon  monoxide  CO  gas can come  into your vehicle  You cannot   see or smell CO  It can cause  unconsciousness and even death   If you must drive with the liftgate  open or if electrical wiring or other  cable connections must pass  through the seal between the  body and the liftgate       Make sure all other windows  are shut      Turn the fan on your heating  or cooling system to its  highest speed and select the     Continued                    
271. ot  damage the vehicle if it is not           7 6 Climate Controls    4 NOTES    Driving and  Operating    Starting and Operating  Your Vehicle  New Vehicle Break In           8 2  Ignition Positions                  8 2  Retained Accessory    Power  RAP             s 0scceees 8 4  Starting the Engine               8 4  Engine Coolant Heater         8 5    Automatic Transmission  Operation  Four Speed      8 6  Automatic Transmission  Operation  Five Speed       8 8  Manual Transmission    Operation se   i 8 11  Parking Brake 2    8 12  Shifting Into Park                8 13  Shifting Out of Park            8 14       Parking the Vehicle     Manual Transmission      8 15  Parking Over Things   That Burn 22222558 8 16  Engine Exhaust                   8 16  Running the Vehicle   While Parked                   8 17   Driving Your Vehicle  Defensive Driving                8 17  Drunk Driving  eseese 8 18  Control of a Vehicle            8 18  Braking  isien 8 19  Antilock Brake   System  ABS  GG    8 20  Traction Control   System  TCS          ee 8 21  All Wheel Drive  AWD    VSI eea 8 22  StabiliTrake System           8 22  Steering  co ee 8 23  Off Road Recovery             8 24  PASSING  ceisiai na 8 25  Loss of Control              1   1       8 25    Driving at Night                   8 26       Driving and Operating 8 1    Driving in Rain and on    Wet Roads               0  eeee 8 27  Before Leaving on a   LONG Wrip seers nee 8 28  Highway Hypnosis               8 28  Hil
272. other people  or  can be thrown out of the vehicle        Z  CAUTION          Never do this     Never hold an infant or a child  while riding in a vehicle  Due to  crash forces  an infant or a child  will become so heavy it is not  possible to hold it during a crash   For example  in a crash at only  25 mph  40 km h   a 12 Ib  5 5 kg   infant will suddenly become a  240 Ib  110 kg  force on a  person   s arms  An infant should  be secured in an appropriate  restraint        Seats and Restraints 1 39       CAUTION  Continued           restraint in a rear seat  It is also  better to secure a forward facing  child restraint in a rear seat  If you  must secure a forward facing child  restraint in the right front seat   always move the front passenger  seat as far back as it will go              Z  CAUTION                Never do this     Children who are up against  or  very close to  any airbag when it  inflates can be seriously injured or  killed  Never put a rear facing  child restraint in the right front  seat  Secure a rear facing child     Continued                    1 40    Seats and Restraints      What are the different types of  add on child restraints       Add on child restraints  which   are purchased by the vehicle   s  owner  are available in four basic  types  Selection of a particular  restraint should take into  consideration not only the child   s  weight  height  and age but also  whether or not the restraint will be  compatible with the motor vehicle  in whi
273. ou or move it  to the side to help reduce glare     To use the mirror  slide the attached  cover        Doors and Windows 2 13    Mirrors    Manual Rearview Mirror    Adjust the mirror to see clearly  behind the vehicle  Hold the mirror  in the center to move it up  down   and side to side  The day night lever  lets you adjust the mirror to avoid  glare from headlamps behind   your vehicle  Move the lever to the  right for nighttime use and back   to the center for daytime use     Vehicles with OnStar   have three  control buttons located at the bottom  of the mirror  See OnStar   System  on page 4 25 for more information     2 14    Outside Power Mirror s        The controls are located to  the left of the steering wheel  on the instrument panel        Keys  Doors and Windows    The vehicle must be in ON RUN  or ACC ACCESSORY to adjust  the mirrors     1  Adjust either mirror by pushing  the selector switch to the L  left   or R  right      2  Use the arrows on the control  pad to adjust the direction of  the mirror     3  Move the selector switch back to  the center  This locks the mirrors  in place     Manually fold the mirrors inward  to prevent damage when going  through an automatic car wash   To fold  push the mirror toward the  vehicle  Push the mirror outward   to return to its original position        Sunroof    On vehicles with a sunroof    the controls are on the overhead  console  The ignition must be   in ON RUN or Retained Accessory  Power  RAP  for the sunroof
274. ou to  momentarily switch to high beams    If the headlamps are on when the  lever is released  the high beams will  return to low beam        4 7    Windshield Wipers       The windshield wiper washer lever  is located on the right side of  the steering column     Move the lever to one of the  following positions     SF  Mist   Move the lever to mist   for a single wiping cycle and then  release  The wipers stop after   one wipe     O  Off   Move the lever to this  position to turn the wipers off     4 8    VY  Intermittent   Move the lever  to choose a delayed wiping cycle     For vehicles with the variable  intermittent feature  the time  between wipes can be adjusted   Turn the X band for a longer  or shorter delay interval     A    Low   Use for steady wiping at  low speed     Y  High   Use for steady wiping at  high speed     Clear snow and ice from the wiper  blades before using them  If the  blades are frozen to the windshield   loosen or thaw them  If they  become damaged  get new blades  or blade inserts  See Windshield  Wiper Blade Replacement on   page 9 25     Heavy snow or ice can overload the  wipers  A circuit breaker stops  them until the motor cools     Instruments and Controls    Windshield Washer    Pull the lever toward you to spray  washer fluid on the windshield    The spray continues until the lever  is released  The wipers will run   a few times  See Windshield Washer  Fluid on page 9 24 for information  on filling the windshield washer fluid  reservo
275. ower levels during the  day  and then reduce these levels  during the night  Static can also  occur when things like storms and  power lines interfere with radio  reception  When this happens  try  reducing the treble on the radio        FM Stereo    FM stereo gives the best sound   but FM signals only reach about  10 to 40 miles  16 to 65 km     Tall buildings or hills can interfere  with FM signals  causing the  sound to fade in and out     XM    Satellite Radio Service    XM Satellite Radio Service gives  digital radio reception from  coast to coast in the 48 contiguous  United States  and in Canada  Just  as with FM  tall buildings or hills can  interfere with satellite radio signals     causing the sound to fade in and out     In addition  traveling or standing  under heavy foliage  bridges   garages  or through tunnels could  cause loss of the XM signal for a  period of time  The radio may  display NO XM SIGNAL to indicate  interference        Fixed Mast Antenna    The fixed mast antenna can  withstand most car washes without  being damaged  If the mast should  ever become slightly bent  straighten  it out by hand  If the mast is badly  bent  replace it     Check occasionally to make sure  the mast is still tightened to the  antenna base located on the roof  of the vehicle  If tightening is  required  tighten by hand     XM    Satellite Radio  Antenna System    The XM Satellite Radio antenna is  located on the roof of the vehicle   Keep this antenna clear of snow and  i
276. passenger sensing  system has turned off the right  front passenger frontal airbag  andseat mounted side impact  airbag  if equipped   no system is  fail safe  No one can guarantee     Continued              that an airbag will not deploy  under some unusual  circumstance  even though  the airbag s  are off     Secure rear facing child   restraints in a rear seat  even if the  airbag s  are off  If you secure a  forward facing child restraint in the  right front seat  always move the  front passenger seat as far back as  it will go  It is better to secure the  child restraint in a rear seat              The passenger sensing system is   designed to turn off the right front   passenger frontal airbag and   seat mounted side impact airbag    if equipped  if      The right front passenger seat is  unoccupied       The system determines that an  infant is present in a rear facing  infant seat        Seats and Restraints 1 29    The system determines that a  small child is present in a child  restraint     The system determines that a  small child is present in a  booster seat     A right front passenger takes  his her weight off of the seat for a  period of time     The right front passenger seat is  occupied by a smaller person   such as a child who has outgrown  child restraints     Or  if there is a critical problem  with the airbag system or the  passenger sensing system     1 30    When the passenger sensing  system has turned off the right  front passenger frontal airbag an
277. peut obtenir un exemplaire de  ce guide en fran  ais aupr  s de  concessionnaire ou a l adresse  suivante     Helm Incorporated  P O  Box 07130  Detroit  MI 48207    1 800 551 4123  helminc com      2008 General Motors Corporation  All Rights Reserved     Index    To quickly locate information about  the vehicle use the Index in the back  of the manual  It is an alphabetical  list of what is in the manual and the  page number where it can be found     Cautions and Notices    A circle with a slash through it is a  safety symbol which means    Do Not      Do not do this    or    Do not let this  happen           A box with the word CAUTION is  used to tell about things that could  hurt you or others if you were to  ignore the warning        Z  CAUTION       These mean there is something  that could hurt you or other people              Cautions tell what the hazard is and  what to do to avoid or reduce the  hazard  Read these cautions     A notice tells about something that  can damage the vehicle        Preface iii    Notice  These mean there is  something that could damage  your vehicle     Many times  this damage would not  be covered by the vehicle s warranty   and it could be costly  The notice  tells what to do to help avoid the  damage     There are also warning labels on  the vehicle which use the same  words  CAUTION or Notice     iv Preface       NOTES    Seats and  Restraints    Front Seats  Manual Seats  Seat Height Adjuster             1 2    Reclining Seatbacks   
278. portant to check  the engine oil regularly and keep it  at the proper level  Failure to keep  the engine oil at the proper level  can cause damage to the engine  not covered by the vehicle  warranty        Check the engine oil level and add  the proper oil if necessary  See  Engine Oil on page 9 9     Engine Coolant Level Check    Check the engine coolant level  and add DEX COOL   coolant  mixture if necessary  See Engine  Coolant on page 9 18     Windshield Washer Fluid  Level Check    Check the windshield washer fluid  level in the windshield washer  fluid reservoir and add the proper  fluid if necessary  See Windshield  Washer Fluid on page 9 24     Hood Latch Operation Check    Pull the primary hood latch release  handle inside the vehicle  The  secondary latch should keep the  hood from opening all the way when  the primary latch is released  Make  sure the hood closes firmly    See Hood Release on page 9 5     At Least Once a Month    Tire Inflation Check    Inspect the tires and make sure the  tires are inflated to the correct  pressures  Do not forget to check  the spare tire  See Inflation   Tire  Pressure on page 9 47     At Least Twice a Year    Wiper Blade Check    Inspect wiper blades for wear   cracking  or contamination  Clean  the windshield and wiper blades    if contaminated  Replace wiper  blades that are worn or damaged   See Windshield Wiper Blade  Replacement on page 9 25 and  Exterior Cleaning on page 9 86 for  more information        Service and Mainte
279. r   Airbag Equipped   Vehicle  sale 1 33  What Makes an Airbag   Inflate  aia 1 26  What Will You See After   an Airbag Inflates           1 26    When Should an Airbag  Inflate   2 renere 1 24  Where Are the Airbags        1 23  All Wheel Drive  AWD     System   2 0    ee eeceeeeeeee eee ees 8 22  All Wheel Drive Service   Ee ai E sees Seek een 4 24  Antenna  Fixed Mast              6 14  Antenna  XM    Satellite   Radio Antenna System        6 14  Antilock Brake   System  ABS  aaaeeeaa 8 20  Antilock Brake  System   Warning Light                     4 18       INDEX    Appearance Care  Chemical Paint Spotting    Exterior Cleaning  Finish Damage  Interior Cleaning  Sheet Metal Damage    Underbody Maintenance         Appointments  Scheduling  Service  Ashtray  s   Audio System               0666  Audio Steering Wheel  Controls  Fixed Mast Antenna  Radio Reception  Setting the Clock              XM    Satellite Radio  Antenna System           Audio System s     Automatic Headlamp System        Automatic Transmission  Fluid  Operation                 0688    Run Down Protection    System Inspection    System Warning Light          Break   n  i New Vehicle eer  Bulb Replacement  Halogen Bulbs  Headlamp Aiming  Headlamps and Parking  License Plate Lamps an  Replacement Bulbs    Buying New Tires    California Fuel   California Perchlorate  Materials Requirements   California Proposition    Canadian Owners       Capacities and    Specifications                  5  10 2  Carbon Mono
280. r tires  When applying  a tire dressing  always wipe off  any overspray from all painted  surfaces on your vehicle     Sheet Metal Damage    If the vehicle is damaged and  requires sheet metal repair or  replacement  make sure the body  repair shop applies anti corrosion  material to parts repaired or  replaced to restore corrosion  protection        9 89    Original manufacturer replacement  parts will provide the corrosion  protection while maintaining   the vehicle warranty     Finish Damage    Any stone chips  fractures or deep  scratches in the finish should be  repaired right away  Bare metal will  corrode quickly and may develop into  major repair expense     Minor chips and scratches can be  repaired with touch up materials  available from your dealer retailer   Larger areas of finish damage can be  corrected in your dealer s retailer s  body and paint shop     9 90    Underbody Maintenance    Chemicals used for ice and snow  removal and dust control can collect  on the underbody  If these are not  removed  corrosion and rust can  develop on the underbody parts such  as fuel lines  frame  floor pan  and  exhaust system even though they  have corrosion protection     At least every spring  flush these  materials from the underbody   with plain water  Clean any areas  where mud and debris can collect   Dirt packed in close areas of   the frame should be loosened before  being flushed  Your dealer retailer  or an underbody car washing  system can do this for you        V
281. r vehicle has a navigation  system  use of the system may result  in the storage of destinations   addresses  telephone numbers  and  other trip information  Refer to the  navigation system operating manual  for information on stored data and for  deletion instructions     Radio Frequency  Identification  RFID     RFID technology is used in some  vehicles for functions such as   tire pressure monitoring and ignition  system security  as well as in  connection with conveniences such  as key fobs for remote door  locking unlocking and starting  and  in vehicle transmitters for garage  door openers  RFID technology in  GM vehicles does not use or record  personal information or link with  any other GM system containing  personal information     A  Accessories and  Modifications 2    9 3  Accessory Power Outlets          4 9  Adding Equipment to Your  Airbag Equipped Vehicle      1 34  Additives  Fuel                   555 8 37  Add On Electrical  Equipment                  eee 9 35  Air Cleaner Filter  Engine         9 12  Air Conditioning                 7 1  Airbag  Passenger Status  Indicator siiis 4 15  Readiness Light                  4 14  System  Replacing Parts  After a Crash                  1 35  Airbag System    n    1 21  Adding Equipment to  Your Airbag Equipped  Vehicle                ceeeeeees 1 34  Check          ceceeeeeeceee eee ees 1 35    How Does an Airbag  Restrain  aiioe 1 26       Airbag System  cont    Passenger Sensing    System   ia 1 28  Servicing You
282. rake only        11 15      To check the P  Park   mechanism   s holding ability   With the engine running  shift to  P  Park   Then release the  parking brake followed by the  regular brake     Contact your dealer retailer if  service is required     Underbody Flushing Service    At least every spring  use plain  water to flush any corrosive  materials from the underbody   Take care to clean thoroughly  any areas where mud and other  debris can collect     11 16    Part C  Periodic  Maintenance Inspections    Listed in this part are inspections  and services which should be  performed at least twice a year   for instance  each spring and fall   You should let your dealer retailer  do these jobs  Make sure any  necessary repairs are completed  at once     Proper procedures to perform these  services can be found in a service  manual  See Service Publications    Ordering Information on page 12 16        Service and Maintenance    Steering  Suspension  and Front Drive Axle  Boot and Seal Inspection    Inspect the front and rear  suspension and steering system for  damaged  loose  or missing parts  or signs of wear  Inspect power  steering cables for proper hook up   binding  cracks  chafing  etc    Clean and then inspect the drive  axle boot seals for damage    tears  or leakage  Replace seals   if necessary        Exhaust System  Inspection    Inspect the complete exhaust  system  Inspect the body near the  exhaust system  Look for broken   damaged  missing  or out of position
283. re  See  Malfunction Indicator Lamp   on page 4 20     Driving and Operating       Z  CAUTION       If a fire starts while you are  refueling  do not remove the  nozzle  Shut off the flow of fuel  by shutting off the pump or by  notifying the station attendant   Leave the area immediately                 8 39    Notice  If you need a new fuel  cap  be sure to get the right type   Your dealer retailer can get one for  you  If you get the wrong type  it  may not fit properly  This may  cause the malfunction indicator  lamp to light and may damage the  fuel tank and emissions system   See Malfunction Indicator Lamp  on page 4 20     8 40 Driving and Operating    Filling a Portable Fuel  Container       CAUTION  Continued           Z  CAUTION       Never fill a portable fuel container  while it is in the vehicle  Static  electricity discharge from the  container can ignite the fuel  vapor  You can be badly burned  and the vehicle damaged if this  occurs  To help avoid injury to  you and others      Dispense fuel only into  approved containers      Do not fill a container while  it is inside a vehicle  ina  vehicle   s trunk  pickup bed   or on any surface other than  the ground      Continued             Bring the fill nozzle in contact    with the inside of the fill  opening before operating the  nozzle  Contact should be  maintained until the filling is  complete    Do not smoke while  pumping fuel    Do not use a cellular phone  while pumping fuel                       Vehicle
284. re goes flat  the next part  shows how to use the jacking  equipment to change a flat tire  safely     9 62 Vehicle Service and Care    Changing a Flat Tire    If a tire goes flat  avoid further tire  and wheel damage by driving slowly  to a level place  Turn on the hazard  warning flashers  See Hazard  Warning Flashers on page 4 3        CAUTION  Continued           Z  CAUTION       Changing a tire can be dangerous   The vehicle can slip off the jack  and roll over or fall on you or other  people  You and they could be  badly injured or even killed  Find  a level place to change your tire   To help prevent the vehicle from  moving    1  Set the parking brake firmly     2  Put an automatic  transmission shift lever in  P  Park   or shift a manual  transmission to 1  First  or  R  Reverse       Continued           3  Turn off the engine and do  not restart while the vehicle  is raised     4  Do not allow passengers to  remain in the vehicle     To be certain the vehicle will not  move  put blocks at the front and  rear of the tire farthest away from  the one being changed  That  would be the tire on the other  side  at the opposite end of the  vehicle                       When you have a flat tire  use the  following example as a guide to  assist you in the placement of  wheel blocks     ee 6       The following information tells you  how to use the jack and change  a tire     Removing the Spare Tire  and Tools         Compact Spare Tire  Jack     Cargo Area Floor s      Tire
285. rea where you will be parking  the vehicle for the best advice   on this        Automatic Transmission  Operation  Four Speed        The shift lever is located on the  console between the seats     P  Park   This position locks the  front wheels  It is the best position  to use when you start the engine  because the vehicle cannot   move easily           Z  CAUTION       It is dangerous to get out of the  vehicle if the shift lever is not fully  in P  Park  with the parking brake  firmly set  The vehicle can roll     Do not leave the vehicle when the  engine is running unless you have  to  If you have left the engine  running  the vehicle can move  suddenly  You or others could be  injured  To be sure the vehicle will  not move  even when you are on  fairly level ground  always set the  parking brake and move the shift  lever to P  Park   See Shifting Into  Park on page 8 13  If you are  pulling a trailer  see Towing a  Trailer on page 9 77              Make sure the shift lever is  fully in P  Park  before starting  the engine  The vehicle has  an automatic transmission  shift lock control system     You must fully apply the regular  brake first and move the shift lever to  the right before you can shift from   P  Park  when the ignition key is in  ON RUN  If you cannot shift out of   P  Park   ease pressure on the shift  lever  then push the shift lever all the  way into P  Park  as you maintain  brake application  Then move the  shift lever to the right and move the  shift
286. rforms a fuel evaporation leakage  test approximately five hours   after the engine is turned off    You may hear a sound coming   from underneath the rear cargo  compartment for several minutes     The noise is normal and does not  signify a malfunction  See your  dealer retailer with any questions     8 16 Driving and Operating    Parking Over Things  That Burn       CAUTION  Continued     CAUTION  Continued           Z  CAUTION       Things that can burn could touch  hot exhaust parts under the  vehicle and ignite  Do not park  over papers  leaves  dry grass   or other things that can burn              Engine Exhaust       Z  CAUTION       Engine exhaust contains Carbon   Monoxide  CO  which cannot be   seen or smelled  Exposure to CO  can cause unconsciousness and   even death      Continued           Exhaust may enter the vehicle if      The vehicle idles in areas  with poor ventilation  parking  garages  tunnels  deep snow  that may block underbody  airflow or tail pipes       The exhaust smells or  sounds strange or different      The exhaust system leaks  due to corrosion or damage      The vehicle   s exhaust system  has been modified  damaged  or improperly repaired      There are holes or openings  in the vehicle body from  damage or after market  modifications that are not  completely sealed      Continued        If unusual fumes are detected or  if it is suspected that exhaust is  coming into the vehicle     Drive it only with the windows  completely down     Hav
287. ricant  GM Part No  U S  12377985  in Canada 88901242  or  lubricant meeting requirements of NLGI  2  Category LB or GC LB     Lubriplate Lubricant Aerosol  GM Part No  U S  12346293   in Canada 992723  or lubricant meeting requirements of  NLGI  2 Category LB or GC LB     Chassis Lubricant  GM Part No  U S  12377985  in Canada 88901242  or  lubricant meeting requirements of NLGI  2  Category LB or GC LB     Lubriplate Lubricant Aerosol  GM Part No  U S  12346293   in Canada 992723  or lubricant meeting requirements of  NLGI  2  Category LB or GC LB     Multi Purpose Lubricant  Superlube  GM Part No  U S  12346241   in Canada 10953474      Weatherstrip Lubricant  GM Part No  U S  3634770  in Canada 10953518   or Dielectric Silicone Grease  GM Part No  U S  12345579   in Canada 992887         11 20 Service and Maintenance    Part E  Maintenance Record    After the scheduled services are performed  record the date  odometer reading  and who performed the service and  any additional information from  Owner Checks and Services    or  Periodic Maintenance    on the following record  pages  Also  you should retain all maintenance receipts     Maintenance Record    Odometer A         Service and Maintenance 11 21    Maintenance Record  cont d        11 22 Service and Maintenance    Maintenance Record  cont d        Customer  Information    Customer Information  Customer Satisfaction  Procedure        c cecceeeee eens 12 1  Online Owner Center          12 3  Customer Assistance for  
288. rmal  Leave the  system on during ordinary driving so  that it can operate when needed   When the ignition is turned to  ON RUN  the system automatically  turns on  If the system has been  turned off  it will automatically turn on  at 35 mph  55 km h   TCS cannot be  turned off above 35 mph  55 km h            ee    This light should come on briefly  when the engine is started     The traction control system warning  light flashes and an alarm will  sound intermittently when the  system is limiting wheel spin      amp   22    OFF    The  amp  switch is located to the left  of the steering wheel below the  instrument panel cluster     When getting the vehicle out of mud  or newly fallen snow  turn off the  traction control system  The system  that controls engine performance  interferes with the process of freeing       the front wheels  To turn off traction  control  press and release   the 2 switch  The traction control  system warning light will come on   To turn the traction control system  back on  press the  amp  switch again   or increase vehicle speed and the  system will automatically turn back  on  The traction control system  warning light will go off  See Traction  Control System  TCS  Warning Light  on page 4 19 Traction Control  System  TCS  Warning Light for  more information     VSC  OFF    To turn off both the traction control  system and StabiliTrak   press  and hold the  amp  switch while   the vehicle is stopped  The traction  control system warning light a
289. rong  replacement brake parts are  installed     9 30    Battery    This vehicle has a maintenance  free battery  When it is time for a  new battery  see your dealer retailer  for one that has the replacement  number shown on the original  battery s label  See Engine  Compartment Overview on   page 9 6 for battery location   Warning  Battery posts  terminals   and related accessories contain lead  and lead compounds  chemicals  known to the State of California to    cause cancer and reproductive harm     Wash hands after handling        Vehicle Service and Care    Vehicle Storage       Z  CAUTION       Batteries have acid that can burn  you and gas that can explode   You can be badly hurt if you are  not careful  See Jump Starting  on page 9 71 for tips on working  around a battery without   getting hurt              Infrequent Usage  If the vehicle is  driven infrequently  remove the  black  negative       cable from the  battery  This helps keep the battery  from running down     Extended Storage  For extended  storage of the vehicle  remove the  black  negative       cable from the  battery or use a battery trickle  charger  This helps maintain the  charge of the battery over an  extended period of time        Headlamp Aiming    Headlamp aim has been preset at  the factory and should need no  further adjustment     However  if your vehicle is damaged  in a crash  the headlamp aim may   be affected  Aim adjustment to the  low beam headlamps may be  necessary if oncoming dri
290. rs are  unlocked when it is dark outside   When the vehicle left the factory this  feature was programmed on     Key Fob Signal  If this feature is  programmed on  the Remote  Keyless Entry  RKE  transmitter  can be used to lock and unlock  the vehicle  When the vehicle left  the factory this feature was  programmed on     RFA Visual Feedback  If this  feature is programmed on    the hazard lights will flash when you  lock and unlock the vehicle with   the RKE transmitter  When the  vehicle left the factory this feature  was programmed on        Customer Information    RFA All Unlock Enable  If this  feature is programmed on  pressing  the RKE unlock button twice   within three seconds will unlock all  of the doors  When the vehicle   left the factory this feature   was programmed on     Remote Panic Command  If this  feature is programmed on  pressing  and holding the RKE panic button  will cause the horn to sound and the  lights to flash  When the vehicle   left the factory this feature was  programmed on     Automatic Door Locking  If this  feature is programmed on  the doors  will automatically lock when the  vehicle is shifted out of P  Park  or  when the vehicle speed is greater  than 8 mph  13 km h         12 9    Automatic Door Unlocking  If this  feature is programmed on  the doors  will automatically unlock when the  vehicle is shifted into P  Park  or  when the ignition is turned off     All Door Unlock Command  If this  feature is programmed on  the doors  will al
291. rvice facility could void    authorization to use this equipment        Immobilizer Operation    This vehicle has a passive  theft deterrent system     You do not have to manually arm or  disarm the system     The system is automatically armed  when the key is removed from  the ignition           The security light  located on the  center of the instrument panel   comes on if there is a problem  with arming or disarming the  theft deterrent system     2 10    The security light flashes when the  system is armed     When the key is inserted in the  ignition the transponder in the key  head transmits an electronic code   to the vehicle and automatically  cancels the system  Only the correct  key starts the vehicle     If the engine does not start  there  could be a problem with the  theft deterrent system  Turn the  ignition off and try again     If the engine still does not start  and  the key appears to be undamaged   try another ignition key  Check the  fuse  See Fuses and Circuit  Breakers on page 9 36     If the engine still does not start with  the other key  the vehicle needs  service  If the vehicle does start  the  first key may be faulty  See your  dealer retailer who can service the  theft deterrent system and have   a new key made        Keys  Doors and Windows    If any of the following conditions  occur  contact your dealer retailer       The security light stays on       The security light does not start  flashing when the key is  removed from the ignition       
292. rvices have been  deactivated  Press the OnStar button  to confirm that the OnStar equipment  is active     4 28 Instruments and Controls    4 NOTES    Lighting    Lighting  Exterior Lamps Controls       5 1  Daytime Running    Lamps  DRL  sissies 5 2  Automatic Headlamp   SYSTEM use seere ee 5 2  Fog Lamps          0     eee 5 2  Instrument Panel   Brightness senere 5 3  Dome Lamp S  1    5 3  Entry Lighting orne 5 3  Reading Lamps                0 5 4  Battery Run Down   Protection  eee 5 4       Lighting    Exterior Lamps Controls    The lever on the left side of the  steering column operates the  exterior lamps     Y    00   Exterior Lamps   Turn the  outside band of the lever to operate  the lamps  For vehicles sold in the  U S   XX appears on the instrument  panel cluster when the exterior  lamps are on  For vehicles first   sold in Canada  200  appears in the  instrument panel cluster  See Lights  On Reminder on page 4 23        Lighting 5 1    The exterior lamp switch has three  positions    O  Off   Turns off all lamps  except  the Daytime Running Lamps  DRL    200   Parking Lamps   Turns on  the parking lamps together with the  following      Sidemarker Lamps     Taillamps   e License Plate Lamp     Instrument Panel Lights    ED   Headlamps   Turns on the  headlamps  together with the  previously listed lamps and lights     Headlamps on Reminder    A tone sounds when the ignition is  turned to LOCK OFF  the driver  door is opened and the key   is removed from the ig
293. s    Door Locks       CAUTION  Continued           Z  CAUTION       Unlocked doors can be dangerous     Passengers  especially   children  can easily open the  doors and fall out of a moving  vehicle  When a door is  locked  the handle will not  open it  You increase the  chance of being thrown out of  the vehicle in a crash if the  doors are not locked  So  wear  safety belts properly and lock  the doors whenever you drive      Continued                Young children who get into    unlocked vehicles may be  unable to get out  A child  can be overcome by  extreme heat and can suffer  permanent injuries or even  death from heat stroke   Always lock your vehicle  whenever you leave it   Outsiders can easily enter  through an unlocked door  when you slow down or stop  your vehicle  Locking your  doors can help prevent this  from happening                    To lock and unlock your vehicle  from the outside  use your key or the  Remote Keyless Entry transmitter    if equipped  See Remote Keyless  Entry  RKE  System Operation   on page 2 4 for more information     Open the driver door  on vehicles  with power door locks  by turning the  key in the lock toward the rear of  the vehicle     Turn the key back toward the center  and toward the rear again  within  three seconds  to unlock all of   the doors  Use the key in the  passenger door to also unlock   all of the doors     Lock a door by turning the key  toward the front of the vehicle   If you have power door locks   all the do
294. s  Instrument Panel Cluster      Speedometer and  Odometer  Trip Odometer s   Tachometer  Safety Belt Reminders  Airbag Readiness Light  Passenger Airbag Status  Indicator  Service Airbag Notification  System Message  Charging System Light  Brake System Warning  Light  Antilock Brake System   ABS  Warning Light  Speed Sensitive Power  Steering  SSPS   Warning Light    Instruments and Controls    Low Tire Pressure  Warning Light  Traction Control System   TCS  Warning Light  StabiliTrak   Indicator  Light  Engine Coolant    11 Temperature Gage             4 12 Malfunction   Indicator Lamp                  4 13 Security Light    e  4 13 Oil Pressure Light                4 13 Fog Lamp Light                  4 14 Lights On Reminder             4 14 Taillamp Indicator Light        Cruise Control Light              4 15 Low Washer Fluid    Warning Light  4 16 Service All Wheel Drive    4 16 Light ieir sinnn   Highbeam On Light               4 17 Door Ajar Light                    Fuel Gage      ccccceeseeeeeeeeees   4 18 Low Fuel Warning Light       OnStar   System   4 18   OnStar System          4 2 Instruments and Controls    Instrument Panel Overview       The main components of the  instrument panel are the following     A  Outside Power Mirror s  on  page 2 14   B  Outlet Adjustment on page 7 3   C  Turn Signal Multifunction  Lever on page 4 4   D  Instrument Panel Cluster on  page 4 12   E  Windshield Wipers on page 4 7   F  Passenger Airbag Status  Indicator  Passenger Sensi
295. s may not be necessary   But the safety belt assemblies   that were used during any crash  may have been stressed or  damaged  See your dealer retailer  to have the safety belt assemblies  inspected or replaced     New parts and repairs may be  necessary even if the safety belt  system was not being used at  the time of the crash     Have the safety belt pretensioners  checked if the vehicle has been in  a crash  or if the airbag readiness  light stays on after you start   the vehicle or while you are driving   See Airbag Readiness Light on  page 4 14        Airbag System    This vehicle has the following  airbags       A frontal airbag for the driver       A frontal airbag for the right front  passenger     The vehicle may have the following  airbags       A seat mounted side impact  airbag for the driver       A seat mounted side impact  airbag for the right front  passenger       A roof rail airbag for the driver  and the passenger seated  directly behind the driver       A roof rail airbag for the  right front passenger and the  passenger seated directly behind  the right front passenger     Seats and Restraints       1 21    All of the airbags in the vehicle will  have the word AIRBAG embossed   in the trim or on an attached   label near the deployment opening     For frontal airbags  the word  AIRBAG will appear on the middle  part of the steering wheel for   the driver and on the instrument  panel for the right front passenger     With seat mounted side impact  airbags
296. s than 35 mph   56 km h   push the accelerator  pedal about halfway down       Going about 35 mph  56 km h   or more  push the accelerator  all the way down     Notice  If the vehicle seems to  start up rather slowly or not shift  gears when you go faster  and you  continue to drive the vehicle that  way  you could damage the  transmission  Have the vehicle  serviced right away  You can drive  in L2  Low  when you are driving  less than 35 mph  56 km h  and   D  Drive  for higher speeds   until then     2  Second   This position reduces  vehicle speed more than D  Drive   without using the brakes  You   can use 2  Second  on hills     8 8 Driving and Operating    It can help control vehicle speed as  you go down steep mountain roads   but then you would also want to use  the brakes off and on     L  Low   This position reduces  vehicle speed even more than   2  Second  without using the brakes   You can use it on very steep hills   or in deep snow or mud  If the   shift lever is put in L  Low     the transmission will not shift   into low gear until the vehicle   is going slow enough        Automatic Transmission  Operation  Five Speed        The shift lever is located on the  console between the seats     P  Park   This position locks the  front wheels  It is the best position  to use when starting the engine  because the vehicle cannot move  easily           Z  CAUTION       It is dangerous to get out of the  vehicle if the shift lever is not fully  in P  Park  with the par
297. s that fold  out from the back of the center  console     There are also molded bottle  holders located in the front and  rear doors     3 2 Storage    Overhead Console    lf your vehicle has an overhead  console  push on the cover to  open it     Center Console Storage    To access the center console  storage area  pull up on the lock  release lever to raise the upper    cover and access the tray storage     Pull up on the lower release  lever to raise the tray and access  more storage     Luggage Carrier       Z  CAUTION       If something is carried on top of  the vehicle that is longer or wider  than the luggage carrier     like  paneling  plywood  or a   mattress     the wind can catch it  while the vehicle is being driven   This can cause a driver to lose  control  The item being carried  could be violently torn off  and  this could cause a collision  and  damage the vehicle  Items may  be carried inside  Never carry  something longer or wider than  the luggage carrier on top of the  vehicle                 Do not exceed the maximum vehicle  capacity when loading your vehicle   For more information on vehicle  capacity and loading  see Loading  the Vehicle on page 8 32           Notice  Loading cargo on the  luggage carrier that weighs more  than 132 Ibs  60 kg  or hangs  over the rear or sides of the  vehicle may damage your vehicle   Load cargo so that it rests  evenly between the crossrails   making sure to fasten it securely     To prevent damage or loss of   cargo 
298. se the nuts might  come loose  The vehicle   s wheel          could fall off  causing a crash           12  Reinstall the wheel nuts with  the rounded end of the nuts  toward the wheel  Tighten each  nut by hand until the wheel  is held against the hub        13  Turn the jack handle  counterclockwise  Lower  the jack completely        Vehicle Service and Care       Z  CAUTION       Incorrect or improperly tightened  wheel nuts can cause the wheel  to come loose and even come off   This could lead to a crash  If you  have to replace them  be sure to  get new original equipment wheel  nuts  Stop somewhere as soon  as you can and have the nuts  tightened with a torque wrench to  the proper torque specification   See Capacities and Specifications  on page 10 2 for wheel nut torque  specification              Notice  Improperly tightened  wheel nuts can lead to brake  pulsation and rotor damage    To avoid expensive brake repairs   evenly tighten the wheel nuts in  the proper sequence and to the  proper torque specification    See Capacities and Specifications  on page 10 2 for the wheel nut  torque specification        9 67       14  Tighten the wheel nuts firmly  in a crisscross sequence as  shown     9 68    Storing a Flat or Spare  Tire and Tools    Storing the Compact  Spare Tire       Z  CAUTION       Storing a jack  a tire  or other  equipment in the passenger  compartment of the vehicle could  cause injury  In a sudden stop or  collision  loose equipment could  strike som
299. shaded warning area  the vehicle  could be damaged  and the  damages would not be covered  by the vehicle warranty  Do not  operate the engine with the  tachometer in the shaded  warning area     4 14    Safety Belt Reminders    When the engine is started  a chime  will sound for several seconds to  remind people to fasten their safety  belts  unless the driver safety   belt is already buckled     The safety belt light will also flash  until the driver belt is buckled  If the  driver belt is already buckled  neither  the chime nor the light comes on     The vehicle also has a safety belt  reminder light for the right front  passenger position next to the  passenger airbag status indicator   See Passenger Airbag Status  Indicator on page 4 15        Instruments and Controls    This light is located on the center of  the instrument panel  next to the  audio system     When the key is turned to ON RUN  or START  this light comes on  as a reminder for the right front    passenger to fasten their safety belt     This light flashes until the right  front passenger safety belt is  buckled  The passenger safety belt  reminder light will not come on if  the right front passenger belt   is already buckled or if a sensor  does not detect the weight of   a passenger in that seat     If something is placed on the right  front passenger seat  the sensors  in the seat may detect that   object and cause the right front  passenger safety belt reminder  light to come on  If this happens   remo
300. shuttle service to get you  to your destination with minimal  interruption of your daily schedule   This includes one way or round   trip shuttle service within reasonable  time and distance parameters of   the dealer   s area        Public Transportation or Fuel  Reimbursement    If your vehicle requires overnight  warranty repairs  and public  transportation is used instead of the  dealer   s shuttle service  the expense  must be supported by original  receipts and can only be up to the  maximum amount allowed by GM  for shuttle service  In addition  for  U S  customers  should you arrange  transportation through a friend or  relative  limited reimbursement for  reasonable fuel expenses may be  available  Claim amounts should  reflect actual costs and be supported  by original receipts  See your   dealer for information regarding   the allowance amounts for  reimbursement of fuel or other  transportation costs     12 11    Customer Information    Courtesy Rental Vehicle    Your dealer may arrange to provide  you with a courtesy rental vehicle or  reimburse you for a rental vehicle  that you obtain if your vehicle is kept  for an overnight warranty repair   Rental reimbursement will be limited  and must be supported by original  receipts  This requires that you sign  and complete a rental agreement  and meet state provincial  local  and    rental vehicle provider requirements     Requirements vary and may include  minimum age requirements   insurance coverage  credit card   
301. ssions are at acceptable  levels for the life of the vehicle   helping to produce a cleaner  environment     United States Canada    This light comes on when the ignition  is on  but the engine is not running   as a check to show it is working  If it  does not  have the vehicle serviced  by your dealer retailer        Instruments and Controls    If the check engine light comes on  and stays on  when the engine   is running  this indicates that there  is an OBD II problem and service  is required     Malfunctions often are indicated by  the system before any problem   is apparent  Heeding the light can  prevent more serious damage to the  vehicle  This system assists the  service technician in correctly  diagnosing any malfunction     Notice  If the vehicle is  continually driven with this light  on  after a while  the emission  controls might not work as well   the vehicle   s fuel economy  might not be as good  and   the engine might not run as  smoothly  This could lead   to costly repairs that might   not be covered by the vehicle  warranty        Notice  Modifications made   to the engine  transmission   exhaust  intake  or fuel system of  the vehicle or the replacement  of the original tires with other  than those of the same Tire  Performance Criteria  TPC  can  affect the vehicle   s emission  controls and can cause this light  to come on  Modifications to  these systems could lead   to costly repairs not covered   by the vehicle warranty  This  could also result in a 
302. status indicator light is OFF   the right front passenger frontal and  seat mounted side impact airbags  if  equipped  may not activate correctly        Z  CAUTION       Stowing of articles under the  passenger seat or between the  passenger seat cushion and  seatback may interfere with the  proper operation of the passenger  sensing system                 Servicing Your  Airbag Equipped Vehicle    Airbags affect how the vehicle should  be serviced  There are parts of the  airbag system in several places  around the vehicle  Your dealer   retailer and the service manual have  information about servicing the  vehicle and the airbag system    To purchase a service manual    see Service Publications Ordering  Information on page 12 16     Seats and Restraints 1 33       Z  CAUTION       For up to 10 seconds after the  ignition is turned off and the battery  is disconnected  an airbag can still  inflate during improper service   You can be injured if you are close  to an airbag when it inflates  Avoid  yellow connectors  They are  probably part of the airbag system   Be sure to follow proper service  procedures  and make sure the  person performing work for you is  qualified to do so                 1 34 Seats and Restraints    Adding Equipment to  Your Airbag Equipped  Vehicle    Q  Is there anything I might add to    or change about the vehicle  that could keep the airbags  from working properly       Yes  If you add things that  change the vehicle   s frame   bumper system  he
303. t       Running the Vehicle While  Parked       S    Safety Belt Reminders            4 14  Safety Belts 22 korleder 1 8  Care Of ssc scccdeincetiensiaveias 1 20  Check          ccceceeceeeee eee ees 1 20  How to Wear Safety Belts  Properly is erani ieia  1 11  Lap Shoulder Belt               1 16  Replacing Parts After a  Crash eraai draa 1 20  Safety Belt Extender           1 19  Safety Belt Use During  Pregnancy oesissnenaiss 1 19  Scheduled Maintenance          11 4    Seatback  Folding Passenger     1 4  Seats    Head Restraints                   1 6  Height Adjuster                    1 2  Passenger Folding  Seatback                cee 1 4  Rear Seat Operation             1 7  Reclining Seatbacks              1 3  Securing Child  Restraints                  1 50  1 53  Security Light               0 4 22       Service  G   G sssssssseeeeereereerrrnnee 9 2  Accessories and  Modifications                    9 3  Adding Equipment to the  Outside of the Vehicle       9 4    All Wheel Drive Light           4 24  California Perchlorate   Materials Requirements      9 3  California Proposition    65 Warning            eee 9 3  Doing Your Own Work          9 4  Engine Soon Lamp             4 20  Owner Checks n   9 5  Publications Ordering   Information               04 12 16   Service Airbag Notification   System Message              5 4 16  Service  Scheduling   Appointments               0000 12 8  Servicing Your   Airbag Equipped Vehicle      1 33  Setting the Clock         
304. t in the  instrument panel cluster ever  comes on and stays on  it means  that something may be wrong with  the airbag system  If this ever  happens  have the vehicle  serviced promptly  because an  adult size person sitting in the  right front passenger   s seat may  not have the protection of the  airbag s   See Airbag Readiness  Light on page 4 14 for more on  this  including important safety  information              If the On Indicator is Lit for a  Child Restraint    If a child restraint has been installed  and the on indicator is lit     1  Turn the vehicle off     2  Remove the child restraint from  the vehicle     3  Remove any additional items  from the seat such as blankets   cushions  seat covers  seat  heaters  or seat massagers     4  Reinstall the child restraint with  the ignition key in the ACC or  LOCK position while following the  directions provided by the child  restraint manufacturer and  refer to Securing Child Restraints   Right Front Seat  on page 1 50  or Securing Child Restraints   Rear Seats  on page 1 53        5  If  after reinstalling the child  restraint and restarting the  vehicle  the on indicator is still lit   turn the vehicle off  Then slightly  recline the vehicle seatback  and adjust the seat cushion  if  adjustable  to make sure that the  vehicle seatback is not pushing  the child restraint into the seat  cushion     6  Also make sure the child restraint  is not trapped under the vehicle  head restraint  If this happens   adjust the hea
305. t test  course  For example  a tire  graded 150 would wear one and  a half  11   2  times as well on the  government course as a tire  graded 100  The relative  performance of tires depends  upon the actual conditions of  their use  however  and may  depart significantly from the  norm due to variations in driving  habits  service practices    and differences in road  characteristics and climate        9 57    Traction     AA  A  B  C    The traction grades  from  highest to lowest  are AA  A  B   and C  Those grades represent  the tire   s ability to stop on wet  pavement as measured under  controlled conditions on specified  government test surfaces of  asphalt and concrete  A tire  marked C may have poor  traction performance        Z  WARNING       The traction grade assigned  to this tire is based on  straight ahead braking traction  tests  and does not include  acceleration  cornering   hydroplaning  or peak traction  characteristics              9 58    Temperature     A  B  C    The temperature grades   are A  the highest   B  and C   representing the tire   s resistance  to the generation of heat and its  ability to dissipate heat when  tested under controlled  conditions on a specified indoor  laboratory test wheel  Sustained  high temperature can cause the  material of the tire to degenerate  and reduce tire life  and  excessive temperature can   lead to sudden tire failure    The grade C corresponds to   a level of performance which   all passenger car tires must 
306. t that load        Compact Spare Tire Example     A  Temporary Use Only  The  compact spare tire or temporary  use tire has a tread life of  approximately 3 000 miles    5 000 km  and should not be  driven at speeds over 65 mph   105 km h   The compact spare  tire is for emergency use when a  regular road tire has lost air and  gone flat  If your vehicle has a  compact spare tire  See Compact  Spare Tire on page 9 70 and Ifa  Tire Goes Flat on page 9 61        Vehicle Service and Care     B  Tire Ply Material  The type  of cord and number of plies   in the sidewall and under   the tread      C  Tire Identification Number   TIN   The letters and numbers  following the DOT  Department  of Transportation  code is the  Tire Identification Number  TIN    The TIN shows the manufacturer  and plant code  tire size  and  date the tire was manufactured   The TIN is molded onto both  sides of the tire  although only  one side may have the date of  manufacture      D  Maximum Cold Inflation  Load Limit  Maximum load that  can be carried and the maximum  pressure needed to support   that load        9 43     E  Tire Inflation  The  temporary use tire or compact  spare tire should be inflated   to 60 psi  420 kPa   For more  information on tire pressure and  inflation see Inflation   Tire  Pressure on page 9 47      F  Tire Size   A combination  of letters and numbers define a  tire   s width  height  aspect ratio   construction type  and service  description  The letter T as the  first ch
307. tart  check the trailer  hitch  platform and attachments   safety chains  electrical connector   lamps  tires and mirror adjustment   If the trailer has electric brakes  start  your vehicle and trailer moving and  then apply the trailer brake controller  by hand to be sure the brakes   are working  This lets you check  your electrical connection at the  same time     During your trip  check occasionally  to be sure that the load is secure   and that the lamps and any   trailer brakes are still working     Following Distance    Stay at least twice as far behind the  vehicle ahead as you would when  driving your vehicle without a trailer   This can help you avoid situations  that require heavy braking and  sudden turns     Passing    More distance in front is needed to  pass when towing a trailer  And   because the tow vehicle and trailer  are longer  you will need to go  farther beyond the passed vehicle  before you can return to your lane     Backing Up    Hold the bottom of the steering  wheel with one hand  Then  to move  the trailer to the left  just move that  hand to the left  To move the trailer  to the right  move your hand to the  right  Always back up slowly and  if  possible  have someone guide you        Vehicle Service and Care    Making Turns    Notice  Making very sharp turns  while trailering could cause   the trailer to come in contact with  the vehicle  The vehicle could   be damaged  Avoid making very  sharp turns while trailering     When you are turning wi
308. tation     Press the FAV button to  display the page where it can  be stored     Press and hold one of the  six buttons until a beep sounds     Repeat the steps to store another  radio station     Setting the Tone   Bass Midrange Treble     To adjust the bass  midrange  and  treble     il  2     Press the TUNE ADJ knob     Turn the TUNE ADJ knob  or  press the button below BASS   MID  or TREB so it is highlighted     Press the TUNE ADJ knob  to select BASS  MID  or TREB       Turn the TUNE ADJ knob    to adjust the level     Press the TUNE ADJ knob to set  the adjustment        EQ  Equalization   To select  customized equalization settings     1   2     Press EQ     Press the button below the label   POP  ROCK  COUNTRY  TALK   JAZZ  and CLASSICAL     Adjusting the Speakers   Balance Fade     To adjust the balance or fade   perform the following steps     1   2     Press the TUNE ADJ knob     Turn the TUNE ADJ knob  or press the button below BAL  FADE so it is highlighted     Press the TUNE ADJ knob to  select the tone to adjust     Turn the TUNE ADJ knob to  adjust the audio balance to   the right or the left speakers  and the fade to adjust the audio  volume to the front or rear  speakers     Press the TUNE ADJ knob to set  the adjustment     Finding a Category  CAT   Station  XM Satellite Radio  Service Only    If CAT times out and is no longer   on the display  return to Step 1    To select and find a desired   category    1  Press the CAT button    2  Turn the TUNE ADJ kn
309. tergents or  dishwashing soaps with  degreasers  Using too much  soap will leave a residue that  leaves streaks and attracts dirt   For liquid cleaners  about   20 drops per gallon  3 78 L    of water is a good guide     Do not heavily saturate the  upholstery while cleaning     Damage to your vehicle   s interior  may result from the use of many   organic solvents such as naptha   alcohol  etc        Vehicle Service and Care    Fabric Carpet    Use a vacuum cleaner with a   soft brush attachment frequently   to remove dust and loose dirt    A canister vacuum with a beater bar  in the nozzle may only be used on    floor carpet and carpeted floor mats     For soils  always try to remove them  first with plain water or club soda   Before cleaning  gently remove as  much of the soil as possible using  one of the following techniques     e For liquids  gently blot the    remaining soil with a paper towel     Allow the soil to absorb into the  paper towel until no more can be  removed       For solid dry soils  remove as  much as possible and then  vacuum        To clean  use the following  instructions     1     2     Saturate a lint free  clean white  cloth with water or club soda     Wring the cloth to remove excess  moisture     Start on the outside edge of the  soil and gently rub toward the  center  Continue cleaning  using  a clean area of the cloth each  time it becomes soiled     Continue to gently rub the soiled  area until the cleaning cloth  remains clean     If the so
310. test the alarm    1  Open all the windows    2  Set the system as described  in the previous procedure    The doors and liftgate should  be locked with the key or RKE  transmitter  Be sure to wait until  the security light starts flashing    3  Unlock the driver door from the  inside  The system should  activate the alarm    4  Stop the alarm as described in  the disarming procedure    5  Repeat this operation for the  other doors  Also  check that  the system is activated when the  battery terminal is disconnected  and then reconnected        2 11    If the system does not work  properly  have it checked by your  dealer retailer     How the System Alarm is  Activated  The system activates the alarm if       A locked door or the liftgate is  unlocked or opened without the  RKE transmitter       A locked door is unlocked or  opened without the key      The liftgate is unlocked or opened  with the key      The battery is reconnected       The side windows are tapped or  broken     Do not leave the key or device that  disarms or deactivates the theft  deterrent system in the vehicle     2 12    Windows       Z  CAUTION       Leaving children  helpless adults   or pets in a vehicle with the  windows closed is dangerous   They can be overcome by the  extreme heat and suffer  permanent injuries or even death  from heat stroke  Never leave a  child  a helpless adult  or a pet  alone in a vehicle  especially with  the windows closed in warm or  hot weather                 Keys  Doors
311. th a trailer   make wider turns than normal    Do this so your trailer will not strike  soft shoulders  curbs  road signs   trees or other objects  Avoid jerky or  sudden maneuvers  Signal well in  advance     Turn Signals When Towing a  Trailer    When you tow a trailer  your vehicle  may need a different turn signal  flasher and or extra wiring  Check  with your dealer retailer  The arrows  on the instrument panel flash  whenever you signal a turn or lane  change  Properly hooked up  the  trailer lamps also flash  telling other  drivers you are about to turn  change  lanes or stop        9 81    When towing a trailer  the arrows  on the instrument panel will flash for  turns even if the bulbs on the trailer  are burned out  Thus  you may think  drivers behind you are seeing your  signal when they are not  It is  important to check occasionally to be  sure the trailer bulbs are still working     Driving On Grades    Reduce speed and shift to a lower  gear before you start down a long or  steep downgrade  If you do not shift  down  you might have to use your  brakes so much that they would get  hot and no longer work well     On a long uphill grade  shift down  and reduce your speed to around  45 mph  70 km h  to reduce the  possibility of the engine and the  transmission overheating     9 82    Parking on Hills       Z  CAUTION       Parking the vehicle on a hill   with the trailer attached can be  dangerous  If something goes  wrong  the rig could start to move   People can
312. the car at night     Do not cover the automatic light  sensor  located on the top left corner  of the instrument panel  If the  sensor is covered the headlamps  will stay on continuously     Fog Lamps    4D  Fog Lamps   For vehicles with  fog lamps  move the band on the turn  signal multifunction lever to 20 to turn  them on  The fog lamps only come  on when the headlamps are on   low beam     Some localities have laws that  require the headlamps to be  on along with the fog lamps     Instrument Panel  Brightness    ST  USH aip    vore    Use the trip odometer knob located  on the right side of the instrument  panel cluster to adjust the  instrument panel brightness     Turn the knob clockwise or  counterclockwise to brighten  or dim the instrument panel     The brightness of the instrument  panel lights decreases when  the headlamps are on        Dome Lamp s     The interior lamps control is located  on the overhead lamp  To change  the interior lamps setting  slide   the switch to one of the following  positions     OFF  Turns the lamp off     ON  Keeps the lamp on all  the time     Door  Turns the lamp on when  any door or the liftgate is opened   The lamp goes off when all the side  doors and the liftgate are closed     If the lamp switch is in the door  position and a door is left open   the lamps will go off automatically  after 20 minutes        Lighting 5 3    Entry Lighting    After all the doors and liftgate  are closed  and the key is out of  the ignition  in LOCK 
313. the importance of  proper restraint use     A thick layer of additional material   such as a blanket or cushion  or  aftermarket equipment such as  seat covers  seat heaters  seat  backpacks  and seat massagers  can affect how well the passenger  sensing system operates  We  recommend that you not use   seat covers or other aftermarket  equipment except when approved  by GM for your specific vehicle   See Adding Equipment to Your  Airbag Equipped Vehicle on   page 1 34 for more information  about modifications that can affect  how the system operates        The passenger sensing system may  suppress the airbag deployment  when liquid soaks into the seat    If this happens  the off indicator   in the passenger airbag status  indicator and the airbag readiness  light will be lit  Have your  dealer retailer check the system     An object  person or child in the  rear seat contacting or pressing the  right front passenger seatback    or objects stowed under the right  front passenger seat  may affect the  proper functioning of the passenger  sensing system     When a safety belt extender is used  in the right front passenger seat   make sure the passenger airbag  status indicator shows ON  If the  indicator shows OFF  disconnect the  extender   s latch from the buckle then  reconnect the safety belt     The passenger airbag status  indicator light should be ON and then  the safety belt extender can be  reconnected  If the safety belt  extender is used while the passenger  airbag 
314. the safety belts   See Safety Belt Reminders on    page 4 14 for additional information        In most states and in all Canadian  provinces  the law requires  wearing safety belts  Here is why     You never know if you will be ina  crash  If you do have a crash  you do  not know if it will be a serious one     A few crashes are mild  and some  crashes can be so serious that even  buckled up  a person would not  survive  But most crashes are in  between  In many of them  people  who buckle up can survive and  sometimes walk away  Without  safety belts they could have been  badly hurt or killed     After more than 40 years of safety    belts in vehicles  the facts are clear     In most crashes buckling up does  matter    a lot        Why Safety Belts Work    When you ride in or on anything   you go as fast as it goes        Take the simplest vehicle  Suppose  it is just a seat on wheels     1 10       Get it up to speed  Then stop the  vehicle  The rider does not stop     Seats and Restraints          The person keeps going until  stopped by something  In a real  vehicle  it could be the windshield          or the instrument panel             or the safety belts     With safety belts  you slow down as  the vehicle does  You get more  time to stop  You stop over more  distance  and your strongest bones  take the forces  That is why   safety belts make such good sense     Questions and Answers About  Safety Belts    Q  Will I be trapped in the vehicle  after a crash if I am wear
315. the underside of the  vehicle such as hitting a curb  falling  into a deep hole  or landing hard     In addition  the vehicle has  dual stage frontal airbags   Dual stage airbags adjust the  restraint according to crash severity        The vehicle has electronic frontal  sensors  which help the sensing  system distinguish between a  moderate frontal impact and a more  severe frontal impact  For moderate  frontal impacts  dual stage airbags  inflate at a level less than full  deployment  For more severe frontal  impacts  full deployment occurs     The vehicle may have seat mounted  side impact and roof rail airbags   See Airbag System on page 1 21   Seat mounted side impact and  roof rail airbags are intended   to inflate in moderate to severe  side crashes  Seat mounted   side impact and roof rail airbags  will inflate if the crash severity   is above the system   s designed  threshold level  Your vehicle   has sensors which detect side  impacts  These sensors signal the  appropriate side impact airbag   to inflate  The threshold level can  vary with specific vehicle design     Seats and Restraints       1 25    Seat mounted side impact and  roof rail airbags are not intended to  inflate in frontal impacts  near frontal  impacts  rollovers  or rear impacts    A seat mounted side impact airbag is  intended to deploy on the side of the  vehicle that is struck  A roof rail  airbag is intended to deploy on the  side of the vehicle that is struck  It is  possible that  in a crash 
316. tire with  the spare tire  The spare tire    if equipped  must be in good  condition and properly inflated    It is the owner s responsibility for  the repair or replacement of the  tire if it is not covered by the  warranty     Battery Jump Start  Service is    provided to jump start a dead  battery     Trip Interruption Benefits and  Assistance  If your trip is  interrupted due to a warranty  failure  incidental expenses   may be reimbursed during the   5 years 100 000 miles    160 000 km  Powertrain warranty  period  Items considered are  hotel  meals  and rental car     Services Not Included in  Roadside Assistance    Impound towing caused by  violation of any laws    Legal fines    Mounting  dismounting or  changing of snow tires  chains   or other traction devices   Towing or services for vehicles    driven on a non public road or  highway        Services Specific to Canadian  Purchased Vehicles    Fuel delivery  Reimbursement is  approximately  5 Canadian   Diesel fuel delivery may be  restricted  Propane and other  fuels are not provided through  this service     Lock Out Service  Vehicle  registration is required     Trip Routing Service  Detailed  maps of North America are  provided when requested either  with the most direct route or the  most scenic route  There is a  limit of six requests per year   Additional travel information is  also available  Allow three weeks  for delivery     Customer Information       12 7      Trip Interruption Benefits    and Assistanc
317. tronic power  steering and does not use power  steering fluid  If you suspect a   problem  see your dealer retailer     Windshield Washer Fluid    What to Use    When you need windshield   washer fluid  be sure to read the  manufacturer   s instructions before  use  If you will be operating your  vehicle in an area where the  temperature may fall below freezing   use a fluid that has sufficient  protection against freezing        Vehicle Service and Care    How to Check Windshield  Washer Fluid    oe et eT       A B    To check windshield washer fluid     1  Pull dipstick out of windshield  washer reservoir     2  Washer fluid should fill the holes  between the LOW  B  and  NORMAL  A  mark     3  If the fluid reads LOW  B  add  fluid        Adding Washer Fluid       Open the cap with the washer  symbol on it  Add washer fluid  until the holes of the dipstick are  filled between the LOW  B  and  NORMAL  A   See Engine  Compartment Overview on  page 9 6 for reservoir location     Notice       When using concentrated  washer fluid  follow the  manufacturer   s instructions  for adding water        Do not mix water with  ready to use washer fluid   Water can cause the solution  to freeze and damage your  washer fluid tank and other  parts of the washer system   Also  water does not clean  as well as washer fluid       Fill the washer fluid tank only  three quarters full when it is  very cold  This allows for fluid  expansion if freezing occurs   which could damage the tank  if it
318. ty Belt Check    Now and then  check the safety   belt reminder light  safety belts   buckles  latch plates  retractors and  anchorages are working properly   Look for any other loose or damaged  safety belt system parts that might  keep a safety belt system from doing  its job  See your dealer retailer to  have it repaired  Torn or frayed  safety belts may not protect you in   a crash  They can rip apart under  impact forces  If a belt is torn or  frayed  get a new one right away     Make sure the safety belt reminder  light is working  See Safety Belt  Reminders on page 4 14 for more  information     Keep safety belts clean and dry   See Care of Safety Belts on  page 1 20     Seats and Restraints    Care of Safety Belts    Keep belts clean and dry        Z  CAUTION       Do not bleach or dye safety belts     If you do  it may severely weaken  them  In acrash  they might not  be able to provide adequate  protection  Clean safety belts only  with mild soap and lukewarm       water                 Replacing Safety Belt  System Parts After  a Crash       Z  CAUTION       A crash can damage the safety  belt system in the vehicle    A damaged safety belt system  may not properly protect the  person using it  resulting in  serious injury or even death ina  crash  To help make sure the  safety belt systems are working  properly after a crash  have them  inspected and any necessary  replacements made as soon   as possible              After a minor crash  replacement of  safety belt
319. ur vehicle only if a non trivial  crash situation occurs  no data   is recorded by the EDR under  normal driving conditions and no  personal data  e g   name  gender   age  and crash location  is  recorded  However  other parties   such as law enforcement  could  combine the EDR data with the type  of personally identifying data  routinely acquired during a crash  investigation     To read data recorded by an EDR   special equipment is required    and access to the vehicle or the  EDR is needed  In addition to   the vehicle manufacturer  other  parties  such as law enforcement   that have the special equipment  can  read the information if they have  access to the vehicle or the EDR        Customer Information    GM will not access this data or  share it with others except  with the  consent of the vehicle owner or    if the vehicle is leased  with the  consent of the lessee  in response  to an official request of police or  similar government office  as part of  GM s defense of litigation through  the discovery process  or  as  required by law  Data that GM  collects or receives may also be  used for GM research needs or may  be made available to others for  research purposes  where a need is  shown and the data is not tied to   a specific vehicle or vehicle owner     OnStar      If your vehicle has OnStar and you  subscribe to the OnStar services   please refer to the OnStar Terms and  Conditions for information on data  collection and use        Navigation System    If you
320. ure  the belt goes under the armrests              Q  What is wrong with this              forties  ODO 3  OO    A  The shoulder belt is worn under  the arm  It should be worn over  the shoulder at all times                 Seats and Restraints 1 15       Z  CAUTION          You can be seriously injured if you  wear the shoulder belt under your  arm  In a crash  your body would  move too far forward  which would  increase the chance of head and  neck injury  Also  the belt would  apply too much force to the ribs   which are not as strong as  shoulder bones  You could also  severely injure internal organs like  your liver or spleen  The shoulder  belt should go over the shoulder  and across the chest              Q  What is wrong with this        A  The belt is behind the body        Z  CAUTION          You can be seriously injured by  not wearing the lap shoulder belt  properly  In a crash  you would  not be restrained by the shoulder  belt  Your body could move too  far forward increasing the chance  of head and neck injury  You  might also slide under the lap  belt  The belt force would then be  applied right on the abdomen   That could cause serious or fatal  injuries  The shoulder belt should  go over the shoulder and across  the chest              1 16 Seats and Restraints    Q  What is wrong with this                          A  The belt is twisted across  the body        Z  CAUTION       You can be seriously injured by a  twisted belt  In a crash  you would  not have t
321. ve buckled safety belts to  avoid rubbing the LATCH  attachments        attachments to the lower  anchors  If the child restraint  does not have lower attachments  or the desired seating position  does not have lower anchors   secure the child restraint with the  top tether and the safety belts   Refer to the child restraint  manufacturer instructions and the  instructions in this manual     1 1  Find the lower anchors for  the desired seating position     1 2  Put the child restraint on  the seat     1 3  Attach and tighten the lower  attachments on the child  restraint to the lower  anchors     1 48    2    Seats and Restraints    lf the child restraint manufacturer  recommends that the top tether  be attached  attach and tighten  the top tether to the top tether  anchor  if equipped  Refer to the  child restraint instructions and the  following steps     Pl   2 2     2 3     Find the top tether anchor     If the vehicle has a cargo  mat  you may need to fold  it back to access the   top tether anchors     Open the top tether anchor  cover to expose the anchor        2 4  Route  attach  and tighten    the top tether according  to the child restraint  instructions and the  following instructions     If the position you are using  does not have a headrest  or head restraint and   you are using a single  tether  route the tether  over the seatback        TL    If the position you are using  does not have a headrest  or head restraint and   you are using a dual tether   route t
322. ve dust    If a more thorough cleaning is  necessary  a clean soft cloth  dampened with a mild soap solution  can be used to gently remove dust  and dirt  Never use spot lifters or  removers on plastic surfaces    Many commercial cleaners and  coatings that are sold to preserve  and protect soft plastic surfaces may  permanently change the appearance  and feel of your interior and are not  recommended  Do not use silicone  or wax based products  or those  containing organic solvents to clean  your vehicle   s interior because   they can alter the appearance by  increasing the gloss in a non uniform  manner    Some commercial products may  increase gloss on your instrument  panel  The increase in gloss may  cause annoying reflections in the  windshield and even make it difficult  to see through the windshield under  certain conditions     9 86    Exterior Cleaning    Cleaning Exterior  Lamps Lenses    Use only lukewarm or cold water  a  soft cloth and a car washing soap to  clean exterior lamps and lenses   Follow instructions under    Washing  Your Vehicle    later in this section     Finish Care    Occasional waxing or mild polishing  of your vehicle by hand may be  necessary to remove residue   from the paint finish  You can   get approved cleaning products  from your dealer retailer     If your vehicle has a  basecoat clearcoat paint finish    the clearcoat gives more depth   and gloss to the colored basecoat   Always use waxes and polishes that  are non abrasive and made 
323. ve the object        Airbag Readiness Light    There is an airbag readiness light  on the instrument panel cluster   which shows the airbag symbol   The system checks the airbag   s  electrical system for malfunctions   The light stays on if there is an  electrical problem  The system  monitors the airbag sensor  assembly  front airbag sensors   seat mounted side impact and  roof mounted airbag sensors  driver  seat position sensor  driver seat  belt buckle switch  right front  occupant sensing system and  indicator light  front passenger  seat belt buckle switch  seat belt  pretensioner assemblies  inflators   interconnecting wiring and power  sources  For more information   on the airbag system  see Airbag  System on page 1 21      A  This light will come on briefly when  the vehicle is started  then it should    go out indicating the system is ready        Z  CAUTION       If the airbag readiness light stays  on or keeps flashing after you  start your vehicle  it means the  airbag system and safety belt  pretension system may not be  working properly  The airbags in  your vehicle may not inflate in a  crash  or they could even inflate  without a crash  To help avoid  injury to yourself or others  have  your vehicle serviced right away if  the airbag readiness light stays on  after you start your vehicle                 Instruments and Controls    Passenger Airbag Status  Indicator    The vehicle has the passenger  sensing system  See Passenger  Sensing System on page 1 28 
324. vehicle with fuel       The gage moves a little when  you turn  stop or speed up     The gage does not go back to    E or empty when you turn off  the ignition        Low Fuel Warning Light  F    al       oe    Canada    E f  United States    This light  on the fuel gage  comes  on when the fuel tank is low on  fuel  To turn if off  add fuel to the  fuel tank        OnStar   System    TIRRI    OnStar uses several innovative  technologies and live advisors to  provide a wide range of safety   security  information  and  convenience services  If the airbags  deploy  the system is designed to  make an automatic call to OnStar  Emergency advisors who can  request emergency services be  sent to your location  If the keys are  locked in the vehicle  call OnStar at  1 888 4 ONSTAR to have a signal  sent to unlock the doors  OnStar  Hands Free Calling  including   30 trial minutes good for 60 days  is  available on most vehicles  Press the  OnStar button to have an OnStar  advisor contact Roadside Service        4 26    OnStar service is provided subject  to the OnStar Terms and Conditions  included in the OnStar Subscriber  glove box literature     Some services such as Remote Door  Unlock or Stolen Vehicle Location  Assistance may not be available until  the owner of the vehicle registers  with OnStar  After the first prepaid  year  contact OnStar to select a  monthly or annual subscription  payment plan  If a payment plan is  not selected  the OnStar system   and all services  inc
325. vel in the reservoir  might go down       The brake fluid level goes down  because of normal brake lining  wear  When new linings are  installed  the fluid level goes  back up       A fluid leak in the brake and or  clutch hydraulic system can also  cause a low fluid level  Have the  brake and or clutch hydraulic  system fixed  since a leak means  that sooner or later the brakes  and or clutch will not work well     9 28    Do not top off the brake clutch fluid   Adding fluid does not correct a leak   If fluid is added when the brake  linings are worn  there will be too  much fluid when new brake linings  are installed  Add or remove fluid  as  necessary  only when work is done  on the brake clutch hydraulic system        Z  CAUTION       If too much brake fluid is added  it  can spill on the engine and burn   if the engine is hot enough  You  or others could be burned  and  the vehicle could be damaged   Add brake fluid only when work   is done on the brake hydraulic  system              When the brake fluid falls to a low  level  the brake warning light comes  on  See Brake System Warning  Light on page 4 17        Vehicle Service and Care    What to Add    Use only new DOT 3 brake fluid  from a sealed container  See  Part D  Recommended Fluids  and Lubricants on page 11 18     Always clean the brake fluid  reservoir cap and the area around  the cap before removing it  This  helps keep dirt from entering the  reservoir        Z  CAUTION       With the wrong kind of fluid in
326. ven  that can be too heavy     It depends on how you plan to   use your rig  For example  speed   altitude  road grades  outside  temperature and how much your  vehicle is used to pull a trailer are  all important  It can also depend on  any special equipment that you have  on your vehicle  and the amount of  tongue weight the vehicle can carry   See    Weight of the Trailer Tongue     later in this section for more  information     Maximum trailer weight is calculated  assuming only the driver is in the tow  vehicle and it has all the required  trailering equipment  The weight   of additional optional equipment   passengers and cargo in the tow  vehicle must be subtracted from   the maximum trailer weight     You can ask your dealer retailer for  our trailering information or advice   or you can write us at our Customer  Assistance Offices  See Customer  Assistance Offices on page 12 4 for  more information     Weight of the Trailer Tongue    The tongue load  A  of any trailer   is an important weight to measure  because it affects the total or gross  weight of your vehicle  The Gross  Vehicle Weight  GVW  includes the  curb weight of the vehicle  any cargo  you may carry in it  and the people  who will be riding in the vehicle        Vehicle Service and Care    And if you tow a trailer  you must add  the tongue load to the GVW because  your vehicle will be carrying that  weight  too  See Loading the Vehicle  on page 8 32 for more information  about your vehicle   s maximum 
327. vers flash  their high beam headlamps at you   for vertical aim      If the headlamps need to be  re aimed  it is recommended  that you take the vehicle to your  dealer retailer for service     Bulb Replacement    For the proper type of replacement  bulbs  see Replacement Bulbs  on page 9 35     For any bulb changing procedure  not listed in this section  contact  your dealer retailer     Halogen Bulbs       Z  CAUTION       Halogen bulbs have pressurized  gas inside and can burst if you  drop or scratch the bulb  You or  others could be injured  Be sure  to read and follow the instructions  on the bulb package                 Vehicle Service and Care    Headlamps and Parking  Lamps       A  High beam Headlamp  B  Turn Signal Lamp Parking Lamp  C  Low beam Headlamp       9 31    High beam and Low beam  Headlamps    To replace the High beam or  Low beam Headlamp     1  Open the hood  See Hood  Release on page 9 5        2  Turn the bulb socket  counterclockwise and pull it out  of the headlamp assembly     9 32       3  Unplug the connector while    pressing down on the release tab     4  Pull the old bulb straight out     5  Push the new bulb straight  in until it clicks     6  Push the bulb socket into the  headlamp assembly and turn  it clockwise to secure it in  its original location        Vehicle Service and Care    Front Turn Signal Lamp and  Parking Lamp    To replace the Front Turn Signal  Lamp or Parking Lamp     1  Open the hood  See Hood  Release on page 9 5       
328. with your repair  professional  and insist on Genuine  GM parts  Remember if your  vehicle is leased you may be  obligated to have the vehicle  repaired with Genuine GM parts   even if your insurance coverage  does not pay the full cost     If another party   s insurance  company is paying for the repairs   you are not obligated to accept   a repair valuation based on   that insurance company   s collision  policy repair limits  as you have  no contractual limits with that  company  In such cases  you can  have control of the repair and  parts choices as long as cost stays  within reasonable limits     Reporting Safety  Defects    Reporting Safety Defects  to the United States  Government    If you believe that your vehicle  has a defect which could cause a  crash or could cause injury or  death  you should immediately  inform the National Highway  Traffic Safety Administration   NHTSA  in addition to notifying  General Motors     If NHTSA receives similar  complaints  it may open an  investigation  and if it finds that  a Safety defect exists ina   group of vehicles  it may order a  recall and remedy campaign        Customer Information    However  NHTSA cannot  become involved in individual  problems between you    your dealer retailer  or  General Motors     To contact NHTSA  you may call  the Vehicle Safety Hotline  toll free at 1 888 327 4236   TTY  1 800 424 9153   go to  http   www safercar gov    or write to     Administrator  NHTSA  1200 New Jersey Avenue  S E   Wash
329. xide           8 16  8 29  Care  Safety Belts                  1 20  Cargo Cover         ceeeeeeeeeeee eee 3 4  Cargo Management System      3 6  Cargo Tie Downs                     3 6  Cautions and Notices                 iii  CD  MP3s  lor feiesedeocgecesabiaea 6 9  Center Console Storage Area     3 2  Chains  Tire             ccccceeee eee 9 60  Charging System Light            4 16  Check   Engine Lamp                 0  4 20  Chemical Paint Spotting          9 90    Child Restraints  Child Restraint Systems       1 41  Infants and Young    Children             ccccceeee ee 1 38  Lower Anchors and Tethers   for Children                  5 1 44  Older Children                    1 36  Securing 1    1 50  1 53  Where to Put the   Restraint         1      1 43   Cleaning   EXtEFIOR son bosteder 9 86  Interior       cece eee ee eee ee eee eee 9 83    Underbody Maintenance            Climate Control System            7 1  Air Filter  Passenger    Compartment                 5  7 4  Outlet Adjustment                 7 3  Clock  Setting 1    6 2  Clutch  Hydraulic               0  9 17  Collision Damage Repair       12 11  Compact Spare Tire               9 70  Content Theft Deterrent           2 10  Control of a Vehicle                8 18  Coolant  ENGINE aieeaa ae 9 18  Engine  Temperature Gage           4 19  Cooling System              eee 9 18  Cruise Control                    066 4 4  Cruise Control Light                4 23  Cupholders            eeeeeeeeeeeee eee 3 1 
330. y  The load index  can range from 1 to 279  The  speed rating is the maximum  speed a tire is certified to carry  a load  Speed ratings range  from A to Z     Tire Terminology and  Definitions    Air Pressure  The amount of air  inside the tire pressing outward  on each square inch of the tire   Air pressure is expressed in  pounds per square inch  psi    or kilopascal  kPa      Accessory Weight  This means  the combined weight of optional  accessories  Some examples   of optional accessories are   automatic transmission  power  steering  power brakes  power  windows  power seats  and air  conditioning     Aspect Ratio  The relationship  of a tire s height to its width     Belt  A rubber coated layer of  cords that is located between the  plies and the tread  Cords may  be made from steel or other  reinforcing materials     Bead  The tire bead contains  steel wires wrapped by steel  cords that hold the tire onto  the rim     Bias Ply Tire  A pneumatic  tire in which the plies are laid  at alternate angles less than   90 degrees to the centerline   of the tread     Cold Tire Pressure  The  amount of air pressure in a tire   measured in pounds per square  inch  psi  or kilopascals  kPa   before a tire has built up heat  from driving  See Inflation   Tire  Pressure on page 9 47        Vehicle Service and Care    Curb Weight  The weight of   a motor vehicle with standard  and optional equipment including  the maximum capacity of fuel   oil  and coolant  but without  passengers an
331. y  installed should turn the light off     If the vehicle has been driven  through a deep puddle of water   the vehicle   s electrical system  might be wet  The condition is  usually corrected when the  electrical system dries out    A few driving trips should turn  the light off          Make sure to fuel the vehicle with  quality fuel  Poor fuel quality  causes the engine not to run as  efficiently as designed and may  cause  stalling after start up   stalling when the vehicle is  changed into gear  misfiring   hesitation on acceleration  or  stumbling on acceleration   These conditions might go away  once the engine is warmed up     If one or more of these conditions  occurs  change the fuel brand  used  It will require at least   one full tank of the proper fuel   to turn the light off     See Gasoline Octane on  page 8 36     If none of the above have made the  light turn off  your dealer retailer can  check the vehicle  The dealer retailer  has the proper test equipment and  diagnostic tools to fix any mechanical  or electrical problems that might  have developed     4 22    Emissions Inspection and  Maintenance Programs    Some state provincial and local  governments have or might begin  programs to inspect the emission  control equipment on the vehicle   Failure to pass this inspection could    prevent getting a vehicle registration     Here are some things to know to    help the vehicle pass an inspection       The vehicle will not pass this  inspection if the check 
332. y from fuel  Do not  leave the fuel pump unattended  when refueling the vehicle  This is  against the law in some places   Do not re enter the vehicle while  pumping fuel  Keep children away  from the fuel pump  never let  children pump fuel                 Driving and Operating    The fuel door release lever is near  the floor under the driver seat  on the outboard side           The tethered fuel cap is located  behind a hinged fuel door on  the driver side of the vehicle     To remove the fuel cap  turn it  slowly counterclockwise  On some  vehicles you may have to push   in while turning the cap     While refueling  hang the fuel cap  inside of the fuel door        Z  CAUTION       Fuel can spray out on you if you  open the fuel cap too quickly    If you spill fuel and then something  ignites it  you could be badly  burned  This spray can happen if  the tank is nearly full  and is more  likely in hot weather  Open the fuel  cap slowly and wait for any hiss  noise to stop  Then unscrew the  cap all the way              Do not to spill fuel  Do not top off   or overfill the tank and wait a few  seconds to remove the nozzle  Clean  fuel from painted surfaces as soon  as possible  See Exterior Cleaning  on page 9 86        When replacing the fuel cap  turn  it clockwise until it clicks  Make  sure the cap is fully installed    The diagnostic system can  determine if the fuel cap has been  left off or improperly installed   This would allow fuel to evaporate  into the atmosphe
333. you do not seal them  deadly  carbon monoxide  CO  from the  exhaust can get into your vehicle   See    Engine Exhaust    in the  Index  Dirt and water can too        Vehicle Service and Care    Safety Chains    You should always attach chains  between your vehicle and your  trailer  Cross the safety chains  under the tongue of the trailer   so that the tongue will not drop   to the road if it becomes separated  from the hitch  Instructions about  safety chains may be provided   by the hitch manufacturer or by   the trailer manufacturer  Follow the  manufacturer   s recommendation for  attaching safety chains and do not  attach them to the bumper  Leave  sufficient slack in the chain for turns   Never allow safety chains to drag on  the ground     Trailer Brakes    Does your trailer have its own  brakes     Be sure to read and follow the  instructions for the trailer brakes so  you will be able to install  adjust and  maintain them properly  If you have  antilock brakes  do not tap into your  vehicle   s brake system  If you do   both systems will not work well    or at all        Driving with a Trailer    Towing a trailer requires a certain  amount of experience  Get to know  the rig before setting out for the open  road  Acquaint yourself with the feel  of handling and braking with the  added weight of the trailer  And  always keep in mind that the vehicle  you are driving is now a good deal  longer and not nearly as responsive  as your vehicle is by itself     Before you s
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
MANUAL DEL USUARIO  "user manual"  U260 User Guide  Sandisk Sansa Fuze User's Manual  6059â•¢221 TEXTE F-GB  RENAULT Marine 2.60 - folie douce jeanneau  "取扱説明書"  Equipo Emotron Aqua Variador de Velocidad  Pic。Drive KEY AG〝E""峨  Hamilton Beach 14567 User's Manual    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file